User Manual PowerLogic P5 Protection Relay P5 en M 44D Scheneider
User Manual PowerLogic P5 Protection Relay P5 en M 44D Scheneider
User Manual PowerLogic P5 Protection Relay P5 en M 44D Scheneider
Protection Relay
User Manual
05/2023
www.se.com
Legal Information
The Schneider Electric brand and any trademarks of Schneider Electric SE and its
subsidiaries referred to in this guide are the property of Schneider Electric SE or its
subsidiaries. All other brands may be trademarks of their respective owners.
This guide and its content are protected under applicable copyright laws and
furnished for informational use only. No part of this guide may be reproduced or
transmitted in any form or by any means (electronic, mechanical, photocopying,
recording, or otherwise), for any purpose, without the prior written permission of
Schneider Electric.
Schneider Electric does not grant any right or license for commercial use of the guide
or its content, except for a non-exclusive and personal license to consult it on an "as
is" basis. Schneider Electric products and equipment should be installed, operated,
serviced, and maintained only by qualified personnel.
As standards, specifications, and designs change from time to time, information
contained in this guide may be subject to change without notice.
To the extent permitted by applicable law, no responsibility or liability is assumed by
Schneider Electric and its subsidiaries for any errors or omissions in the informational
content of this material or consequences arising out of or resulting from the use of the
information contained herein.
Protection Relay
Table of Contents
General information ..................................................................................15
Legal notice .............................................................................................15
Purpose ...................................................................................................15
Safety information and password protection................................................16
Abbreviations ...........................................................................................17
Range description .....................................................................................20
Easergy to PowerLogic renaming ..............................................................20
Introduction ................................................................................................22
Selection guide by application ...................................................................22
Function table ..........................................................................................24
Technical characteristics ...........................................................................28
Environmental characteristics ....................................................................33
Installation ..................................................................................................37
Safety instructions ....................................................................................37
Transport, handling and storage ................................................................39
Transport ...........................................................................................39
Handling ............................................................................................39
Storage ..............................................................................................39
Unpacking................................................................................................40
Equipment receipt...............................................................................40
Package contents ...............................................................................40
Equipment identification ............................................................................42
Dimensions ..............................................................................................46
Operating environment .............................................................................48
Mounting..................................................................................................49
General mounting operations...............................................................49
Flush mounting with accessory ............................................................51
Flush mounting without accessory........................................................54
Rack mounting ...................................................................................56
Rear panel connectors and application diagrams ........................................58
PowerLogic P5 rear panel....................................................................58
Typical application diagrams ................................................................66
Wiring on the real panel ............................................................................74
Slot A: analogue module......................................................................74
Digital input connections......................................................................83
Slot B: power supply + digital 4-input/4-output .......................................84
Slot C, D, E: additional digital input/output modules (6I4O/12I4O/
5I5O) .................................................................................................86
Slots D and E: Arc-flash module (for PowerLogic P5x30 only) ................87
Installing the digital I/O connectors .......................................................87
Wiring accessories for Slot B, C, D, E ...................................................88
Connecting earth/ground .....................................................................88
Optional rear communication ports and modules.........................................91
Location of the communication ports ....................................................91
Installing the modules..........................................................................92
Slot L: Ethernet communication module with RSTP redundancy
(reference REL51042).........................................................................93
P5/EN M/44D 3
Protection Relay
4 P5/EN M/44D
Protection Relay
6 P5/EN M/44D
Protection Relay
Characteristics.................................................................................. 267
Selective Overcurrent Logic (SOL)........................................................... 268
Description ....................................................................................... 268
Operation ......................................................................................... 268
Characteristics.................................................................................. 271
Incomer fault locator (ANSI 21FL) ............................................................ 272
Description ....................................................................................... 272
Example........................................................................................... 273
Characteristics.................................................................................. 274
Feeder fault locator (ANSI 21FL) ............................................................. 275
Description ....................................................................................... 275
Example........................................................................................... 276
Characteristics.................................................................................. 276
Neutral admittance (ANSI 21YN) ............................................................. 278
Description ....................................................................................... 278
Operation ......................................................................................... 279
Block diagram................................................................................... 281
Characteristics.................................................................................. 282
Transformer Overfluxing Protection (ANSI 24) .......................................... 284
Description ....................................................................................... 284
Function decomposition .................................................................... 284
Block diagram................................................................................... 286
Characteristics.................................................................................. 286
Synchro-check (ANSI 25) ........................................................................ 288
Description ....................................................................................... 288
Block diagram................................................................................... 290
Characteristics.................................................................................. 290
Undervoltage (ANSI 27) .......................................................................... 292
Description ....................................................................................... 292
Block diagram................................................................................... 294
Characteristics.................................................................................. 294
Positive sequence undervoltage (ANSI 27P)............................................. 296
Description ....................................................................................... 296
Block diagram................................................................................... 297
Characteristic ................................................................................... 298
Directional power (ANSI 32) .................................................................... 299
Description ....................................................................................... 299
Block diagram................................................................................... 299
Characteristics.................................................................................. 300
Wattmetric earth/ground fault (32N) ......................................................... 301
Description ....................................................................................... 301
Four memory modes ......................................................................... 302
Operation ......................................................................................... 303
Tripping direction .............................................................................. 303
Block diagram................................................................................... 304
Characteristics.................................................................................. 304
Phase undercurrent (ANSI 37)................................................................. 307
Description ....................................................................................... 307
Low-current self-blocking................................................................... 307
Block diagram................................................................................... 307
Characteristics.................................................................................. 308
P5/EN M/44D 7
Protection Relay
8 P5/EN M/44D
Protection Relay
Characteristics.................................................................................. 346
Motor underspeed (ANSI 14) ................................................................... 348
Description ....................................................................................... 348
Block diagram................................................................................... 348
Characteristics.................................................................................. 349
Motor Anti-backspin (ABS) protection....................................................... 350
Description ....................................................................................... 350
Block diagram................................................................................... 350
Characteristics.................................................................................. 351
Emergency restart .................................................................................. 352
Description ....................................................................................... 352
Characteristics.................................................................................. 353
Inrush blocking ....................................................................................... 354
Description ....................................................................................... 354
Block diagram................................................................................... 355
Characteristics.................................................................................. 355
Switch On To Fault (ANSI 50HS).............................................................. 356
Description ....................................................................................... 356
Operation ......................................................................................... 356
Block diagram................................................................................... 357
Characteristics.................................................................................. 357
Non-directional/directional phase overcurrent protection (ANSI 50/51/
67) ........................................................................................................ 359
Description ....................................................................................... 359
Examples ......................................................................................... 362
Block diagram................................................................................... 364
Voltage-controlled overcurrent ........................................................... 365
High Impedance Busbar Differential Protection ................................... 366
Characteristics.................................................................................. 366
Arc-flash (ANSI 50ARC).......................................................................... 369
Description ....................................................................................... 369
Block diagram................................................................................... 371
Operation ......................................................................................... 371
Characteristics.................................................................................. 374
Circuit breaker failure (ANSI 50BF) .......................................................... 376
Description ....................................................................................... 376
Block diagram................................................................................... 378
Characteristics.................................................................................. 378
Capacitor bank unbalance (ANSI 51C) ..................................................... 380
Description ....................................................................................... 380
Compensation method ...................................................................... 380
Characteristics.................................................................................. 384
Overvoltage (ANSI 59) ............................................................................ 385
Description ....................................................................................... 385
Block diagram................................................................................... 386
Characteristics.................................................................................. 386
Neutral overvoltage (ANSI 59N)............................................................... 388
Description ....................................................................................... 388
Block diagram................................................................................... 389
Characteristics.................................................................................. 389
Capacitor overvoltage (ANSI 59C) ........................................................... 391
P5/EN M/44D 9
Protection Relay
10 P5/EN M/44D
Protection Relay
12 P5/EN M/44D
Protection Relay
P5/EN M/44D 13
General information Protection Relay
General information
Legal notice
Copyright
2022 Schneider Electric. All rights reserved.
Disclaimer
No responsibility is assumed by Schneider Electric for any consequences arising
out of the use of this document. This document is not intended as an instruction
manual for untrained persons. This document gives instructions on device
installation, commissioning and operation. However, the manual cannot cover all
conceivable circumstances or include detailed information on all topics. In the
event of questions or specific issues, do not take any action without proper
authorisation. Contact Schneider Electric and request the necessary information.
Contact information
35 rue Joseph Monier
92500 Rueil-Malmaison
FRANCE
Phone: +33 (0) 1 41 29 70 00
Fax: +33 (0) 1 41 29 71 00
www.se.com
Purpose
This user manual is intended for electrical power engineering experts, OEMs,
system integrators, communication specialists, and general users of the
PowerLogic™ P5 protection and control relays.
The complete manual is arranged as follows:
• Preliminary sections, with the details of the manual (how to use it, glossary)
and technical data.
• Functions of the protection relay.
Explanations, diagrams and settings of the protection, control, monitoring and
maintenance, measurement, recording and programmable logic functions are
detailed in these sections.
• Installation and commissioning.
• Local control panel use, troubleshooting and maintenance instructions.
The following documents complete this manual:
• Quick Start Guide, delivered in the relay package, summarises instructions
for installation.
• Communication Manual, for the understanding and the setup of the
communication protocols with PowerLogic P5.
• Application Book, for the understanding of specific applications and
describing how the PowerLogic P5 protection and control relay functionality
can be expanded.
All above documents are accessible at se.com under this link:https://www.se.com/
ww/en/product-range/62400-powerlogic-p5-protection-relays/?parent-
subcategory-id=86796&filter=business-6-medium-voltage-distribution-and-grid-
automation#documents
We welcome your comments about this document. You can reach us by
contacting Customer Care Centre Contact page:
http://www.se.com/CCC
P5/EN M/44D 15
Protection Relay General information
The addition of this symbol to a "Danger" or "Warning" safety label indicates that an
electrical hazard exists which will result in death or serious injury if the instructions
are not followed.
This is the safety alert symbol. It is used to alert you to potential personal injury
hazards. Obey all safety messages that follow this symbol to avoid possible injury or
death.
DANGER
DANGER indicates an imminently hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will
result in death or serious injury.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, can
result in death or serious injury.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or
equipment damage.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, can
result in minor or moderate injury, or equipment damage.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment
damage.
NOTICE
NOTICE is used to address practices not related to physical injury.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
16 P5/EN M/44D
General information Protection Relay
Abbreviations
Table 1 - Abbreviations used in the manual
Acronyms Indication
Ø Diameter
CB Circuit Breaker
CS CyberSecurity
CT Current Transformer
CTS Current Transformer Supervision
DI, DO Digital Input, Digital Output: used in connection with the number of inputs and
output contacts within the relay and - when necessary - with the slot letter.
DG Distributed Generation
DIN rail Standard metal rail used to mount equipment inside ar rack (DIN for Deutsches
Institut für Normung)
GOOSE Generic Object Oriented Substation Events: in IEC 61850, type of generic
substation event, for a peer-to-peer communication over Ethernet.
I/O Input/Output (e.g. 6I/4O: 6 inputs, 4 outputs): used in connection with the
number of inputs and output contacts within the relay.
P5/EN M/44D 17
Protection Relay General information
Acronyms Indication
IRIG-B Inter-Range Instrumentation Group time code B: standard for time transfer
max. Maximum
NERC North American Electric Reliability Corporation
NI Network Input
RBAC Role Based Access Control: provides a restricting access to authorised users
only (Cybersecurity).
Ref Reference
REF Restricted Earth Fault
RH Relative Humidity
RS485 (or EIA- Standard defining the electrical characteristics of a serial communication
485) interface.
18 P5/EN M/44D
General information Protection Relay
Acronyms Indication
VO Virtual Output
VT Voltage Transformer
P5/EN M/44D 19
Protection Relay Range description
Range description
PowerLogic P5 is a family of digital protection and control relays for
medium voltage distribution networks dedicated to:
20 P5/EN M/44D
Range description Protection Relay
simpler and customer-centric approach, that will facilitate the navigation through
all the breadth and depth of our offers and that will be a key enabler for an
optimised digitization experience.
This brand optimization initiative affects Protection & Control portfolio including
Easergy P5 protection and control relays. The Easergy P5 has been renamed to
PowerLogic P5. It is essential to emphasize that this renaming change exclusively
affects the brand name of the products and will have absolutely no consequence
on the current performances, specifications, characteristics, and/or quality of the
product, which remain totally unaffected by this brand name migration.
During the brand transition project, it may happen that the application of this
change to different parts of the offer goes effective with different time schedules.
There is absolutely no difference between Easergy and PowerLogic branded P5
products and accessories. Easergy accessories can be used with PowerLogic P5
product as long as the commercial reference is matching. The commercial
references have not changed along with renaming of the offer. eSetup Easergy
Pro and CET850 remain the software to configure PowerLogic P5 protection and
control relays.
P5/EN M/44D 21
Protection Relay Introduction
Introduction
Selection guide by application
Table 2 - PowerLogic P5 protection relay selection guide
Voltage - P5V20 - -
Feeder P5F30 -
Characteristics
Phase current 1/5A CT (x3) LPCT (x3) - 1/5A CT (x3) LPCT (x3) 1/5A CT (x6)
Analogue Neutral current 1/5A CT & 1A CSH - 1/5A CT & 1A CSH 1/5A CT (x2)
inputs CT or CSH CT or CSH
Voltage - LPVT (x4)3 VT (x4) VT (x4) LPVT (x4)3 VT (x1)
Inputs 4 to 16 4 to 40
Digital
Outputs 3 to 8 + watchdog 3 to 18 + watchdog
Communication
Extension port
with backup ■ ■
memory
Ethernet port ■ ■
IEC 60870-5-101 ■ ■
EtherNet/IP ■ ■
Digital CB ■ ■
3. Resistive divider or capacitive divider LPVTs can be connected to the PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
22 P5/EN M/44D
Introduction Protection Relay
RSTP ■ ■
Redundan-
cy PRP ■ ■
protocols
HSR ■ ■
Pulse, IRIG-B ■ ■
Time
synchroni- SNTP, PTP IEEE
sation 1588-2008 / IEC ■ ■
61588:2009
Others
Control 6 controlled + 2 monitored objects
Matrix ■
Logic equations ■
Logic
Advanced logic
compliant IEC
■
61131-3 and IEC
61499
Cybersecurity RBAC according to IEC 62351 standard
IEC 62443-4 Security Level 1
Withdrawability ■
P5/EN M/44D 23
Protection Relay Introduction
Function table
Table 3 - PowerLogic P5 protection relay function selection table
IEC 61850 Logical ANSI P5U20 P5U20 P5V20 P5F30 P5M30 P5T30
node4 code CT LPCT/ VT CT/VT CT/VT CT/VT
variant LPVT variant variant variant variant
variant LPCT/ LPCT/
LPVT LPVT
variant variant
Protection functions
Non-directional/directional phase P5OCPTOCx 50/51/67 66 6 - 6 6 6
overcurrent5
Non-directional/directional earth/ P5DEFUPTOCx 50N/ 6 6 - 6 6 6
ground fault overcurrent7 51N/
67N
Wattmetric earth/ground fault P5EFPDOPx 32N - - - 2 2 -
Auto-Recloser P5ARRREC1 79 1 1 - 1 - -
Undervoltage P5UVPTUVx 27 - 3 3 3 3 -
4. The x at the end of the logical node name in this column corresponds to the number of the stages of protection functions and the number
of the objects for control and monitoring functions.
5. Only non-directional phase overcurrent is available in P5U20 and P5T30.
6. Non-directional only
7. Only non-directional earth/ground fault overcurrent is available in P5U20.
8. This protection function is only available when 12I4O module is fitted in the PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
24 P5/EN M/44D
Introduction Protection Relay
IEC 61850 Logical ANSI P5U20 P5U20 P5V20 P5F30 P5M30 P5T30
node9 code CT LPCT/ VT CT/VT CT/VT CT/VT
variant LPVT variant variant variant variant
variant LPCT/ LPCT/
LPVT LPVT
variant variant
Positive sequence undervoltage P5UVPSPTUVx 27P - - 2 - 2 -
Synchro-check P5RSYN1 25 - - 1 1 - -
Lockout relay 86 1 1 1 1 1 1
Programmable curves 3 3 3 3 3 3
Restricted earth fault (low P5REFPDIF1 64REF 110 - - 110 110 210
impedance)
Restricted earth fault with external 87N A10 - - A10 11 A10 11 A10 11
connection (high-impedance)
Setting groups 4 4 4 4 4 4
Monitoring functions
CT supervision P5CTSGGIO1 60 1 1 - 1 1 2
VT supervision P5VTSGGIO1 60 - 1 1 1 1 -
Relay monitoring ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
Control functions
Switchgear control and monitoring P5OBJCSWIx 6 6 6 6 6 6
Programmable switchgear ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
interlocking
9. The x at the end of the logical node name in this column corresponds to the number of the stages of protection functions and the number
of the objects for control and monitoring functions.
10. Only available with conventional (phase or neutral) CTs.
11. Function can be realized by application guidelines.
P5/EN M/44D 25
Protection Relay Introduction
IEC 61850 Logical ANSI P5U20 P5U20 P5V20 P5F30 P5M30 P5T30
node12 code CT LPCT/ VT CT/VT CT/VT CT/VT
variant LPVT variant variant variant variant
variant LPCT/ LPCT/
LPVT LPVT
variant variant
Local/remote function ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
Function keys 1 1 1 7 7 7
Measurement
RMS current values P5RMSAMMXU1 ■ ■ - ■ ■ ■
Frequency P5VECAMMXUx ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
12. The x at the end of the logical node name in this column corresponds to the number of the stages of protection functions and the number
of the objects for control and monitoring functions.
13. For 1 voltage.
26 P5/EN M/44D
Introduction Protection Relay
IEC 61850 Logical ANSI P5U20 P5U20 P5V20 P5F30 P5M30 P5T30
node14 code CT LPCT/ VT CT/VT CT/VT CT/VT
variant LPVT variant variant variant variant
variant LPCT/ LPCT/
LPVT LPVT
variant variant
months: active, reactive and
apparent power
14. The x at the end of the logical node name in this column corresponds to the number of the stages of protection functions and the number
of the objects for control and monitoring functions.
14. For 1 voltage.
P5/EN M/44D 27
Protection Relay Introduction
Technical characteristics
Table 4 - PowerLogic P5 protection relay technical characteristics
Characteristic Value
PowerLogic P5x20 PowerLogic P5x30
Rated frequency 50 Hz or 60 Hz
Power supply
Operating range DC: 24 to 250 V DC, ±20% DC: 48 to 250 V DC, ±20%
AC: 100 to 230 V AC, ±20% AC: 100 to 230 V AC, ±20%
Optional:
DC: 24 to 48 V DC, ±20%
Phase CT inputs
LPCT inputs
Current factor 0.25; 0.50; 1.00; 1.25; 1.33; 2.00; 2.50; 3.20; 4.00; 5.00; 6.30; 6.66; 10; 16; 20; 25; 31.5
15. This value can be impacted by high temperature exposition during a long time.
28 P5/EN M/44D
Introduction Protection Relay
Characteristic Value
PowerLogic P5x20 PowerLogic P5x30
CT ratio 1/470
Linear range 42.5 x rated primary current
VT inputs
Digital inputs
16. A setting below 10 ms can be used for testing only. It is not recommended during operation.
P5/EN M/44D 29
Protection Relay Introduction
Characteristic Value
PowerLogic P5x20 PowerLogic P5x30
Continuous: 1.3 mA
Maximum activation time DC < 1 ms
AC < 20 ms
Reset time < 0.5 ms
Debounce time Adjustable (by software) from 1 ms up to 20 ms, with 1 ms steps
Continuous current 8A
Short duration carry current 30 A for 3 s
Other characteristics
Making capacity 2000 operations
5 A DC with L/R = 50 ms
Duty cycle 1 s ON, 9 s OFF
Closing/opening time 7 ms (typical value), 3.5 ms + 3.5 ms for contact bounce, resistive load
30 P5/EN M/44D
Introduction Protection Relay
Characteristic Value
PowerLogic P5x20 PowerLogic P5x30
Continuous current 10 A
Short duration carry current 30 A for 3 s
Dielectric withstand across normally None – due to Solid State Devices across normally open contact
open contacts
Dielectric withstand across normally None – due to Solid State Devices across normally open contact
open contacts
Other characteristics
Making capacity 2000 operations
5 A DC with L/R = 50 ms
Breaking capacity 10000 operations
0.25 A DC with L/R = 50 ms
Short duration making capacity 20 A for 0.5 s;
30 A for 0.2 s
Minimum making current 10 mA with 50 mW minimum
Closing time 1 ms (typical value) for the high-speed contact relay DO1 (PowerLogic P5x30)
P5/EN M/44D 31
Protection Relay Introduction
Characteristic Value
PowerLogic P5x20 PowerLogic P5x30
Continuous current 2A
Short duration carry current 30 A for 200 ms
Other characteristics
Making and breaking capacity 10000 operations
1 A DC with L/R = 20 ms
Minimum making current 10 mA with 50 mW minimum
Closing/opening time 7 ms (typical value) 3.5 ms + 3.5 ms for contact bounce, resistive load
Size (Width x Height x Depth) 102/180/224 mm (4.01/7.08/ 8.82 in) 152.4/180/224 mm (6/7.08/8.82 in)
32 P5/EN M/44D
Introduction Protection Relay
Environmental characteristics
WARNING
UNEXPECTED OPERATION
Install PowerLogic P5 according to the environmental characteristics described
in the table below.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or
equipment damage.
According to the informative annex of IEC 60255-1 standard edition 2, all the
environmental tests are performed at the minimum settings which helps ensure
the robustness of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
The digital inputs have been tested with 10 ms of debounce filter.
Characteristic Description/Value
Power Supply
Product Safety
None for High Speed, High Break control relay output due to
solid state devices across normally open contact.
IEEE C37.90 1.5 kV rms AC for 1 min: across open tripping contacts
Impulse voltage IEC 60255-27 5 kV, 1.2/50 μs, 0.5 J between all terminals of independent
circuits, and all terminals and case earth/ground.
P5/EN M/44D 33
Protection Relay Introduction
Characteristic Description/Value
Electromagnetic Compatibility
CISPR11
IEC 60255-26
GOST-30805.22
IACS-E10 For equipment installed in the general power distribution zone.
IEC 60255-26
GOST-30805.22
IACS-E10 For equipment installed in the general power distribution zone.
Radiated radio frequency fields IEC 61000-4-3 Level 3 10 V/m, 80 MHz to 6 GHz, 80% AM (1 kHz)
Magnetic field at power IEC 61000-4-8 Level 5 100 A/m continuous; 1000 A/m, 1 to 3 s
frequency
Oscillatory magnetic fields IEC 61000-4-10 Level 5 100 A/m, 100 kHz and 1 MHz
Conducted Radio Frequency IEC 61000-4-6 Level 3 10 V rms common mode, 0.15 MHz to 80 MHz, 80% AM
disturbance (1 kHz)
Fast transient bursts17 IEC 61000-4-4 Level 4 4 kV common mode, 5 kHz, 100 kHz
Slow damped oscillatory waves IEC 61000-4-18 Level 3 2.5 kV common mode
1 kV differential mode, 100 kHz, 1 MHz
ANSI C37.90.1 2.5 kV, 1 MHz, common mode and transversal mode
IEC 61000-4-12 Level 3 2 kV common mode; 1 kV, differential mode, 100 kHz,
Source impedance: 12 Ω
GOST 30804.4.12
Fast damped oscillatory waves IEC 61000-4-18 Level 3 2 kV common mode, 3 MHz, 10 MHz, 30 MHz
Conducted disturbances 0 to IEC 60255-26 Zone A 150 V rms, differential mode; 300 V rms, common mode.
150 kHz
GOST 51317.4.6 Level 3 Continuous: 30 V rms
Short: 300 V rms
5 Hz – 150 kHz: 30 V rms
Surges18 IEC 61000-4-5 Level 4 4 kV, common mode; 2 kV, differential mode
17. ANSI C37.90.1 test passed with 20 ms of digital inputs debounce filter.
18. When protection function 50N/51N/50G/51G/67N is used and IN is measured with CSH core balance CT, it is recommended to use
operation time of 50 ms at the lowest pickup value setting.
34 P5/EN M/44D
Introduction Protection Relay
Characteristic Description/Value
Power voltage fluctuation (AC) IEC 61000-4-14 Level x ±ΔU 15% for (Un, Un – 10 %Un, Un + 10 %Un)
Level 3 ±ΔU 12% (Un, Un – 10 %Un, Un + 10 %Un)
Environmental conditions
Operation
Exposure to damp heat IEC 60068-2-78 Cab 40 ℃ (+104 ℉), 93% ± 3% RH, 56 days,
without condensation
Temperature variation IEC 60068-2-14 Nc -40℃ to +70℃ (-40℉ to +158℉), 10℃/min (18℉/min)
96 hours
Damp heat cyclic test IEC 60068-2-30 Db 55℃ (131 °F), 93% ± 3% RH and 25℃ (77 °F), 97% -2% +3%
RH, with condensation, 6 cycles (12 h + 12 h)
Variant 1
Storage
Exposure to damp heat IEC 60068-2-78 Cab 40 ℃ (+104℉), 93% ± 3% RH, 21 days
Corrosive atmosphere
Salt mist IEC 60068-2-52 Kb 4 spraying periods of 2 hours with a storage of 7 days after
Severity 1 each
Mechanical Robustness
Characteristics Standard Level Value
In operation (flush mounted case with REL51032: panel mounting kit with flush mounting accessory)
Storage (flush mounted case with REL51032: panel mounting kit with flush mounting accessory)
P5/EN M/44D 35
Protection Relay Introduction
Characteristic Description/Value
Enclosure
Local panel IEC 62262 IK07 Degree of protection against mechanical impacts
NEMA Type 12
Rear panel IEC 60529 IP10 Area with ring terminal connection (analogue inputs)
Fire resistance
Flammability IEC 60695-11-10 class V-1 minimum
Packaging
Cybersecurity
IEC 62443-4-2 Security Level 1 (SL Security for industrial automation and control systems:
1)20 Technical security requirements for IACS components.
Certification/declaration
EN / IEC 60255-26:2013 Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) directive 2014/30/EU
European Commission's EN 60255-27:2014 / IEC 60255- Electrical Equipment (Safety) directive 2014/35/EU
directives 27:2013
EN IEC 63000:2018 / Restriction of the Use of Certain Hazardous Substances in
IEC 63000:2016 Electrical and Electronic Equipment (ROHS) directive 2015/
863/EU
UL 508 File E354250, NRGU
ANSI/IEEE C37.90
CAN/CSA C22.2 No.14
UL Standards
ЕАЭС RU C-FR.НА46.В.05269/22 Hardware variants with P5xxx-xxxx-xxxx-xxxH
36 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
Installation
Safety instructions
This page contains important safety instructions that must be followed precisely
before attempting to install, repair, service or maintain electrical equipment.
Carefully read and follow the safety instructions described below. Only qualified
personnel, equipped with appropriate individual protection equipment, may work
on or operate the equipment. Qualified personnel are:
• Familiar with the installation, commissioning, and operation of the equipment
and of the system to which it is being connected.
• Able to safely perform switching operations in accordance with accepted
safety engineering practices and are authorised to energise and de-energise
equipment and to isolate, earth/ground, and label it.
• Trained in the care and use of safety apparatus in accordance with safety
engineering practices.
• Trained in emergency procedures (for example, first aid).
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Turn off all power supplying the protection relay and the equipment in which
it is installed before working on it.
• Always use a properly rated voltage sensing device to confirm that power is
off.
• Apply appropriate personal protective equipment and follow safe electrical
work practices. See local regulation.
• Do not install this product in ATEX class 0, 1 and 2 areas.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
DANGER
FIRE HAZARD
If you are authorised to withdraw the relay:
• Disconnect the power supply before removing or replacing a module or the
withdrawable part of the protection relay.
• Never touch electronic parts (electrostatic discharge).
• Before replacing the withdrawable part, clean all debris and contaminants
from the case, the withdrawable part, and the connectors.
• Apply proper tightening torque to all wire connections.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
UNEXPECTED OPERATION
Do not energise the primary circuit before this protection relay is properly
configured.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or
equipment damage.
P5/EN M/44D 37
Protection Relay Installation
38 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
Handling
Protective relays, although generally of robust construction, require careful
handling: handle the PowerLogic P5 protection relays in their original packing in
order to help protect it against damage.
If installed in a cubicle: should the protection relay fall out of a cubicle, check its
condition by visual inspection and energising.
Storage
NOTICE
WATER DAMAGE
• Do not expose the products to sustained humidity during storage.
• Electrically energise the products within three months of unpacking.
• Where electrical equipment is being installed, allow sufficient time for
acclimatisation to the ambient temperature of the environment before
powering on.
• Supply power to the protection relay every two years for at least one hour.
Failure to follow these instructions can reduce the product life span.
P5/EN M/44D 39
Protection Relay Installation
Unpacking
Equipment receipt
NOTICE
PRODUCT TAMPERING
Our products leave our factory in closed, sealed original packaging. At delivery,
if the packaging is opened or the seal is broken, Schneider Electric must be
informed.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in compromised
confidentiality and authenticity of the information contained in the
products.
Package contents
Each PowerLogic P5 protection relay is delivered in an independent package
containing:
• An PowerLogic P5 protection relay
◦ 1a: PowerLogic P5x20
◦ 1b: PowerLogic P5x30
• A certificate of conformity ②
• An installation sheet providing main information about installation and use ③
• One plastic bag including a set of labels and stickers, and the cabling kit for
connector A
◦ 4a-1: pack for PowerLogic P5x20 of CT/VT analogue input type
◦ 4a-2: pack for PowerLogic P5U20 of LPCT/LPVT analogue input type
◦ 4b-1: pack for PowerLogic P5x30 of CT/VT analogue input type
◦ 4b-2: pack for PowerLogic P5x30 of LPCT/LPVT analogue input type
• One plastic bag including one to four rear connectors
◦ 5a: pack for PowerLogic P5x20
◦ 5b: pack for PowerLogic P5x30
4a-1
Protectio P5F20
n relay
en
1a
Instruction
Retain
Go to for sheet
future
www.schneid
to download use
reference er-electric.co
the
documents.manual PowerLogic
The
and m QR
IMPORTANT other P5F20 gives code
This websitea direct (front panel
and device NOTE access of
servicedmust
electrical to your the relay)
be installed
by qualified relay’s
Schneider personnel.
responsibleElectric
the
instructions
instruction cannot
for failure
en be held
to follow
sheet.given on
this
Equipme
nt receipt
03/2014
Schneider 1
35 rue Electric
92500 Joseph Industries
en Equipment
Monier
France Rueil-Malmais 2 1
SAS Protection receipt
www.schneide 3 2
on Certificate relay
xxxxxxx
r-electric.com 4 of compliance
Instruction
5
Connector sheet
6
Connector(s) A cabling
© 2014
All rights Schneider kit
reserved. Electric.
4a-2
4b-1
4b-2
5a 5b
P533G0A
40 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
P5/EN M/44D 41
Protection Relay Installation
Equipment identification
Different kinds of labels and stickers are used on the PowerLogic P5 protection
relay to identify its model type and its different components.
1 1
2 2 P533G1A
② Reference label
Reference label
The reference label contains the commercial reference, the serial number, the
power supply voltage of the relay and a QR code. The QR code can be used to
access the specific product website through mySchneider App (available in App
Store and Google Store) to get basic product documents and product life cycle
documents like Certificate of Conformity and Test.
1
4
2
P5
DC
AC
3
P5U20W211647230001
P533G2A
1 4
2
P5
DC
AC
3
P5F30W211647230001
P533G3A
② Reference
③ Serial number
④ Access to product website
42 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
P533RSB
As built configuration
The information about model number, serial number and firmware number can be
found on the bottom side of rear panel connection instructions label, as shown
above. It informs on how the product was built and left the factory. If there are
further manipulations on the product (for example, firmware upgrade), it is
recommended to update the information on the label.
P5/EN M/44D 43
Protection Relay Installation
2
P533G5A
ETH Dual port copper (RJ45) or fibreoptic (multi-mode glass fibre) Ethernet ports
EXT Extension port for connection with external module and demodulated IRIG-B input
or back-up memory
44 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
P533G6A
P5/EN M/44D 45
Protection Relay Installation
Dimensions
Product dimensions
Dimensions of the PowerLogic P5 protection relays are shown below:
53.4
51.8 2.10
2.04
98.8
3.89
P533G7A
53.4
103.6
2.10
4.08
150.3
5.92
P533G8A
46 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
158
6.22
43
1.69 P533G9A
Rear clearances
For easy access to the rear panel, the rear clearances illustrated below are
recommended:
60
2.36
2
140
5.51
P533GAA
P5/EN M/44D 47
Protection Relay Installation
Operating environment
Operating temperature and humidity
NOTICE
POTENTIAL DAMAGE FROM ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITIONS
• The PowerLogic P5 protection relay must be installed in an environment
within the specified operation temperature and humidity.
• The protection relay may not operate correctly if condensation occurs on the
electronic boards inside the device.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay is intended for indoor installation and use
only. If it is required for use in an outdoor environment, it must be mounted in a
specific cabinet that will enable it to meet the requirements of IEC 60529 with the
classification of protection degree IP54 (dust and splashing water protected).
The temperature/relative humidity factors must be compatible with the
environmental withstand characteristics of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay:
• Recommended operating range of temperature: -10℃ to +55℃ (+14℉ to
+131℉).
• Maximum operating temperature: -40℃ to +70℃ (-40℉ to +158℉).
• Average humidity: <75% RH over the year.
• Temporary permissible humidity: <93% RH (less than 80 hours per year)
• No condensation.
If the operating conditions are outside the normal range, special arrangements
should be made before commissioning, such as air conditioning of the premises.
48 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
Mounting
General mounting operations
Mounting the protection relay in panels or on rack frame
The PowerLogic P5 protection relays are available for flush mounting or rack
mounting.
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay is fixed by four M4 x 20 mm (0.787 in.)
stainless steel self-tapping screws with stainless steel washers (with diameter 4 x
8 mm (0.157 x 0.315 in.) maximum) at lower and upper parts.
P533GBB
P533GCB
P5/EN M/44D 49
Protection Relay Installation
P5x20 P5x30
x3 x4
P533GDB
2
P533GEA
50 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
The handle on the front face of the protection relay is used to separate the
withdrawable part from the fixed outer case. In order to help prevent unauthorised
dismantling fix the lock tab on the handle with a wired lead seal to restrict the
rotation of the handle.
P533GFB
CAUTION
CUTS AND PHYSICAL IMPACT
• Wear gloves and safety shoes.
• Trim the edges of the cut-out plates to remove any jagged edges.
• Carry the assembled relay with withdrawable part locked.
• When cases are mounted on a rack (with withdrawable part not inserted),
stay far enough from the protruding part(s) of the case(s).
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment
damage.
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay can be mounted onto panels with the
provided accessory. It is recommended to use the flush mounting with accessory
for PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
Mounting Procedure
P5/EN M/44D 51
Protection Relay Installation
1. Prepare the cut out in the panel according to the following dimensions.
8.07 ± 0.2
205 ± 0.5
8.07 ± 0.2
205 ± 0.5
P5x20 P5x30
P533GGA
2. Insert the flush mounting accessory ① in the panel ② and check that the rear
mounting supports ③ are accessible for panel mounting kits to be inserted.
1 2 1 2
3
REL51032 REL51052
P533GHA
3. Insert the panel mounting kits in the mounting support holes ① and then push
down the front parts (flush panel side) ② to lock the flush mounting accessory
on the panel.
P533GIA
52 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
4. Remove the top and bottom seal straps from the rear mounting surface of the
protection relay.
x2 x2
P533GJA
5. Insert the protection relay ② into the mounting accessory ① and hold it in the
mounting position.
1 2 1 2
P533GKA
6. Fix the protection relay on the accessory with the screws provided in the flush
mounting accessory.
P533GLB
P5/EN M/44D 53
Protection Relay Installation
CAUTION
CUTS AND PHYSICAL IMPACT
• Wear gloves and safety shoes.
• Trim the edges of the cut-out plates to remove any jagged edges.
• Carry the assembled relay with withdrawable part locked.
• When cases are mounted on a rack (with withdrawable part not inserted),
stay far enough from the protruding part(s) of the case(s).
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment
damage.
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay can be directly mounted onto panels without
any accessory.
Mounting Procedure
1. Prepare the cut-out in the panel for flush mounting according to the following
dimensions.
The thickness of the panel plate should be a minimum of 3 mm (0.12 in.).
54 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
P533GNA
P5/EN M/44D 55
Protection Relay Installation
Rack mounting
CAUTION
FALLING DEVICES
• Wear gloves and safety shoes.
• Carry the assembled relay with withdrawable part locked.
• When cases are mounted on a rack (with withdrawable part not inserted),
stay far enough from the protruding part(s) of the case(s).
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment
damage.
PowerLogic P5 protection relays may be rack mounted using single rack mounting
frames (ref: REL51021), as illustrated in the figure below.
F0187-1
P533GOA
The two horizontal rails of the rack frame have holes drilled at approximately 26
mm (10 in.) intervals. The PowerLogic P5 protection relays are attached via their
mounting flanges using M4 x 20 mm (0.787 in.) stainless steel self-tapping screws
with stainless steel washers (diameter 4 x 8 mm (0.157 x 0.315 in.) maximum).
Relays can be mechanically grouped into single tier or multi-tier arrangements by
means of the rack frame. This enables schemes using products from the
PowerLogic P5 product ranges to be pre-wired together prior to mounting (rack
mounting with M4 self-tapping screws, washers and nut).
Mounting Procedure
1. Insert the PowerLogic P5 protection relay ② into the rack frame ①.
1
2
P533GPA
56 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
2. Fasten the protection relay onto the rack frame using four M4 x 20 mm (0.787
in.) stainless steel self-tapping screws with stainless steel washers (diameter
4 x 8 mm (0.157 x 0.315 in.) maximum).
Figure 27 - Fasten the protection relay onto the rack frame (PowerLogic
P5x20 shown as an example)
P533GQB
3. Cover up the open section of the rack frame with blank plates if there is still
space left for future installation of protection relays or ancillary components.
P533GRB
Subsequent operation Mount the rack frame on the rack using the mounting flanges on
both sides of the frame.
P5/EN M/44D 57
Protection Relay Installation
P533GSA
✔ ✔ B: Power supply
NOTE: For the slot occupation rules of PowerLogic P5x30 slot C, D and E,
refer to Slot occupation rules, page 580.
58 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
A B C
1 1
1 2 2 2
3 3
3 4 4 4
5 5
5 6 6 6
7 7
7 8 8 8
9 9
10 10
9 10 11 11
12 12
11 12 13 13
14 14
13 14 15 15
16 16
15 16 17 17
18 18
17 18 19 19
20
20
M N P P533GTA
A B C C C
7 8 DI7 8 8 8
DO1 9 DI8 9 DO1 9 DI5 9
8 C C
10 DI9 10 10 10
9 C
IA IA DO2 11 DI10 11 11 DI6 11
C
10 12 DI11 12 DO2 12 12
C
C
11 13 DI12 13 13 DO1 13
S
IB IB C
12 DO3 C
14 14 14 14
15 DO1 15 DO3 15 DO2 15
S C S
13
IC IC WD 16 DO2 S
16 16 16
14 17 17 DO4 17 DO3 17
HS S
15 18 DO3 18 18 18
20 A IN S
16 19 DO4 19 DO5 19 DO4 19
S HS S
20 20 20 20
IN 17 24-250 V DC
2A .sens 18 100-230 V AC
P533RTB
Optional
-S Signalling, 2 A perm.
P5/EN M/44D 59
Protection Relay Installation
A B C
1 1
2 2
A 1 3 3
4 4
5 5
2 6 6
B 7 7
8 8
3 9 9
10 10
C 11 11
4 12 12
13 13
V1 14 14
V2 15 15
V3 16 16
17 17
V4 18 18
19 19
20
20
M N P P533GVB
A B C C C
P533RAB
Optional
-S Signalling, 2 A perm.
60 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
A B C
1 1
1 2 2 2
3 3
3 4 4 4
5 5
5 6 6 6
7 7
7 8 8 8
9 9
10 10
9 10 11 11
12 12
11 12 13 13
14 14
13 14 15 15
16 16
15 16 17 17
18 18
17 18 19 19
20
20
M N P P533GXA
A B C C C
7 8 DI7 8 8 8
V4 DO1 9 DI8 9 DO1 C 9 DI5 9
8 C
10 DI9 10 10 10
9 C
DO2 11 DI10 11 11 DI6 11
C
10 12 DI11 12 DO2 C 12 12
C
11 13 DI12 13 13 DO1 13
C S
12 DO3 C
14 14 14 14
15 DO1 15 DO3 15 DO2 15
S C S
13
Not used WD 16 DO2 S
16 16 16
14 17 17 DO4 17 DO3 17
HS S
15 18 DO3 18 18 18
S
16 19 DO4 19 DO5 19 DO4 19
S HS S
20 20 20 20
17 24-250 V DC
18 100-230 V AC
P533RBB
Optional
-S Signalling, 2 A perm.
P5/EN M/44D 61
Protection Relay Installation
D E A B C
1 1 1 1
2 2 1 2 2 2
3 3 3 3
4 4 3 4 4 4
5 5 5 5
6 6 5 6 6 6
7 7 7 7
8 8 7 8 8 8
9 9 9 9
10 10 10 10
11 11 9 10 11 11
12 12 12 12
13 13 11 12 13 13
14 14 14 14
15 15 13 14 15 15
16 16 16 16
17 17 15 16 17 17
18 18 18 18
19 19 17 18 19 19
20 20 20 20
L M N P P533GZA
A B C D E C D E C D E D E
P533RCA
Optional
-S Signalling, 2 A perm.
62 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
D E A B C
1 1 1 1
2 2 2 2
3 3 3 3
1
4 4 L1 4 4
5 5 5 5
6 6 2 6 6
7 7 7 7
8 8 L2 8 8
9 9 3 9 9
10 10 10 10
11 11 L3 11 11
12 12 4 12 12
13 13 13 13
14 14 V1 14 14
15 15 V2 15 15
16 16 V3 16 16
17 17 17 17
18 18 V4 18 18
19 19 19 19
20 20 20 20
L M N P
P533H1A
A B C D E C D E C D E D E
P533RDA
Optional
-S Signalling, 2 A perm.
P5/EN M/44D 63
Protection Relay Installation
D E A B C
1 1 1 1
2 2 1 2 2 2
3 3 3 3
4 4 3 4 4 4
5 5 5 5
6 6 5 6 6 6
7 7 7 7
8 8 7 8 8 8
9 9 9 9
10 10 10 10
11 11 9 10 11 11
12 12 12 12
13 13 11 12 13 13
14 14 14 14
15 15 13 14 15 15
16 16 16 16
17 17 15 16 17 17
18 18 18 18
19 19 17 18 19 19
20 20 20 20
L M N P P533GZA
A B C D E C D E C D E D E
P533TEA
Optional
-S Signalling, 2 A perm.
64 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
DI1 CB open
DI2 CB close
DI3 Free
DI4 Free
DO1 CB trip
DO3 CB close
WD Watchdog (not configurable)
P5/EN M/44D 65
Protection Relay Installation
S1 A9 S1 A9
1/5 A A10 IA 1/5 A A10
IA
S1 A11 S1 A11
A12 IB A12
IB
S1 A13 S1 A13
A14 IC A14
IC
A15 A15
1/2/5 A A16 IN A16 IN
S1 A17 A17
1A 1A A18 IN.sens
A18 IN.sens
S1 S1
P533CHA
NOTE: For an application with 2 CTs, only IA and IC are used by PowerLogic
P5 protection relay (see figure below).
Such so-called 2 CT mode further requires firmware adjustment with setting
Number of connected phase CT = A/C in the GENERAL menu/Scaling sub-
menu. It impacts power measurements as well as protection and monitoring
functions using negative sequence currents as detailed in the function
descriptions.
A
B
C
S1 A9
1/5 A A10 IA
A11
A12
S1 A13
A14 IC
A15
1/2/5 A A16 IN
S1 A17
1A A18 IN.sens
S1
P533CIA
66 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
S1 A9 S1 A9
1/5 A A10 IA 1/5 A A10 IA
S1 A11 S1 A11
A12 IB A12 IB
S1 A13 S1 A13
A14 IC A14 IC
A15 A15
CSH
A16 IN A16
20 A S1 A17 A17
CSH
A18 A18 IN
2A
S1
P533CJA
NOTE: For an application with 2 CTs, only IA and IC are used by PowerLogic
P5 protection relay( see figure below).
Such so-called 2 CT mode further requires firmware adjustment with setting
Number of connected phase CT = A/C in the GENERAL menu/Scaling sub-
menu. It impacts power measurements as well as protection and monitoring
functions using negative sequence currents as detailed in the function
descriptions.
S1 A9 S1 A9
1/5 A A10 IA 1/5 A A10 IA
A11 A11
A12 A12
S1 A13 S1 A13
A14 IC A14 IC
A15 A15
CSH A16 IN A16
20 A S1 A17 A17
CSH IN
A18 A18
2A
S1
P533CKA
A
B
C
RJ45 IA
RJ45 IB
RJ45 IC
S1 A1
CSH IN
A2
20 A / 2A
A3
A4 IN
P533CLA
P5/EN M/44D 67
Protection Relay Installation
S1 A3 S1 A3
1/5 A A4 IA-1 1/5 A A4 IA-1
S1 A5 S1 A5
A6 IB-1 A6 IB-1
S1 A7 S1 A7
A8 IC-1 A8 IC-1
A9 A9
1/2/5 A A10 IN-1 A10 IN-1
S1
S1 A18 A18
1/2/5 A A17 IN-2 A17 IN-2
A16 A16
A15 IC-2 A15 IC-2
S1 S1
A14 A14
A13 IB-2 A13 IB-2
S1 S1
A12 A12
1/5 A A11 IA-2 1/5 A A11 IA-2
S1 S1
P533THC
NOTE: Figures show standard connection with phase CTs common points on
transformer side.
NOTE: Neutral CTs can also be used to measure the current in a star point
earthing/grounding of wye or zigzag connected transformer windings; or in the
measuring path of a high-impedance earth/ground fault protection scheme.
68 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
VT typical application
Voltage input terminals A2 and A4 have been connected internally. For three
phase to neutral applications, short terminals A4 and A6 together.
A
B
C
A1
A2 V1
A3
A4 V2
A5
A6 V3
A7
A8
P533CMB
A
B
C
A1
A2 V1
A3
A4 V2
A5
A6 V3
A7
A8 V4
P533CNB
P5/EN M/44D 69
Protection Relay Installation
A
B
C
A1
A2 V1
A3
A4 V2
A5
A6 V3
A7
A8 V4
P533COB
A
B
C
A1
A2 V1
A3
A4 V2
A5
A6 V3
A7
A8 V4
P533CPC
A
B
C
A1
A2 V1
A3
A4 V2
A5
A6 V3
A7
A8 V4
P533CQC
70 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
A
B
C
A1
A2 V1
A3
A4 V2
A5
A6
A7
A8 V4
P533CRB
A
B
C
A1
A2 V1
A3
A4
A5
A6 V3
A7
A8
P533CSC
A
B
C
A1
A2 V1
P533TIB
P5/EN M/44D 71
Protection Relay Installation
A
B
C
LPVT A
LPVT hub
connector
LPVT B
LPVT C
P533CTB
A
B
C
LPVT A
LPVT hub
connector
LPVT B
LPVT C
Termination
accessory
NOTE: If one or two LPVTs are connected to the LPVT hub connector, the
termination accessories should be plugged to the 2nd and third input. These
termination accessories are delivered with each LPCT/LPVT hardware variant
in accessories bag. In case the accessories are lost, it is recommended to
order spare part accessories for LPCT/LPVT variant (REL51079).
72 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
A
B
C
Cable between
adapter and relay < 10m
LPVT adapter
RJ45
V1, V2, V3
P533CWB
A
B
C
Cable between
adapter and relay < 10m
LPVT adapter
RJ45
V1, V2, V3
LPVT adapter
RJ45 V4
P533CYB
A
B
C
Cable between
adapter and relay < 10m
LPVT adapter
RJ45
V1, V2, V3
LPVT adapter
RJ45 V4
P533D0B
A
B
C
Cable between
adapter and relay < 10m
LPVT adapter
RJ45
V1, V2, V3
LPVT adapter
RJ45 V4
P533D2C
P5/EN M/44D 73
Protection Relay Installation
DANGER
FIRE HAZARD
Apply proper tightening torque to all wire connections.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Use the appropriate (3 or 4-terminal) copper jumper for common
connections.
• After cabling, protect the rear connector A with the two protective caps.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
3 5
×10
6
4 ×10
P533D4A
74 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
2
×4
3
×4
4
×2 P533D5A
P533CXA
P5/EN M/44D 75
Protection Relay Installation
2. Fasten the terminal jumper with the provided mounting screws and washers.
P533CZB
3. Connect the bent ring lug end of the cables to the terminal using the provided
mounting screws and washers.
P533D1B
REL51060 1.5 ... 2.5 mm2 (AWG 16 ... 14) Ring lug terminal 4.45 mm (0.18 in)
REL51061 2.5 ... 6 mm2 (AWG 14 ... 10) Ring lug terminal 6.35 mm (0.25 in)
76 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
4. After cabling, place and insert the protective caps on the terminal.
P533D3A
A
V1 1 2 V1 A1
V1
V2 3 4 V2 A2
V3 5 6 V3 A3
V2
V4 7 8 V4 A4
9 10 A5
V3 A6
11 12
A7
13 14 V4
A8
15 16
17 18 P533D6A
P5/EN M/44D 77
Protection Relay Installation
The phase voltage input of PowerLogic P5T30 is situated in the upper part of the
rear connector "A", terminals A1 and A2. The voltage measuring inputs are the
following:
A
V 1 2 V A1
V
3 4 A2
5 6 A3
7 8 A4
9 10 A5
A6
11 12
A7
13 14
A8
15 16
17 18 P533TFA
78 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
A
IA
IB 1
IC
IA IA 20 A IN
IB IB 2
IC IC 2 A IN.sens
IN/20 A IN/20 A
IN.sens/2 A IN.sens/2 A 3
P533D8A
① Current inputs
The current inputs of PowerLogic P5T30 are situated in the lower part of the rear
connector A, terminals A3 to A18. The current measuring inputs are the following:
A A3
IA-1
A4
A5
1 IB-1
IA-1 IA-1 A6
A7
IB-1 IB-1 IC-1 A8
A9
IC-1 IC-1 2 IN-1
A10
IN-1 IN-1 A11
IA-2 A12
IA-2 IA-2 A13
1 IB-2
IB-2 IB-2 A14
A15
IC-2 IC-2 IC-2
A16
IN-2 IN-2 A17
2 IN-2
A18
P533TGA
① Current inputs
P5/EN M/44D 79
Protection Relay Installation
1
P1 A 3
2
S1 A9
A10 IA
S2
S1 A11
A12 IB
S1 A13
A14 IC
1
S1 A17
A18 2A
S2
2 P533D7B
where:
① Terminal P121 (primary current).
② Terminal S121 (secondary current).
③ Connector A + terminal number.
Ⓐ Implementation of the cabling between the CTs and the connector:
• Conductors contained in the same strand, in a sheath
• Conductors run along the metal structures of the MV cubicle
Recommended cable for Schneider Electric's CSH120, CSH200, CSH300 and
GO110 core balance CTs:
• Sheathed cable (to be compliant with electromagnetic compatibility
requirements), shielded by tinned copper braid.
• Resistance per unit length < 100 mΩ/m (30.5 mΩ/ft).
• Minimum dielectric strength: 1000 V (700 Vrms).
• Connect the cable shielding in the shortest manner possible to PowerLogic
P5.
• Flatten the connection cable against the metal frames of the cubicle.
The maximum resistance of the connection wiring must not exceed 4 Ω (namely
20 m maximum for 100 mΩ/m or 66 ft maximum for 30.5 mΩ/ft).
Wiring details
Refer to the table below for the detailed information on wiring the screw-type input
connectors of the analogue module in slot A:
21. Markings of current transformer terminals S1, S2, P1 and P2 according to IEC 61869-1 Standard
80 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
LPCT inputs
NOTICE
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Use original cable from OEM with a cable no longer than 10 m (32.8 ft) for EMC
immunity.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in improper operation.
A
1
20A
2
RJ45 IA 3
2A 4
RJ45 IB IA RJ45-1
IB RJ45-2
RJ45 IC
IC
RJ45-3
V4 RJ45-5
P533D9B
Rated primary current factor 0.25 - 0.50 - 1.00 - 1.25 - 1.33 - This configuration parameter
2.00 - 2.50 - 3.20 - 4.00 - 5.00 - corresponds to the rated
6.30 - 6.66 - 10 - 16 - 20 - 31.5 extended primary current
factor of the LPCT
P5/EN M/44D 81
Protection Relay Installation
LPVT inputs
NOTICE
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Use original cable from OEM to connect to the hub or merger. The total cable
length between LPVT and P5 has to be no longer than 10 m (32.8 ft) for EMC
immunity.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in improper operation.
A
1
20A
2
3
2A 4
IA RJ45-1
IB RJ45-2
IC RJ45-3
RJ45 VN VN RJ45-5
P533DIA
More generally the LPVTs inputs must be compliant with the IEC61869-11
standard.
The table below lists the technical data concerning the ratings and limits of the
LPVT channels:
Parameter Value
Rated secondary voltage 3.25 V / √3
Extended rated voltage 0.25 to 1.5 rated voltage
82 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
DI1 DI3
DI2 DI4
P533REB
P533RFB
NOTICE
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATION
When connecting the digital inputs:
• Avoid large cabling loops in the various power supplies.
• Do not short-circuit any of the galvanic insulation.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in improper operation or
equipment damage.
When the environmental and installation conditions are highly unfavorable for the
PowerLogic P5 protection relay, a shielded twisted pair should be used. In such
cases, the cable shielding is connected to the local earth/ground at both ends
(provided that the installation has an equipotential bonding network).
P5/EN M/44D 83
Protection Relay Installation
DANGER
FIRE HAZARD
• Protect the power supplying circuit of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay
against overcurrents.
• For breaking capacity higher than 40W with L/R = 40 ms, protect the digital
output contacts with an additional customer protection (RC or zener diode).
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
The power supply range and inrush currents are provided for easier selection of
Miniature Circuit Breaker (MCB).
NOTICE
POWER SUPPLY DAMAGE
Before connecting the auxiliary voltage to the PowerLogic P5 protection relay,
make sure the nominal value of the auxiliary device voltage corresponds with
the nominal value of the auxiliary system voltage.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
B19
B20
P533DLA
Digital inputs/outputs
The digital 4-input/4-output module (4I4O) is always mounted in slot B of an
PowerLogic P5 protection relay. Digital outputs DO1, DO2 and DO3 are
specifically enhanced for circuit breaker (CB) control. Digital output WD is defined
as a Watchdog.
The operating nominal voltage for digital inputs is:
• 24 V DC to 250 V DC
84 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
• 90 V AC to 230 V AC
The configuration of the 20-terminal connector of the module is shown in the
following figure:
B DI1 1
2
3
1 DI1
2 DI2 4
3 5
4 DI2
5 DI3 6
6 DI3 DI4 7
7
8 DI4 8
9
DO1 DO1 9
10 HS
11 10
12 DO2
13 DO2 11
C
14 12
15 DO3 C
16 13
17 WD DO3 14
18 C
19 15
20 Power supply
WD 16
17
18
19
20 P533RGB
Watchdog
The watchdog (self-monitoring) is a changeover contact provided on slot B, digital
output WD, to indicate the health of the device (refer to Watchdog relay, page
551). Schneider Electric strongly recommends that these contacts are hardwired
into the substation's automation system for alarm purposes.
B16
16
17 B17
18
B18
P533DNA
P5/EN M/44D 85
Protection Relay Installation
P533RHB
NOTICE
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Specific wiring requirements for counting input 12I4O DI1:
• Unshielded twisted pair cable between pin 1 and pin 7
• 0.4 to 1.5 mm² cross section
• Example of recommended cable : Belden 9409 or equivalent
• No earth/ground connection on the PowerLogic P5 side or on the other side
to keep the line symmetrical
• Maximum cable length: 10 m
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
NOTICE
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATION
If the counting input DI1 on 12I4O is selected, this input cannot be used by any
other protection functions.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
86 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
D E DI1 1
2
DI2 3
4
DI1 DI3 5
6
DI2
DO1 C
7
DI3
8
DO1 DO2 9
C
10
DO2 C
11
DO3 DO3 S
12
13
Arc1 14
Arc2 Arc1 15
L> 16
Arc3
Arc2 17
L> 18
Arc3 19
L> 20
P533RIB
P533DQA
Subsequent operation After installing the connectors, stick the connector identification labels
included in the package on the rear panel above the connectors.
P5/EN M/44D 87
Protection Relay Installation
Single wire: 0.4 ... 0.5 N·m (—) 2.5 mm (3/32 in.)
0.2 ... 2.5 mm2 (3.5 ... 4.4 lb-in) flat blade screwdriver
(AWG 24 ... 14)
Double wires:
L P533DRA 0.2 ... 1.5 mm2
(AWG 24 ... 16)
Contact tip length
L = 12 mm (0.5 in.)
P533DSA
P533DTA
P533DUA
P533DVA
P533DWA
Connecting earth/ground
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Connect the PowerLogic P5 protection relay to earth/ground with a nut and
washer using any of the indicated stud terminals (see Fixing the earthing/
grounding cable to the PowerLogic P5 protection relay, page 89 below).
• Check equipotential earthing/grounding network and test earth/ground
during installation.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
The earth/ground connections are accessible on the rear panel of the protection
relays. For PowerLogic P5x20, there are two connectors located in the bottom left
88 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
and right corner of the protection relays; for PowerLogic P5x30, there are three,
one in the bottom right corner and the other two near Connector A.
P533DXA
P533DYA
3 P533DZA
Every PowerLogic P5 must be connected to the local earth/ground bar using one
M4 earth/ground stud on the relay case to help prevent dangerous voltages being
present in case of a wiring fault or damage to the product. Also, it helps ensure
that the PowerLogic P5 protection relay meets EMC claims.
P5/EN M/44D 89
Protection Relay Installation
The minimum recommended wire size is 2.5 mm² (AWG 14) and should have a
ring terminal at the relay end. Due to the limitations of the ring terminal, the
maximum wire size that can be used is 6.0 mm² (AWG 10) per wire.
90 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
NOTICE
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Use RJ45 cable no longer than 10 m (32.8 ft).
Failure to follow these instructions can result in improper operation.
Slot M Dual port Ethernet TP or fibre optic module, configurable to RSTP redundancy
mode or Dual IP mode without redundancy
Slot P Single extension port for connection with external module and demodulated IRIG-
B input and Back-up memory
P5/EN M/44D 91
Protection Relay Installation
NOTICE
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATION
• Check and make sure the communication modules are locked on the
protection relay.
• Never plug in or draw out the communication modules while the PowerLogic
P5 protection relay is in service, otherwise the PowerLogic P5 protection
relay will reboot and consequently lose the setting changes made within the
last 30 minutes.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in setting change erasure
and consequently mis-operation of the protection relay.
92 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
P533M4A
Characteristics
Location Slot L
Connection 2 x RJ45 connectors with communication indicators
P533M6A
Protocol TP or RSTP
Maximum cable length 10 m (32.8 ft)
P5/EN M/44D 93
Protection Relay Installation
1 2
P533M7A
Characteristics
Location Slot M
P533M6A
Protocol TP or RSTP
Maximum cable length 10 m (32.8 ft)
94 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
CAUTION
EYE DAMAGE AND BLINDNESS
Never look into the end of the fibre optic.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in serious injury.
NOTICE
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATON
• Use only Schneider approved optical transceiver components.
• Never replace the optical transceiver components with unauthorised
manufactured parts.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
Use optical power meters to determine the operation or signal level of the device.
If electrical-to-optical converters are used, they must have management of
character idle state capability (when the fibre optic cable interface is "Light off").
Specific care should be taken with the bending radius of the fibres, and the use of
optical shunts is not recommended as these can decrease the communication
performance of the transmission path over time.
Characteristics
Location Slot M
Connection 2 LC connectors
P533M9A
Protocol TP or RSTP
Maximum attenuation (fibre optic + connectors) 14 dB (at fibre optic diameter: 62,5/125 μm or
50/125 μm)
P5/EN M/44D 95
Protection Relay Installation
1 2
P533MAA
VW3A8306RC 1 nF 120 Ω
4
1 nF 120 Ω 5
4 1
2
5 1 nF 120 Ω
P533MBA
The internal polarisation resistor 620 Ω can be enabled or disabled with eSetup
Easergy Pro (see parameter "pull line" in the communication manual).
In order to avoid signal reflections on the line, data transmission lines should
always be terminated with a RC terminating impedance (120 Ω/1 nF, reference
VW3A8306RC), or with a 4 line option that includes 2 pairs of 120 Ω/1 nF RC
terminating impedance, fitted at both ends across the signal wires.
P533MCA
96 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
Characteristics
Location Slot N
P533M6A
Protocol TP or RSTP
Line polarisation 620 Ω
1 8
P533RWA
EIA-485-2
1 1
4 4
5 5
8 8
EIA-485-4
1 1
2 2
4 4
5 5
8 8
P533MDB
A B C D E
1
2
4 D1 TX+ L+ L+ L+
5 D0 TX- L- L- L- G
8 GND GND
SHLD
F
P533SPA
C Slave 1 D Slave 2
E Slave 3 F Shield
G Termination
P5/EN M/44D 97
Protection Relay Installation
CAUTION
EYE DAMAGE AND BLINDNESS
Never look into the end of the fibre optic.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in serious injury.
Use optical power meters to determine the operation or signal level of the device.
If electrical-to-optical converters are used, they must have management of
character idle state capability (for when the fibre optic cable interface is "Light
off").
Specific care should be taken with the bending radius of the fibres, and the use of
optical shunts is not recommended as these can decrease the performance of the
transmission path over time.
The relay uses 1300 nm multi-mode 100BaseFx ST(BFOC) 2.5 connectors (one
Tx/optical emitter, one Rx/optical receiver).
Characteristics
Location Slot N
98 P5/EN M/44D
Installation Protection Relay
P533MGA
NOTICE
ETHERNET PORT DAMAGE
Connect only PowerLogic P5 accessories to the extension module.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
Characteristics
Location Slot P
P533M6A
P5/EN M/44D 99
Protection Relay Installation
P533MHA
CAUTION
EYE DAMAGE AND BLINDNESS
Never look into the end of the fibre optic.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in serious injury.
Use optical power meters to determine the operation or signal level of the device.
If electrical-to-optical converters are used, they must have management of
character idle state capability (when the fibre optic cable interface is "Light off").
Specific care should be taken with the bending radius of the fibres, and the use of
optical shunts is not recommended as these can decrease the communication
performance of the transmission path over time.
Characteristics
Location Both slot M and N
Connection 2 LC connectors
P533M9A
Other accessories
CSH120 (reference 59635), CSH200 (reference 59636), CSH300
(reference 59637) and GO110 (reference 50134)
Description
The CSH120, CSH200, CSH300 and GO110 core balance current transformers
(CT) are designed for direct neutral current measurement. Due to their low voltage
insulation, they can only be used around insulated cables.
CSH300 ①, CSH200 ② and CSH120 ③ are closed CTs, with different inner
diameters:
• CSH300 ① inner diameter: 291mm (11.46 in.)
• CSH200 ② inner diameter: 196 mm (7.72 in.)
• CSH120 ③ inner diameter: 120 mm (4.72 in.)
GO110 ④ is a split CT, with an inner diameter of 110 mm (4.33 in.).
NOTE: GO110 core balance transformer is not sold anymore. However, for
any refurbishing projects, the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is compliant with
this core balance transformer and therefore can be connected together as
shown in Typical application diagrams, page 66.
F0550
P533H3A
Dimensions
Figure 97 - CSH120, CSH 200 and CSH300 dimensions
4 x ØM 4 x ØN
F ØA H K B
J L
E D
P533H4A
A B D E F H J K L M N
CSH120 120 mm 164 mm 44 mm 190 mm 80 mm 40 mm 166 mm 65 mm 35 mm 6 mm 5 mm
(4.72 in.) (6.46 in.) (1.73 in.) (7.48 in.) (3.15 in.) (1.57 in) (6.54 in.) (2.56 in.) (1.38 in.) (0.24 in.) (0.2 in.)
D
T1 T1 M5
E
C
T2
ØB
T2
ØA
G F
P533H5B
A B D E F G
110 mm (4.33 in.) 224 mm (8.82 in.) 92 mm (3.62 in.) 16 mm (0.63 in.) 44 mm (1.73 in.) 8 mm (0.31 in.)
Assembly
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Only qualified personnel should install this equipment. Such work should be
performed only after reading this entire set of instructions.
• NEVER work alone.
• Turn off all power supplying this equipment before working on or inside it.
Consider all sources of power, including the possibility of backreading.
• Always use a properly rated voltage sensing device to confirm that all power
is off.
• Only CSH120, CSH200 and GO110 core balance CTs can be used for direct
neutral current measurement.
• Install the core balance CTs on insulated cables.
• Cables with a rated voltage of more than 1000 V must also have an earthed/
grounded shielding.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Select a CT with a diameter at least twice the size of the cable harness going through it.
Group the cable(s) in the middle of the CT and use non-conducting binding to hold the CT
in place around the cable harness.
Do not bend the cable(s) close to the CT; install the CT on a straight section of the cable(s)
that is at least twice as long as the CT diameter.
Remember to pass the shielded earthing/grounding braid on the cables back through the
CT. Check that the braid goes the right way through the CT.
When assembling the core balance CTs, group the medium voltage cable (or
cables) in the middle of the core balance CT, use non-conductive binding to hold
the cables, and remember to insert the shielded earthing/grounding braid of the
medium voltage cable through the core balance.
Connection
Recommended cable:
• Sheathed cable (to be compliant with electromagnetic compatibility
requirements), shielded by tinned copper braid.
• Resistance per unit length < 100 mΩ/m (30.5 mΩ/ft).
• Minimum dielectric strength: 1000 V (700 Vrms).
• Connect the cable shielding in the shortest manner possible to the protection
relay.
• Flatten the connection cable against the metal frames of the cubicle.
The maximum resistance of the connection wiring must not exceed 4 Ω (in other
word, 20 m maximum for 100 mΩ/m or 66 ft maximum for 30.5 mΩ/ft).
A15/A17
A16/A18
P533H6B
A CSH 20 A input on P5: terminals A15–A16 on standard CV/VT board or A1–A2 on LPCT/
LPVT board
CSH 2 A input on P5: terminals A17–A18 on standard CV/VT board or A3–A4 on LPCT/
LPVT board
Note that for specific application, it is possible to connect 2 CSH200 core balance
CTs in parallel, for example, when the medium-voltage cables have a large
diameter, and the installation uses 2 or 3 conductors per phase.
NOTICE
UNINTENDED AND NUISANCE TRIPPING
The shield of the CSH cable must be connected to the nearest PowerLogic P5
protection relay stud with a cable of less than 12 cm (4.72 in.).
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment misoperation.
Characteristics
Table 15 - Characteristics of the core balance CTs
Transformation 470/1
ratio
Maximum 20 kA - 1s
permissible
current (1CT)
Dimensions
The CSH30 is mounted on symmetrical DIN rail, either in vertical or horizontal
position.
Mechanical dimensions are given in the figure below:
1.18
1.97 0.63
3.23 0.2
0.18
0.315
2.36 1.14
P533TOA
Connection
Recommended cable:
• Sheathed cable, shielded by tinned copper braid
• Minimum cable cross-section 0.93 mm² (AWG 18) (max. 2.5 mm², AWG 12)
• Resistance per unit length < 100 mΩ/m (30.5 mΩ/ft)
• Minimum dielectric strength: 1000 V (700 Vrms)
• Maximum length: 2 m (6.6 ft)
The connection cable shielding is grounded in PowerLogic P5. Do not ground the
cable by any other means.
A
B
C
1/5 A S1
A
2 1
A1
A2 IN
B
P533TPA
Characteristic
Table 16 - Characteristics of the interposing CSH30
Characteristics CSH30
Weight 0.12 kg (0.265 lb)
LPVT L3
LPVT L2
LPVT L1
OUT
P533H7A
Connection
The LPVT hub connector is connected to the protection relay through its RJ45
output connector and to the LPVT sensors through the RJ45 input connectors.
LPVT L3 LPVT L3
LPVT L2 LPVT L2
LPVT L1 LPVT L1
OUT OUT
P533H8A
Characteristics
Table 17 - Characteristics of the LPVT hub connector
Characteristics Values
Electric
Input voltage < 10 V
Form factor
Dimension (L x W x H) 95 mm x 40 mm x 40 mm (3.74 x 1.57 x 1.57 in)
Environment
IP degree of protection IEC 60529 IP30
Connection
NOTICE
INCORRECT VOLTAGE MEASUREMENT
• The earth/ground of the connection diagrams below must be the same of the
whole PowerLogic P5 protection relay. The 0 V of the PowerLogic P5 power
supply input must be connected to this earth/ground.
• Earth/ground connection point of AC voltage adapter must be connected to
the isolated ground of VT sensor (LV transformer). For other wiring cases,
please consult Schneider Electric.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in measurement error.
A
B
C
RJ45 cable
Brown
Black
Grey
Ground connection
point of voltage adapter
P533H9B
A
B
C
RJ45 cable
Brown
Black
Grey
Ground connection
point of voltage adapter
P533HAB
A
B
C
RJ45 cable
Black
Ground connection
point of voltage adapter
P533HBB
A
B
C
A RJ45 cable
Ground connection
point of voltage adapter
P533HCC
A Cable:
• Black for P5x30
• Brown for P5U20
Dimensions
Figure 110 - External dimensions of the AC voltage adapter
B C
P533HEA
A B C D E
120 mm (4.72 in.) 38 mm (1.49 in.) 52 mm (2.04 in.) 90 mm (3.54 in.) 25 mm (0.98 in.)
Mounting
DIN rail mounting Fastening with collar Mounting on telequick grid
Screw
Click!
Screw
P533HFA
P533HHA
Mounting the adapter by its Mounting the adapter using Mounting the adapter on
fixture structure on rail two fastening collars (width: 4 Telequick grid using two
mm/0.16 in) screws (4 mm/0.16 in)
P533HGB P533RVA
Characteristics
Table 18 - Characteristics of the voltage adapter
Humidity IEC 60068-2-30 95% HR; 144 hours (6 cycles of 12 hours at 55°C
(131°F) and another 12 hours at 25°C (77°F))
P533ONA
Its purpose is to close the loop of the sensor presence detection on pins 3-6 of the
RJ45 and to zero the low voltage inputs shorting the 3 others pairs of the RJ45
connector. (1-2, 4-5, 7-8)
8 PIN 5 PIN 1
7
6 PIN 4 PIN 2
5
4
3 PIN 3 PIN 7
2 1
1 1 PIN 6 PIN 8
P533HIA
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
Clean the arc sensor periodically as instructed in this user manual and after an
arc-flash fault.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Description
The arc-flash sensors are used by PowerLogic P5x30 to detect light coming from
an arc-flash incident. They are installed in the protection zone and connected to
the connector terminal on the protection relay.
The arc-flash sensor is activated by strong light caused by an arcing fault. The
sensor transforms light information into a current signal, which is used by the
protection relay to detect an arc-flash and provides the corresponding protection
function.
Dimensions
Figure 114 - Dimensions of the standard arc-flash sensors
mm 22.2
in 0.83 20
14 0.79
0.55
0.39
10
25
1.83
46.4
0.98
8
0.31
4.2
0.17 P533HJA
11 62
0.43 2.44
P533HKA
Characteristics
Table 19 - Characteristics of the standard arc-flash sensors
Shielded - - ■ - - ■
cable
Halogen - ■ - ■ - -
free
Material Plastic
Weight (g/ 1,000/2.2 1,300/2.87 1,300/2.87 300/0.66 400/0.88 400/0.88
lb)
Loop Yes
supervi-
sion
Shielded cable - ■ - ■
Halogen free - - - -
Material Plastic
Weight (g/lb) 1,000/2.2 1,300/2.87 300/0.66 400/0.88
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
Never attempt to extend the length of arc-flash sensor cables.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
23. To connect the interface in the PowerLogic P5 protection relay, use REL52883 cable.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Apply appropriate personal protective equipment (PPE) and follow safe
electrical work practices. See NFPA 70E, NOM-029-STPS-2011, or
CSAZ462.
• The arc fault detection system is not a substitute for proper PPE when
working on or near equipment being monitored by the system.
• Information on this product is offered as a tool for conducting arc-flash
hazard analysis. It is intended for use only by qualified persons who are
knowledgeable about power system studies, power distribution equipment,
and equipment installation practices. It is not intended as a substitute for the
engineering judgement and adequate review necessary for such activities.
• Only qualified personnel should install and service this equipment. Read this
entire set of instructions and check the technical characteristics of the device
before performing such work.
• Perform wiring according to national standards (NEC) and any requirements
specified by the customer.
• Observe any separately marked notes and warnings.
• NEVER work alone.
• Before performing visual inspections, tests, or maintenance on this
equipment, disconnect all sources of electric power. Assume all circuits are
live until they are completely de-energised, tested, and tagged. Pay
particular attention to the design of the power system. Consider all sources
of power, including the possibility of back feeding.
• Always use a properly rated voltage sensing relay to ensure that all power is
off.
• The equipment must be properly grounded.
• Connect the device's protective ground to functional earth according to the
connection diagrams presented in this document.
• Do not open the device. It contains no user-serviceable parts.
• Install all devices, doors and covers before turning on the power to this
device.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Install arc-flash sensors inside the switchgear. There are two options for mounting
the sensors:
• in customer-drilled holes on the switchgear
• on VYX001 Z-shape or VYX002 L-shape mounting plates available from
Schneider Electric or locally fabricated from supplied drawings
59
2.32 2.5
42 0.1
1.65
10
0.39
15
50 0.59
7
1.97
0.28
P533HLA
15 59 15
0.59 2.32 0.59
3
0.12
30
1.18
30
1.18 P533HMA
P533HNA
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
Never attempt to extend the length of arc-flash sensor cables.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
D 15 +
Sensor 1
D 16 -
D 17 +
Sensor 2
D 18 -
D 19 +
Sensor 3
D 20 -
E 15 +
Sensor 4
E 16 -
E 17 +
Sensor 5
E 18 -
E 19 +
Sensor 6
E 20 -
P533HOA
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
Check that the temperature sensors are isolated from dangerous voltages.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Description
The temperature sensor module is an external module used for temperature
measurement with Resistance Temperature Detectors (RTDs). It is connected to
the extension module. It can be selected as an option when ordering the device or
purchased later and installed on site. It provides 8 RTD inputs.
Connection
Figure 121 - Connection of the MET148-2 temperature sensor module
Characteristics
Table 22 - Characteristics of the MET148-2 temperature sensor module
Characteristics Values
Dimensions (L × W × D) 144 mm × 88 mm × 30 mm
(5.67 in × 3.46 in × 1.81 in)24
Temperature sensors
Current to RTD 4 mA 4 mA
Maximum distance between sensor 1 km (0.62 mi)
and MET148-2
MOD
INP
UT
UNM
OD
INPUT
IRIG
0
GN
-B
EXT O
UT
EXT IN
P533HRA
Characteristics
Table 23 - Characteristics of the IRIG-B module
Characteristics Values
Standard
Standard IRIG 200-04
Form factor
Height 95 mm (3.7 in)
Connection
The IRIG-B module is connected to the PowerLogic P5 protection relay from its
EXT IN port. The cable used for connection must be shielded and of a length not
exceeding 10 m (32.8 ft).
The IRIG-B module provides an additional extension port (EXT OUT) for
connecting other accessories such as the MET148-2 module with CCA77x cords.
The time source is connected to the module through the modulated input, or
through the unmodulated input by connecting signal + to the IRIG-B terminal, and
signal - to the 0+ terminal.
NOTE: If one source is connected on the modulated input and another one on
the unmodulated input, the modulated signal has the priority.
5
8
2
EXT IN
T
EXT OU
3
MOD INPUT UNMOD INPUT 4
8
IRIG-B
0+
GND
P533HSA
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Install IRIG-B module between PowerLogic P5 protection relay and any
other accessories like MET148-2 temperature module.
• Do not interface any accessories between PowerLogic P5 protection relay
and IRIG-B module.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
CT requirements
WARNING
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATION
Select the CT size according to the requirement from the electric network.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or
equipment damage.
I
Is Isat
P533DAA
I
Is Isat
1.5 Min (Isc.max, 20 Is)
Min (Isc.max, 20 Is) P533DBA
The method for calculating the saturation current depends on the CT accuracy
class as indicated further below.
Practical information
In the absence of any information about the settings, the characteristics below are
suitable for most situations:
According to the test results, the CT dimensioning must comply with the following
requirements:
• a CT class 5P with an equivalent limiting secondary e.m.f. Eal greater or
equal to the maximum value calculated for the following conditions:
◦ to achieve fast trip during internal faults:
Eal.int ≥ 1.0 x If.int / Ipr x Isr x (RCT + Rb)
◦ and to keep stability for external faults:
Eal.ext ≥ 1.8 x If.ext / Ipr x Isr x (RCT + Rb)
where:
◦ If.int = Maximum primary fault current in case of internal fault
◦ If.ext = Maximum primary (through-flowing) fault current in case of external
fault
◦ Ipr = CT rated primary current
◦ Isr = CT rated secondary current (1 A or 5 A)
◦ RCT = CT secondary winding resistance (at 75°C)
◦ Rb = connected resistive burden
• or equivalent class PX CT with a kneepoint voltage VK ≥ 0.85 x max(Eal.int,Eal.
ext).
Hence if the actual CT load is less than its nominal burden (Rb.act < Rb.nom), a
higher short-circuit current can be transmitted without saturation.
Example:
A CT with the following characteristics is given:
• Transformation ratio: 100 A / 5 A
• Accuracy class and accuracy limit factor: 5P20
• Rated burden: 2.5 VA
• Resistance of the secondary winding: 0.1 Ω
To get an ALF of at least 20, namely, a saturation current of 20 x Iprim.nom = 2 kA,
the load resistance Rb of the CT must be less than:
VACT
Rb,max = = 0.1 Ω
Isec.nom2 P533PHA
This represents 12 m (39 ft) of wire with cross-section 2.5 mm² (AWG 14) for a
resistance per unit length of 8 mΩ/m (2.4 mΩ/ft) approximately.
For an installation with 50 m (164 ft) of wiring with section 2.5 mm² (AWG 14), the
actual resistance is Rb = 0.4 Ω, and hence actual ALF is:
with ρ = specific conductor resistance, for example, for copper 0.021 Ω mm²/m
at 75°C
l = wire length in [m]
A = wire cross section in [mm²]
The impedance of PowerLogic P5 protection relays current inputs (Rrel =
4 mΩ) is often negligible compared to the wiring resistance.
Vk I
Isat = × prim.nom
RCT + Rb Isec.nom
P533PKA
Examples:
CT with transformation ratio 100 A / 5 A, Vk = 20 V, RCT = 0.13 Ω, Rb = 0.4 Ω
20 100
Isat = × = 754 A
0.13 + 0.4 5
P533PJA
90 100
Isat = × = 2307A
3.5 + 0.4 1 P533PLA
LPCT configuration
Introduction
This section gives an overview of some reasons to move from traditional CT to
LPCT, what is an LPCT and how to configure them in eSetup Easergy Pro (at least
V3.0.0).
Further details, such as how to wire the LPCT or the VT adapter is described in the
following section.
Benefits of LPCTs
In short, the use of Low Power Instrument Current Transformers brings many
benefits through-out the project lifecycle, which are detailed below.
One LPCT can replace the needs of dedicated measurement and protection
CTs
As LPCTs commonly saturate much later than Inductive Current Transforms
(ICTs), they can allow fault measurement ranging from 5 kA to 80 kA primary.
The measurement accuracy of an LPCT could range from 5% of rated primary
current to the extended primary current. It may be specified as class 0.1, 0.2, 0.5,
or 1.
However, its protection accuracy could range from the extended primary current to
the accuracy limit of primary current. It may be specified as either class 5P, 10P or
5TPE.
For example, a 100 A LPCT may be labelled as 0.5/5P 25000 A, meaning:
M class = 0.5%, P class = 5P up to 25 kA (250 times primary current rating).
Because LPCTs have an extended rated primary current range, their application
scope is much wider, the LPCT primary rating is no longer required to be as close
as possible to the nominal current, and therefore no longer a major determining
factor in specifications.
For measurement class
In this example, a multipurpose normalized LPCT with a 100 A rated primary
current and a 1000 A extended primary current can be used in place of the 10
different ICTs with the following primary currents:
100, (125), 150, 200, (250), 300, (400), 500, (600), 750** (but not 1000**)
NOTE: ** An ICT has an extended primary current equal to only 120% of its
rated current.
• 750 A x 1.2 = 900 A is below the 1000 A extended primary current.
• 1000 A x 1.2 = 1200 A is above the 1000 A extended primary current.
If we know that the initial nominal current to be measured is between 100 A and
750 A, we can order a 100 A rated LPCT with 1000 A extended primary current
and still be flexible to last-minute changes or when load flow may increase
subsequently.
For protection class
Same example, a multipurpose normalized LPCT with a 100 A rated primary
current and a 1000 A extended primary current can be used in place of the 13
different ICTs with the following primary currents:
25, 50, 100, (125), 150, 200, (250), 300, (400), 500, (600), 750 and 1000
If we know that the initial nominal current for protection is between 25 and 1000 A,
we can order a 100 A rated LPCT with 1000 A extended primary current and still
be flexible to last-minute changes or when load flow may increase subsequently.
LPCT characteristics
The multipurpose LPCT is designed to measure from 5% of Ipr to kalf x Ipr and is
defined with a:
• Rated primary current (Ipr) (minimum current for measuring accuracy class)
• Rated extended primary current (Iepr = Ipr × Kpcr) (maximum current for
measuring accuracy class)
• Rated accuracy limit (Ikpr = Ipr × kalf) (maximum current for protection
accuracy class)
Figure 126 - Magnitude and phase errors across the measurement range
For example, the Schneider Electric LPCTs have the characteristics as shown
below.
Table 24 - Characteristics of the LPCT
2√2 I’’K C
iP
A
2√2 IK
P533S3A
E Time
NOTE:
• I''K = initial symmetrical short-circuit current
• iP = peak short-circuit current
• IK = steady-state short-circuit current
• id.c. = d.c. component of short-circuit current
• A = initial value of the d.c. component id.c.
• 2√2 I”K = For a fully offset fault current where I”K is the rms of the initial
fault current and 2√2 I”K is the peak to peak current
• 2√2 IK = the peak to peak value of the steady state short circuit current
LPVT configuration
Introduction
This section gives an overview of LPVTs, reasons to move from traditional VTs to
LPVTs, and how to configure them in eSetup Easergy Pro (at least V3.0.0).
Further details, such as how to wire the LPCT or the VT adapter is described in the
following section.
Benefits of LPVTs
In short, the use of Low Power Voltage Transformers brings many benefits
throughout the project lifecycle, which are detailed below.
One LPVT can replace the need of several nominal voltage rated VTs
An LPVT is now defined for a wider range of ratings compared to an Inductive
Voltage Transformer (IVT), for example, 3 to 20 kV, class 0.5P, from 2% to 190%
of its rated voltage which is better than the former 0.5 / 3P classification. The
effect of ferroresonance has disappeared as well.
For protection, the above LPVT can be used in place of the 5 different VTs with the
following primary voltages (in kV): 3, 6, 10, (15), 20.
LPVT characteristics
The multipurpose LPVT is designed to measure from 2% of Vpri (min) to 1.9 x Vpri
(Max) and is typically defined with a:
• Rated primary voltage Vpri
• Range of rated primary voltage (Vprimin, VpriMax) (minimum and maximum
voltage for measuring and protecting accuracy classes)
• Rated secondary voltage Vsec
For example, the Schneider Electric LPVTs have the following characteristics.
• Measure the resistance of R2 for each LPVT (RJ45 output pin 7&8)
• Set for each phase “VLx magnitude correction” to:
◦ ((R2+10000)/(R2+2000))/5 with R2 in kΩ
◦ For example, if R2 = 32.51 kΩ then VLx correction = 0.987
Benefits of VT adapter
Traditionally, a protection relay is either designed to be connected to CTs and VTs
or LPCTs and LPVTs. When the switchgear is equipped with LPCTs and VTs, it is
easier to adapt the VT outputs to low level signals compatible with the relay LPVT
inputs.
The nominal ratio is 50.6 and the accurate ratios are written on its label for each
phase.
10 9 ... 3 2 1
T T T T B
P533TAB
Figure 142 - LPVT sharing application including the 4th voltage (sync-check)
and with test sockets/plugs
10 9 3 2 1
...
D D D D
T T T T
T T T
B B
C C
A A
P533TBB
Commissioning
Principles
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• NEVER work alone.
• Only qualified personnel should commission this equipment. Such work
should be performed only after reading this entire set of instructions.
• Obey all existing safety instructions when commissioning and maintaining
high-voltage equipment.
• Beware of potential hazardous voltages from open circuited current
transformers, any voltage transformers and any capacitors which could be
charged to hazardous voltages.
• Before energising check that the protection relay and other devices are
connected to a protective earth/ground in accordance with the instructions
provided.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
DANGER
FIRE HAZARD
Apply proper tightening torque to all wire connections.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Never open the secondary circuit of a live CT since the high voltage
produced may be lethal to personnel and could damage insulation.
• The secondary of the line CT must be shorted before opening any
connections to it.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Apply appropriate personal protective equipment (PPE) and follow safe
electrical work practices. See NFPA 70E, CSA Z462 or national equivalent.
• Do not choose lower personal protective equipment (PPE) while working on
energised equipment.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
PowerLogic P5 protection relays are tested prior to commissioning, with the dual
aim of maximizing availability and minimizing the risk of malfunctioning of the
assembly being commissioned.
PowerLogic P5 protection relays are fully numerical in their design, implementing
all protection and non-protection functions in the firmware. The protection relays
use a high degree of self-checking and give an alarm. Therefore, the
commissioning tests do not need to be as extensive as with non-numeric
electronic or electro-mechanical relays.
To commission PowerLogic P5 protection relays, it is necessary to verify that the
hardware is functioning correctly and the application function settings have been
WARNING
UNEXPECTED OPERATION
Do not energise the primary circuit before this protection relay is properly
configured.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or
equipment damage.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Never open-circuit the secondary circuit of a current transformer because
the high voltage produced may be lethal. It could also damage the insulation.
• Before the test plug is inserted into the test block, make sure the sockets in
the test plug which correspond to the current transformer secondary
windings are linked.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
- Vaux + Vaux
1 2
VA
3 4
VB
5 6
7 8 VC
9 10 Output
11 12
+ Vaux
13 14 - Vaux
15 16 Trip
- Trip 17 18
+ Trip 19 20
Input
21 22
IA
23 24
IB
25 26
IC
27 28
IN
Shorting bar
P533I0B
Before inserting the test plug, refer to the scheme diagram. For example, the test
block may be associated with protection current transformer circuits. If a
PowerLogic P5 protection relay is installed in the switchgear, the test block is not
always provided. In the application case without a test block, it is mandatory to
isolate the voltage transformer supply to the PowerLogic P5 protection relay using
the panel links or connecting blocks, and to short-circuit and disconnect the line
current transformers from the protection relay terminals. Where means of isolating
the auxiliary power supply and trip circuit (such as isolation links, fuses and MCB)
are provided, these should be used. If this is impossible, the wiring to these
circuits must be disconnected and the exposed ends suitably terminated.
Visual inspection
The visual inspection should include the following aspects:
• Check the rating information on the PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
• Check that the PowerLogic P5 protection relay being tested is correct for the
protected objective.
• Check that the circuit reference and system details are entered onto the
setting record sheet (not provided).
• Carefully examine the PowerLogic P5 protection relay to see that no physical
damage has occurred since installation.
• Check that the case earthing/grounding connections, at the rear of the
protection relay case, are used to connect the protection relay to a local earth/
ground bar using an adequate conductor (see Connecting earth/ground, page
88).
External wiring
• Check that the external wiring is correct to the relevant protection relay
diagram and wiring scheme. Check that the phase rotation appears as
expected.
• Check the connections against the wiring diagram if a test block is provided.
• Check the connected tripping circuit(s) are correct to the wiring scheme.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
The power supply must be turned off for at least 5 s before power supply
module is removed. Otherwise there is the danger of an electric shock.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
NOTICE
POWER SUPPLY DAMAGE
Before connecting the auxiliary voltage to the PowerLogic P5 protection relay,
make sure the nominal value of the auxiliary device voltage corresponds with
the nominal value of the auxiliary system voltage.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
Watchdog
Using a continuity tester, check that the watchdog contacts (DO4 of slot B) are in
the states shown in the Watchdog contact status table for a de-energised
protection relay.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• The current and voltage transformer connections must remain isolated from
the protection device for these checks.
• The trip circuit must remain isolated to help prevent accidental operation of
the associated circuit breaker.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Watchdog
Using a continuity tester, check that the watchdog contacts (DO4 of slot B) are in
the states shown in the Watchdog contact status diagram for an energised
protection relay.
Digital inputs
This test checks that all the PowerLogic P5 protection relay’s digital inputs (opto-
isolated) are functioning correctly. Check the terminal configuration schemes in
PowerLogic P5 rear panel, page 58 for terminal numbers. Check the polarity and
connect the external 48 V DC supply voltage to the appropriate terminals for the
input being tested. Energise the opto-isolated input one by one.
NOTE: The external power supply is used for this test, but only after
confirming that it is suitably rated, with the variation less than 20%.
The status of each opto-isolated input can be viewed in the Digital inputs view of
the Control menu; a "1" indicating an energised input and a "0" indicating a de-
energised input. When each opto-isolated input is energised, the related DI status
changes to indicate the new state of the inputs.
Digital outputs
This test checks that all the output contact relays are functioning correctly using
the Test mode.
Connect a continuity tester across the terminals corresponding to output relay as
shown in the relevant terminal configuration schemes in PowerLogic P5 rear
panel, page 58. To operate the output relay DO1 in Slot B, via Home menu /
Control sub-menu / digital outputs menu item / digital output Slot X view, set
the field DO1(B) to 1. Operation is confirmed by the continuity tester operating for
a normally open contact and ceasing to operate for a normally closed contact.
Measure the resistance of the contacts in the closed state. Reset the output relay
by setting the DO1(B) field to 0. Repeat the test for the rest of the output relays
then return the PowerLogic P5 protection relay to service by setting the IED mode
back to "Normal".
NOTE: Ensure that the thermal ratings of anything connected to the output
relays during the contact test procedure are not exceeded by the over-
operated output contact relays. Keep the time between application and
removal of contact test to a minimum.
Communication ports
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay supports both serial communication ports and
Ethernet communication ports.
There are five protocols that can be selected and used to communicate through
the serial ports.
• DNP3
• IEC 60870-5-101
• IEC 60870-5-103
• Modbus slave
• Modbus master
If one of these protocols is configured, the PowerLogic P5 protection relay can
exchange data with protocol master. The serial port parameters, e.g. baud rate,
parity, wire number, can be selected and will take effect after reboot.
There are five protocols that can be selected and used to communicate through
the Ethernet ports.
• IEC 61850
• DNP3
• Modbus
• EtherNet/IP
• Digital CB
Three Ethernet protocols can be selected at the same time, and for each protocol
IP address needs to be selected to communicate with clients.
Virtual injections
Enable virtual injection
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay has the capability to test all the functionalities
according to the relevant access rights by:
• Simulation of voltage and current signals
• Injection of a Comtrade file
The virtual injection is done using eSetup Easergy Pro connected to the local
panel.
NOTE: To use the virtual injections the first time, eSetup Easergy Pro
proposes to install WinPcap library delivered with the software. This
installation is mandatory to simulate injections.
To enable virtual injection in eSetup Easergy Pro:
1. Click on the green button with a left arrow on right-hand side to expand the
injector view that is by default hidden in eSetup Easergy Pro.
2. Check the Enable virtual injections option.
3. Select Test mode or Test Block mode for the virtual injection test.
Virtual injections are available only in Test mode or Test Block mode (see
Mode of use for testing purposes, page 254 for more information).
4. Set Auto read to On in the menu bar of eSetup Easergy Pro in order to read
the measurements.
Manual injection
In the Manual tab of the Virtual injection setting view, set the following
parameters:
• Cycles:
Set the value to the number of signal period to apply for the signal simulation.
• Frequency:
Set the frequency of the signal to inject.
• Scalings:
Set the maximum values and angles.
• Measurements:
Set the injection values for the testing.
The injection time can be set in cycles or in real time. For example, for 50 Hz
nominal frequency, one cycle is 20 ms, so 100 cycles equal to 2 s of injection time.
All the signals are simulated with their fundamental value (no harmonics) and
instantaneously displayed in the Graph section of the view.
Injection
Press on the Start button in the upper section of the view for the injection.
Any protection function that is enabled and of which the threshold setting is below
the injection will activate, with the magnitudes displayed in the MEASUREMENTS
section of the view.
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay will trip and activate digital outputs physically
in the Test mode and will stay frozen in the Test-block mode.
NOTE: Do not try to manually change the mode while using the injector.
Figure 144 - Secondary injection test connection diagram with test block
A
B
C
PowerLogic P5
Connector A Test block + Test plug
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A10
A11
A12
A13
A14 V
A15
V
A16
V
A A A A
IA IB IC N IN N VA VB VC N
3-phase A V
generator
P533I1B
In the application case without test block, it is mandatory to remove the voltage
transformer cable. The trip circuit shall be disconnected to avoid the spurious
circuit breaker trip during the secondary injection test. The secondary injection test
can be performed by injecting the current and voltage into the related analogue
connection terminals on the rear panel of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay via
the test block.
Current inputs
This test verifies that the accuracy of current measurement is within acceptable
tolerances.
• Double check the connection and then start the injection test.
• Apply current equal to the related CT secondary rated current.
• Check its magnitude using a multimeter or reading from the test equipment.
• Check the current magnitude displayed on the local panel of the PowerLogic
P5 protection relay.
• Calculate the current measurement accuracy, it shall be within ±1%.
P5F30 VT ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
LPVT ■ ■
LPVT + VT ■ ■ ■ ■
Adapter
P5M30 VT ■ ■ ■
LPVT ■
LPVT + VT ■ ■
Adapter
P5V20 VT ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
P5U20 LPVT ■ ■
LPVT + VT ■ ■ ■ ■
Adapter
P5T30 VT ■ ■ ■
Voltage inputs
This test verifies that the accuracy of voltage measurement is within the
acceptable tolerances.
Seven modes of connection are available on the PowerLogic P5 protection relay:
Mode U1 U2 U3 U4
3VP VA VB VC -
3VP + VN VA VB VC VN
3VP/VPPy VA VB VC VABy
3VP/VPy VA VB VC VAy
The following tests will be realised with the VT Connecting Mode set to 3 VT which
is the most used configuration.
• Double check the connection and then start the injection test.
• Apply voltage equal to the related VT secondary rated voltage.
• Check its magnitude using a multimeter or reading from the test equipment.
• Check the voltage magnitude on the local panel of the PowerLogic P5
protection relay.
• Calculate the voltage measurement accuracy, it shall be within ±1%.
Figure 145 - Connection diagram for testing the LPCT and LPVT
measurement accuracy
A
B
C
PowerLogic P5
S1 A1 1
CSH
A2 2
A3 3
A4 4
IA RJ45 1
2
IB RJ45 1
LPCTs
2
IC RJ45 1
2
A
4
5 VA, VB, VC RJ45
4
LPVTs
5 B
4 RJ45
5
P533I2B
LPCT measurement
This test verifies that the accuracy of LPCT measurement is within acceptable
tolerances.
• Disconnect the secondary of LPCTs from the PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
• Use a generator with low voltage output (30 V max) and connect it directly to
the PowerLogic P5 protection relay as described in Testing tools and
equipment, page 145.
• Apply current equal to the related LPCT secondary rated current.
• Check its magnitude using a multimeter or reading from the test equipment.
• Check the current magnitude displayed on the local panel of the PowerLogic
P5 protection relay.
• Calculate the LPCT measurement accuracy, it shall be within ±1%.
NOTE: To be sure everything is well reconnected after test, it is recommended
to perform a primary injection, at low level.
LPVT measurement
This test verifies that the accuracy of LPVT measurement is within acceptable
tolerances.
• Disconnect the secondary of LPVTs from the LPVT hub.
If the LPVT hub is not accessible inside the cubicle, disconnect the secondary
of the LPVT hub from the PowerLogic P5 protection relay, and connect
another one to replace it during the tests.
• Use a generator with low voltage output (10 V max) and connect it directly to
the LPVT hub as described in Testing tools and equipment, page 145.
• Apply voltage equal to the related LPVT secondary rated voltage.
• Check its magnitude using a multimeter or reading from the test equipment.
• Check the voltage magnitude on the local panel of the PowerLogic P5
protection relay.
• Calculate the LPVT measurement accuracy, it shall be within ±1%.
NOTE: To be sure everything is well reconnected after test, it is recommended
to perform a primary injection, at low level.
Current protection
This test, performed on stage 1 of the overcurrent protection function in setting
group 1, is to check that the protection relay is operating correctly at the
application-specific settings.
1. Determine which output relay has been selected to operate when an I> trip
occurs.
2. Connect the output relay so that its operation will trip the test set and stop the
timer of the injection box.
3. Connect the current outputs of test set (current injection source) to the
protection relay current input terminals.
4. Apply a current of 120% of the current setting to the protection relay and the
relay shall trip according to the operation time setting.
5. Check the tripping time from the test set and compare with the operation time
setting.
6. Check the related fault recorder, events, and the related LEDs for trip
indications.
A similar test procedure can be applied for the secondary injection test to check
the other protection functions with the application-specific settings.
Voltage protection
This test, performed on stage 1 of the undervoltage protection function in setting
group 1, is to check that the protection relay is operating correctly at the
application-specific settings.
1. Determine which output relay has been selected to operate when a U< trip
occurs.
2. Connect the output relay so that its operation will trip the test set and stop the
timer.
3. Connect the voltage outputs of the test set (voltage injection source) to the
protection relay voltage input terminals.
4. Apply normal voltage first and then a voltage of 80% of the voltage setting to
the protection relay. The relay shall trip according to the operation time
setting.
5. Check the tripping time from the test set and compare with the operation time
setting.
6. Check the related fault recorder, events, and the related LEDs for trip
indications.
A similar test procedure can be applied for the secondary injection test to check
the other protection functions with the application-specific settings.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• This equipment must be only be installed and serviced by qualified electrical
personnel.
• Turn off all power supplying this equipment before working on or inside it.
• Always use a properly rated voltage sensing device to confirm that all power
is off.
• Apply appropriate personal protective equipment (PPE) and follow safe
electrical work practices.
• Do not install this product in ATEX zone 0 or 1 areas.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Introduction
The secondary injection tests can be carried out with the LPIT test box. This test
box is an adapter for secondary testing of PowerLogic P5 protection relays with
LPCT/LPVT measuring inputs. It is an interface between the OMICRON25 testing
kit's low-power outputs and PowerLogic P5 inputs. Thanks to this adapter, the
testing is comfortable and the right accuracy in the entire measuring range is
ensured. For the LPCT signal testing, the LPIT Test Box offers 4 sets of current
and 2 sets of voltage outputs depending on the measuring ranges tested. The
LPIT test box is delivered with all cables required to perform the tests.
The OMICRON CMC 356, CMC 256plus and CMC 353 low level output allows 2
sets of three phase injections (LL1,2,3 and/or LL4,5,6).
The injection accuracy of these outputs is 0.07% from 0.71 V to 7.10 V (phase to
neutral).
The overall accuracy (OMICRON + LPIT test box) is 0.25%26 from 0.71 V to 7.10
V (phase to neutral).
For the order code of the LPIT test box, refer to Order codes of LPIT test box and
test sockets/plugs, page 164 section for details.
The LPIT test box can be connected to the OMICRON low-level outputs with 3
inputs as shown below.
25. Omicron is a trademark of OMICRON Electronics GmbH, Oberes Ried 1, 6833 Klaus, Austria
26. Typical value at 25℃ and variable in range of ultimate operation temperature 0℃-50℃.
The LPIT test box can output different voltages in relation to the rated voltages of
LPCTs (22.5 mV or 225 mV) and/or LPVTs (3.25 V (phase to phase)/1.88 V
(phase to neutral)) linked to the three inputs shown above.
LPCT/ LPCT Input 1 (a: LL 1,2,3) LPCT Input 1 (b: LL 4,5,6) LPVT (2a) LPVT (2b)
LPVT
Port 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Port 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
LPCT/ LPCT Input 3 (a: LL 1,2,3) LPCT Input 3 (b: LL 4,5,6) LPVT (2c) Test
LPVT
Current/ IA IB IC IA,B,C IA IB IC IA,B,C VA,B,C
voltage
Input 2V 1V 1V Pin
Output 22.5 mV 1V 1V 1 to 8
OMICRON A P5
P533SNA
NOTE:
• For current, use 1st/2nd/3rd connector of each scaling block.
• Test cables are connected in place of LPCT/LPVT cables during the
testing.
• To find out the order codes, refer to Order codes of LPIT test box and test
sockets/plugs, page 164 section for details.
.
OMICRON A P5
V
B C
I
D E
P533SOA
C LPVT test socket (with cover) REL51092 D LPCT test plug REL51090
NOTE:
• For current, use 4th connector of each scaling block.
• To find out the order codes, refer to Order codes of LPIT test box and test
sockets/plugs, page 164 section for details.
Method 1:
• Connect to input 2
• Outputs to be used are 9 and 10
• Set 3.25 V rated OMICRON output on LL1,2,3 or LL4,5,6
Method 2:
• Connect to input 3
• Output to be used is 19
• Set 3.25 V rated OMICRON output on LL4,5,6
2. If lower voltage injection is needed:
a. From 0 to 0.42 Vn with accuracy needed from 0.042 Vn to 0.42 Vn
• Connect to input 1 to obtain 0.188 V rated output
• Output to be used is 4
• Set 1.668 V rated OMICRON output on LL1,2,3
b. From 0 to 0.042 Vn with accuracy needed from 0.0042 Vn to 0.042 Vn
• Connect to input 1 to obtain 0.188 V rated output
• Output to be used is 14
• Set 1.668 V rated OMICRON output on LL1,2,3
RJ45 Pin 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
LPCT S1 S2
LPVT a n
LPVT (old) n a
Ordering table
Please refer to Order codes of test sockets/plugs, page 165 for ordering
information of test sockets/plugs.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
The primary injection test shall be performed by the qualified electrical
engineers and strictly follow the related primary injection testing instructions
from the utility.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
If any of the external wiring was disconnected from the protection device to run
any tests, make sure that all connections are restored according to the external
connection or scheme diagram.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Voltage connections
NOTICE
CIRCUIT OVERLOAD
• Using a multi-meter, measure the voltage transformer secondary voltages to
help ensure they are compliant with the PowerLogic P5 protection relay’s
input ratings.
• Check that the system phase rotation is correct using a phase rotation meter.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
Thus, the VT ratio, polarity, phase sequence and the external wiring from the
primary system to the protection relay can be verified by the primary voltage
injection.
Current connections
NOTICE
CIRCUIT OVERLOAD
Measure the current transformer secondary values for each input using a
multimeter connected in series with corresponding protection device current
input.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
LPCT connections
NOTICE
MEASUREMENT LOSS
Make sure that LPCTs are connected to all 3 phases with low power sensors or
with RJ45 plug.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in no current measured.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Apply appropriate personal protective equipment (PPE) and follow safe
electrical work practices. See NFPA 70E, NOM-029-STPS-2011, or
CSAZ462.
• The arc fault detection system is not a substitute for proper PPE when
working on or near equipment being monitored by the system.
• Information on this product is offered as a tool for conducting arc-flash
hazard analysis. It is intended for use only by qualified persons who are
knowledgeable about power system studies, power distribution equipment,
and equipment installation practices. It is not intended as a substitute for the
engineering judgement and adequate review necessary for such activities.
• Only qualified personnel should install and service this equipment. Read this
entire set of instructions and check the technical characteristics of the device
before performing such work.
• Perform wiring according to national standards (NEC) and any requirements
specified by the customer.
• Observe any separately marked notes and warnings.
• NEVER work alone.
• Before performing visual inspections, tests, or maintenance on this
equipment, disconnect all sources of electric power. Assume all circuits are
live until they are completely de-energised, tested, and tagged. Pay
particular attention to the design of the power system. Consider all sources
of power, including the possibility of back feeding.
• Always use a properly rated voltage sensing relay to ensure that all power is
off.
• The equipment must be properly grounded.
• Connect the device's protective ground to functional earth according to the
connection diagrams presented in this document.
• Do not open the device. It contains no user-serviceable parts.
• Install all devices, doors and covers before turning on the power to this
device.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Checking zones
End
P533I3A
Checking zones
• Check the protected zones where sensors have been installed and compare
them against the drawings.
• Consult the customer if the configuration does not match with the drawings.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
Removing trip wires may cause loss of protection. Review system drawings and
diagrams before disconnecting trip circuits.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
• Disconnect the trip signals to the circuit breakers that may disturb other parts
of the system during the test.
• Also disconnect trip signals routed to other parts of the system, such as the
breaker failure (ANSI 50BF) backup trip to upstream breakers and the
transfer trip signals.
• Test the disconnected trip signals with a multimeter.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Apply appropriate personal protective equipment (PPE) and follow safe
electrical work practices. See NFPA 70E, NOM-029-STPS-2011, or
CSAZ462.
• The arc fault detection system is not a substitute for proper PPE when
working on or near equipment being monitored by the system.
• Information on this product is offered as a tool for conducting arc-flash
hazard analysis. It is intended for use only by qualified persons who are
knowledgeable about power system studies, power distribution equipment,
and equipment installation practices. It is not intended as a substitute for the
engineering judgement and adequate review necessary for such activities.
• Only qualified personnel should install and service this equipment. Read this
entire set of instructions and check the technical characteristics of the device
before performing such work.
• Perform wiring according to national standards (NEC) and any requirements
specified by the customer.
• Observe any separately marked notes and warnings.
• NEVER work alone.
• Before performing visual inspections, tests, or maintenance on this
equipment, disconnect all sources of electric power. Assume all circuits are
live until they are completely de-energised, tested, and tagged. Pay
particular attention to the design of the power system. Consider all sources
of power, including the possibility of back feeding.
• Always use a properly rated voltage sensing relay to ensure that all power is
off.
• The equipment must be properly grounded.
• Connect the device's protective ground to functional earth according to the
connection diagrams presented in this document.
• Do not open the device. It contains no user-serviceable parts.
• Install all devices, doors and covers before turning on the power to this
device.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Testing the arc flash sensors with the light-only criteria operates the trip outputs of
the device.
Testing the arc flash sensors with the light and current criteria, without an injected
current, only generates an indication on PowerLogic P5 that protects the zone.
NOTE:
Testing the arc-flash sensors using a light source can trip the neighboring
zones.
Because of their placement, some sensors cannot be tested without
dismantling parts of the system. After completing the testing, reassemble the
parts and validate the compliance with original mounting. Consult the
equipment manufacturer before dismantling any parts.
P533I4A
1. Point a powerful light source such as a flashlight or camera flash unit to each
arc-flash sensors until the sensor is activated.
2. Check the arc-flash sensor indication from the PowerLogic P5 protection
relay.
3. Check the address of the activated arc-flash sensor from the PowerLogic P5
protection relay.
4. Compare the arc-flash sensor address information from the protection relay
with that on the sensor location map.
5. Fill in the test result in the test report.
6. Reset the protection relay.
7. Repeat the procedure with the next arc-flash sensor.
CAUTION
CIRCUIT OVERLOAD
Do not open a loaded current measuring circuit before the secondary circuit of
the current transformer is reliably short-circuited.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment
damage.
1. Short circuit the secondary circuit of the current transformer and disconnect
the PowerLogic P5 protection relay from the measuring circuit.
2. Connect a current injection device, one phase at a time, to the PowerLogic P5
protection relay of the current measuring circuit.
3. For a current injection device with time measurement, connect the injection
device either to inject the current continuously or when triggered by the time
measuring circuit:
a. Use the digital input of the current injection device for the stop trigger in
the time measurement circuit.
b. Connect the trip output of the tested unit to the digital input of the current
injection device for the stop trigger. For measuring the total operating
time, use the NO contact of the circuit breaker, which indicates that
status of circuit breaker is open, for the stop trigger.
c. Connect the time measuring start signal output to the flashlight.
Configure the time measuring start signal to either trigger only the
flashlight or both the flashlight and the current injection.
Preferably, the current injection should be triggered before the flashlight.
d. Measure the operate time between the start trigger and stop trigger.
2. While injecting the current, apply light with a flashlight to at least one of the
arc-flash sensors, one at a time.
3. Check that the arc-flash protection function activates.
4. Generate at least one trip with current for the PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
5. Reset the protection relay.
Test report
• Check the protected zones where sensors have been installed and compare
them against the drawings.
• Consult the customer if the configuration does not match with the drawings.
Supervisor
Date
P533I5B
Final check
NOTICE
CIRCUIT OVERLOAD
• Remove all test or temporary shorting leads.
• If it has been necessary to disconnect any of the external wiring from the
protection relay to perform the wiring verification tests, make sure that all
connections are replaced according to the relevant external connection or
scheme diagram.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in equipment damage.
The commissioning is now complete, but before putting the protection relay into
normal operation, check the following items:
• Ensure that the protection relay is restored to service.
• CB maintenance and current counters should be zero. These counters can be
reset.
• Double check the application-specific settings, to help ensure that all the
desired protection and control functions are enabled with the correct settings.
Extract the final setting file from the protection relay.
• Check the Date and Time of the protection relay, to help ensure the date and
time are exactly synchronised.
• Reset all event records, fault records, and disturbance records. Make sure
that alarms and LEDs have been reset before leaving the protection relay.
The device is now ready for operation.
Cybersecurity
Cybersecurity overview
This chapter contains up-to-date information about cybersecurity of PowerLogic
P5. Network administrators, system integrators and personnel that commission,
maintain or dispose of a device should:
• Apply and maintain the device’s security capabilities. See Device security
capabilities, page 179 for details.
• Review assumptions about protected environments. See Protected
environment assumptions, page 180 for details.
• Address potential risks and mitigation strategies. See Potential risks and
compensating controls, page 181 for details.
• Follow recommendations to optimise cybersecurity.
To communicate a security topic affecting a Schneider Electric product or solution,
go to https://www.se.com/ww/en/work/support/cybersecurity/vulnerability-policy.
jsp.
The PowerLogic P5 device is delivered with auto-login feature. It will be disabled
when the passwords for all three levels are changed from the default ones.
WARNING
POTENTIAL COMPROMISE OF SYSTEM AVAILABILITY, INTEGRITY, AND
CONFIDENTIALITY
• Change default passwords to help prevent unauthorised access to device
settings and information.
• Disable unused ports/services and default accounts, where possible, to
minimise pathways for malicious attacks.
• Place networked devices behind multiple layers of cyber defenses (such as
firewalls, network segmentation, and network intrusion detection and
protection).
• Use cybersecurity best practices (for example: least rights, separation of
duties) to help prevent unauthorised exposure, loss, modification of data and
logs, interruption of services, or unintended operation.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or
equipment damage.
Security policy
NOTICE
ACCESSIBILITY LOSS
• Setup a security policy and procedure to back up the security administrator
user account.
• Do not share a single user account with multiple users. Set one user account
associated to roles and rights per user.
• Do not excessively decrease "user parameters" values.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in loss of access to the
protection relay.
NOTICE
CYBER SECURITY
• Except for private GetSet protocol via secured communication (SSH), the
device does not have the capability to transmit data encrypted using the
following protocols: IEC 61850, DNP3 over Ethernet, Modbus slave over
Ethernet, EtherNet/IP, IEC 60870-5-103 serial, IEC 60870-5-101 serial,
DNP3 serial, Modbus slave serial, Modbus master serial, IEEE 1588 and
SNTP.
• If other users gained access to your network, transmitted information can be
disclosed or subject to tampering.
• For transmitting data over an internal network, physically or logically
segment the network. The access to the internal network needs to be
restricted by using standard controls, such as firewalls, and other relevant
features supported by your device, such as IP Table whitelisting.
• For transmitting data over an external network, encrypt protocol
transmissions over all external connections using an encrypted tunnel, TLS
wrapper or a similar solution.
Failure to follow these instructions can increase the risk of unauthorised
access.
Product defense-in-depth
Use a layered network approach with multiple security and defense controls in
your IT and control system to minimise data protection gaps, reduce single-point
of failure and create a strong cybersecurity posture. The more layers of security in
your network, the harder it is to breach defenses, take digital assets or cause
disruption.
Information confidentiality
These security capabilities help protect the confidentiality of information through
secure protocols that employ cryptographic algorithms, key sizes and
mechanisms used to help prevent unauthorised users from reading information in
transit, i.e. SSH, SFTP and HTTPS.
Physical security
In order to help prevent unauthorised access, lock the shutter on the local panel of
the PowerLogic P5 protection relay with a wired lead seal. See Lock the shutter
and handle, page 50 for details.
Cybersecurity configuration
These security capabilities support the analysis of security events, help protect the
device from unauthorised alteration and records configuration changes and user
account events:
• Internal time synchronisation.
• Time source integrity protection and the PowerLogic P5 protection relay
configuration event logging.
• Timestamps, including date and time, match the PowerLogic P5 protection
relay clock.
• SSH server hosts an internal SFTP site and stores files in the PowerLogic P5
protection relay’s flash memory, such as: COMTRADE records and firmware
files.
• Embeds user information with changes.
• Offload information to syslog or a protected storage or retention location.
Port hardening
The communication port of PowerLogic P5 protection relay can be disabled. Each
logical port can be independently disabled. Port hardening configuration can be
set from the local panel of PowerLogic P5 protection relay, from eSetup Easergy
Pro, or from the web HMI, with the ENGINEER access right.
Firmware upgrades
This security capability helps protect the authenticity of the firmware running on
the PowerLogic P5 protection relay and facilitates protected file transfer: digitally
signed firmware is used to help protect the authenticity of the firmware running on
the PowerLogic P5 protection relay and only allows firmware generated and
signed by Schneider Electric.
User Default account If you do not Change the default password for all
accounts settings are often change the accounts to help reduce unauthorised
the source of default password, access. See Passwords, page 214.
unauthorised unauthorised
access by access can occur.
malicious users.
Secure IEC 61850, DNP3 If a malicious user For transmitting data over an internal
protocols over Ethernet, gained access to network, physically or logically segment
Modbus slave your network, they the network.
over Ethernet, could intercept
EtherNet/IP, IEC communications. For transmitting data over an external
60870-5-103 network, encrypt protocol transmissions
serial, IEC 60870- over all external connections using an
5-101 serial, encrypted tunnel, TLS wrapper or a similar
DNP3 serial, solution.
Modbus slave
serial, Modbus See Protected environment assumptions,
master serial, page 180.
IEEE 1588 and
SNTP protocols
are unsecure.
Cybersecurity configuration
The PowerLogic P5 with firmware V01.500.101 or higher are delivered with Basic
Cybersecurity level. The User can upgrade them to Advanced Cybersecurity level
with a setting parameter available in the relay's local panel. Both levels can be
described in the following way:
• Basic Cybersecurity level: Cyber Security Level 0 (CSL0)
Most of cybersecurity rules are fixed by default configuration which cannot be
customized. User accounts also fixed. Changing of password directly via
device HMI. No security logs. Advanced features such as sending logs to
Syslog server and centralized authentication mode are not provided.
• Advanced Cybersecurity level: Cyber Security Level 1 (CSL1)
Customized cybersecurity rules option provided. Management of user
accounts and update password for all PowerLogic P5 devices in batch mode
in a same local area network. Security logs provided, and the logs can be
transmitted to Syslog server. Supports centralized authentication with
Microsoft Active Directory as backend.
The Advanced CS level of the protection relay holds certification for IEC 62443-4-
1 for Secure Development Lifecycle and IEC 62443-4-2 Security Level 1 (SL1) for
security features provided.
An overview of the differences between security features offered with Basic and
Advanced levels is listed in the following table.
Centralized authentication - ■
The cybersecurity level used to be an order option. In the products delivered with
firmware versions prior to V01.500.101 (earlier version V01.30x.yyy or V01.40x.
yyy), the cybersecurity level was fixed. The character no. 17 in the model number
informed about cybersecurity level available in the product:
P 5 x 2 0 - _ _ _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ A _
P 5 x 3 0 - _ _ _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ B _
27. CAE is a free engineering tool software which is used to manage cybersecurity rules for PowerLogic P5.
28. In Basic Cybersecurity (CS) level, changing password of user account can only be done via device HMI.
29. In Advanced Cybersecurity level, changing password of user account can only be done with CAE software.
D CS Advanced +
Advanced logic
E N/A Settable CS
F Settable CS +
Advanced logic
NOTE:
• From firmware version V01.500.101, only E or F options are available.
• In case of a firmware upgrade of a device with older firmware version to
V01.50x.yyy, the options A and B will evolve to E. The options C and D
will evolve to F.
To configure CS level:
1. With the local panel, enter the Home menu/General sub-menu/
Cybersecurity/CS level config, you can upgrade the level from CS Basic to
CS Advanced.
HMI Auto-login
To facilitate the commissioning work by panel builder and system integrator,
PowerLogic P5 is provided with an Auto-login feature when manufactured. This
feature grants privilege of the role of INSTALLER for HMI access, without request
of password. All roles and their rights are described in chapter of Roles and rights,
page 185.
This feature is applicable for both Basic and Advanced CS levels.
The Auto-login feature will be disabled when:
• For Basic CS level: the auto-login will be disabled when password has been
changed for InstallerLevel account. Password change for other accounts
does not impact the auto-login feature.
• For Advanced CS level: when security rules are pushed to device by CAE
software, the auto-login feature will be immediately disabled.
The following chapters will describe how the cybersecurity rules of PowerLogic P5
can be managed for Basic and Advanced CS levels. Before that, the roles and
rights definitions must be described.
Role Description
VIEWER Can view information except for security logs. Viewer cannot
(Advanced CS level only) modify any settings and files.
SECADM Can change security rules, this is the only role which can be used
(Advanced CS level only) to work with CAE software.
All user accounts are password protected and granted up to 256 concurrent
sessions.
The PowerLogic P5 default RBAC setting is compliant with IEC 62351-8
guidelines. With CAE it can be modified and extended depending on user
requirements. The default RBAC setting is as the following table.
Security ■ ■ ■
Configuration change ■ ■
Control ■ ■ ■
Internal data ■ ■ ■ ■
Configuration read ■ ■ ■ ■
Settings read ■ ■ ■ ■
Read data ■ ■ ■ ■
Debug system ■
Secure communication ■ ■ ■ ■
Setting change ■ ■
Firmware update ■
Firmware verify ■
Logs LOGS Permission to retrieve security logs from PowerLogic P5 with CAE
Backup memory copy P5_RightBackupRootDirDefaultAccess Permission to read, write, delete, transfer through SFTP, back up
memory data in /backup/ directory of file system embedded in the
device.
Configuration read P5_RightConfigDft Permission to read the configuration which need a reboot of the
device, for example, scaling values like CT ratio or voltage
connection mode.
Configuration change P5_RightConfigMgt Permission to modify the configuration, it means we can change
any setting which need a reboot of the device, for example, scaling
values like CT ratio or voltage connection mode.
Control status read P5_RightCtrlObjDft Permission to read the status of controllable objects such as
status of switches, alarms, digital inputs/outputs, LED mode, etc.
Device cybersecurity data P5_RightCybSecRootDirDefaultAccess Permission to read, write, delete, transfer through CAE,
full access cybersecurity data in /cyb_sec/ directory of file system embedded
in the device.
Read data P5_RightDataDft Permission to read all the data (i.e., measurements, fixed
parameters (i.e. model number, ….), logs, …
Internal data P5_RightDescMgt Permission to read and write internal data (internal manufacturer
user)
Firmware verify P5_RightFirmwareVerify Permission to verify firmware authenticity and integrity before
updating the firmware to the device
Function key 1-8 control P5_RightFnkey01-07 Permission to operate with the function keys. There is one
permission per function key Fx (x = 1 to 7)
Settings read P5_RightSettingDft Permission to read any setting which do not need a reboot of the
device, for example, protection threshold or operation time.
30. The name of right in CAE is needed when the rights will be assigned for new roles or to be customized for existing roles.
Settings change P5_RightSettingMgt Permission to modify any setting which does not need a reboot of
the device, for example, protection or communication settings.
Includes also logic and Mimic configuration in eSetup Easergy
Pro, switching device mode (normal use or tests mode) and
allowing test execution.
Read statistics data P5_RightStatDft Permission to read only statistics data like counters, demand,
max, min., thermal capacity, …, etc.
Clear statistics data P5_RightStatMgt Permission to read and clear statistics data like counters, demand,
max, min., thermal level, …, etc.
Debug system P5_RightSystemDebug Permission to execute firmware (low level) debug command
(internal manufacturer user)
Device user data file read P5_RightUserRootDirDefaultAccess Permission to read through SFTP or eSetup Easergy Pro, user
data in /usr/ directory of file system embedded in the device like
disturbance records, …, etc.
Device user data file full P5_RightUserRootDirFullAccess Permission to read, write, delete, transfer through SFTP or eSetup
access Easergy Pro, user data in /usr/ directory of file system embedded
in the device like disturbance records, …, etc., except security
logs.
Device system data file P5_RightUserRootDirFullAccess Permission to read, write, delete, transfer through SFTP, system
full access data in /sys/ directory of file system embedded in the device
(internal manufacturer user); permission to update, through
eSetup Easergy Pro and the device firmware.
EngineerLevel ENGINEER Y Y Y Y
InstallerLevel INSTALLER Y Y Y Y
Advanced CS level allows user to manage user accounts and assign roles for
them. The available access interfaces for roles of Advanced CS level are as
follows:
Table 35 - Accessible interfaces for user accounts of Advanced CS level
OPERATOR Y Y Y Y N
ENGINEER Y Y Y Y N
INSTALLER Y Y Y Y N
SECAUD Y Y N N Y (only for
retrieving
logs)
SECADM N N N N Y
31. The name of right in CAE is needed when the rights will be assigned for new roles or to be customized for existing roles.
Login
• Local HMI panel: go to User Login menu from HMI main menu, then select
account and enter password. Refer to Login and logout, page 231 for more
information.
• Easergy Pro software (via SSH): refer to Connecting to a single protection
relay using USB cable, page 242 or Connecting to protection relays via
Ethernet, page 242 for more information.
• Web HMI (via HTTPS): Web HMI feature is disabled by default. Before use, it
must be enabled in Communication menu by selecting the Ethernet port for
HTTPS server. Refer to the communication user manual, search for “HTTPS
server” for more information.
• CAE (via HTTPS, only for Advanced CS level) : only a Security Admin role
(SECADM) can login to a CAE project.
Logout
For security reasons, it is recommended to logout after any operation on the
PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
On the main menu screen, Login screen and Mimic screen, a padlock icon is
presented at top-right corner of the title bar to signify that there is no user logged
in to PowerLogic P5 protection relay. The padlock icon disappears when any user
logs in.
Default settings
Basic CS level comes with three fixed user accounts. CS rules are as follows:
Table 36 - Accessible interfaces for user accounts of Basic CS level
Changing password
For Basic CS level, the length of the password is 1 to 8 ASCII characters [33 to
122].
The password change is managed directly via the device local HMI as the
following procedure:
1. Login to device by entering password. If the auto-login feature is still active,
then the device is already logged in with InstallerLevel account.
2. Enter the GENERAL SETTINGS menu and select Change password option.
GENERAL SETTINGS
Modbus master
DNP3
IEC60870-5-101
IEC60870-5-103
Port hardening
IP filter
Change password
Cybersecurity reset
3. Select user.
Change Password 1/1
User1 OperatorLevel
User2 EngineerLevel
User3 InstallerLevel
A * * * * * * * *
NOTE: In step 3 the user can select another user with a lower access right in
order to change the password for that user. This is useful and convenient for
changing password for other users when they have lost their passwords. This
function can also serve as a complement to the password recovery options
described in Factory reset using a reset code, page 216.
NOTE: In step 3 the user cannot select another user with a higher access right
in order to change the password for that user. A “Permission denied” message
will appear on the screen.
The scope of the rights of changing password for the three accounts are:
• InstallerLevel can change password for self, OperatorLevel and
EngineerLevel.
• EngineerLevel can change password for self and OperatorLevel.
• OperatorLevel can change password only for self.
Figure 155 - Config access Via F1 Key and Via SCADA shown on HMI
GENERAL SETTINGS
Cybersecurity reset -
RBAC Reset to factory
Firmware upgrade
Config Access
Via F1 Key Enabled
Via SCADA Enabled
NOTICE
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATION
If F1 key is configured as the quick switch of PowerLogic P5 lock/unlock, it will
be not available for other functions.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in improper operation.
Via F1 Key
Disabled32 Enabled
Locked Unlocked
32. When F1 key is disabled which means it is used as a normal function key, the read/write permission is decided by existing RBAC setting.
Via F1 Key
Via SCADA
Disabled Enabled
Access via rear comms Read Read/Write
SCADA (IEC 61850)
Auto log-out
While “Via F1 Key” is enabled, PowerLogic P5 will be switched to locked state
automatically in below conditions, which is called “auto log-out”:
• if PowerLogic P5 is not connected with Easergy Pro, nor with WebHMI, and
without any operation on HMI for 3 minutes;
• if PowerLogic P5 is disconnected from Easergy Pro for 3 minutes;
• if PowerLogic P5 is disconnected from WebHMI for 18 minutes.
33. It is proposed to click on “Logout” button at top right of WebHMI before closing the web browser, the auto log-out will be launched in 3
minutes.
Default settings
When delivered from the factory, PowerLogic P5 Advanced CS level will be
equipped with following settings:
CAE
RBAC
Ethernet
Security logs
P533JXA
System requirements
CAE is a software with no requirement of license nor cost. It can be downloaded
for free from Schneider Electric’s website.
Click See software to choose package between x86 and x64 versions according
to operating system of the computer to install CAE. The latest version of CAE at
the time when this chapter was written is 2.2.1.2304.
NOTE: CAE only runs in Window 10. It will not run in Windows 7.
After downloading the installation package, unzip the package and run the
Cybersecurity Admin Expert Installer.exe file to install. The files in folder
ISSetupPrerequisites will be installed automatically.
• Menu Bar: From the menu bar user can select required function. The
organization of functions follows a typical configuration workflow, however,
user can jump from one to another.
• Preferences: Click to choose language and activate/deactivate window
restore preferences.
• Username: Logged in username is displayed in this area.
• Log out: To log out from the application, click on the power on/off icon.
• Help: click ? icon then Audit Logs to see CAE application logs.
• Create/Export/Import: Use those buttons to create, export or import CAE
security configuration project database.
Most of the CAE functions can be used without connection to PowerLogic P5
devices. Connection with devices in the same local area network is only required
when using function of MANAGEMENT OF SYSTEM for pushing new CS rules to
devices.
CAE functions are grouped in the following menu bars:
• USER ACCOUNTS: the functions for account edit such as create, rename,
remove account, change password of account, and assign accounts to roles.
Please note that one user account can be assigned to multiple roles. This
user account will then have the rights of all corresponding roles combined.
• ROLES: edit PowerLogic P5 user roles and rights. User’s rights are decided
by the roles the user accounts are assigned to.
• SECURITY SETTINGS: set miscellaneous security-related features, such as
session time out duration, password complexity requirement, Syslog server,
account locking.
• SYSTEM EDITOR: list the discovered protection relays so that CAE can push
new CS settings to the devices. Please note that PowerLogic P5 devices can
be discovered automatically by CAE, since PowerLogic P5 supports DPWS
and UDP. Therefore declaring of devices is optional. For devices that do not
support UDP they must be added to the list otherwise CAE cannot find them.
• MANAGEMENT OF SYSTEM: discover PowerLogic P5 devices so that new
CS settings can be pushed.
Selection in Architecture will impact the Security Settings menu which will be
described in CAE menu: Security settings, page 200.
If the selection Factory is selected in Created from setting, the default CAE
template will be used. Alternatively, it can be created from one of existing projects.
Click Save to save the project. Then double-click the new project in the project
manager pane to switch to the project. CAE will ask for authentication upon
opening the new project.
Use the account name SecurityAdmin and default password “AAAAAAAA” to
login. CAE will then force changing of the initial password. There is no password
complexity requirement for a new project.
After the password of SecurityAdmin has been changed, the project will be loaded
with CAE default template settings if Factory is chosen to create the project from.
NOTE: CAE projects can only be opened by accounts of SECADM (Security
Administrator) role.
DefaultEngineer ENGINEER
DefaultInstaller INSTALLER
DefaultOperator OPERATOR ↓←↑→↓←↑→ (then
AAAAAAAA press OK key)
DefaultSecAud SECAUD
DefaultViewer VIEWER
SecurityAdmin SECADM
If the arrow password is set in CAE, the PowerLogic P5 always prompts this
authentication mode in the local HMI. If the feature is not required, please make
sure to clear the arrow password for all the accounts as shown in below example.
NOTE:
1. It is strongly recommended to change the default passwords for all
accounts before PowerLogic P5 is put to operation.
2. It is strongly recommended to create a 2nd user account assigned with
SECADM role, so that in case of SecurityAdmin password lost, the 2nd
SECADM account can be used to open the CAE project and recover
passwords.
3. In case of managing multiple CAE projects in parallel, keep at least one
SECADM account with the same password in all projects, so that to
switch easily between CAE projects.
4. SecurityAdmin is the account with a hardcoded username for all CAE
projects as well as for the devices. The username cannot be changed or
deleted. Other roles cannot be assigned to this account (except
SECADM).
5. Make sure to save changes for each account.
User Accounts
CAE is delivered with default security parameters as follows:
To facilitate operation and setting via local HMI, Activate ‘Local Default Access’
can be set to Yes to automatically grant selected rights of the role. Anyone who
can access to the PowerLogic P5 local HMI will have the rights of the roles
assigned with ‘Local Default Access’. The default setting is VIEWER, but it can be
extended to multiple ROLES if needed as follows:
Please note that the ‘Local Default Access’ option is only available for Substation /
Feeder Automation architecture.
NOTE: The setting of project architecture will also impact the following
options:
• Allow user account locking: can only be YES for Critical Power and
Plant Automation.
• Automatic user account unlocking: can be only YES for Critical Power
and Plant Automation.
Logs
• Logging parameters: no standard logging parameters were enabled when
PowerLogic P5 was released from factory. It will not generate any security log
before being managed with CAE. During creation of a new CAE project the
default standard enabled by CAE is BDEW. PowerLogic P5 also supports
security logs according to IEEE 1686 standards. For type of logs and which
will be generated for both standards refer to Security event logging, page 218.
• Syslog parameters: input remote Syslog server address and port in this
section. PowerLogic P5 will send all the internally generated security logs to
the server for backup after address and port defined.
• SNMP parameters: the options shall not be used since PowerLogic P5 does
not support SNMP.
Security Banners
The security banners are warning messages displayed on the device HMI and
Web HMI login interface for system use notification.
PowerLogic P5 will display Authorized User Access Only before authentication
takes place in the device HMI and Web HMI. The displayed message can be
customized in Security banner medium of CAE.
Certificate whitelist
PowerLogic P5 connects with CAE via HTTPs. PowerLogic P5 works as a server
with device self-signed HTTPs certificate to help ensure the credentials and
contents will not be transmitted in clear text.
After making the settings, CAE should be able to find the devices.
Centralized authentication
PowerLogic P5 supports centralized authentication via RADIUS and LDAP
protocols, so that its user account and privilege management can be merged into
an existing authentication infrastructure of the customer network. This means that
the existing RADIUS server or Active Directory server in the customer network can
also manage the user account and privilege for PowerLogic P5. Users can use
their existing username for other devices in their network, such as other protection
relays, network switches, workstations on PowerLogic P5. Once the account
settings are changed at the RADIUS or LDAP server, all PowerLogic P5 devices
will take account of the changes for user authentication and authorization.
Solution overview
Depending on the existing authentication mechanism used in your network, and
the firmware version of the PowerLogic P5, different solutions are available:
• If your existing authentication server is Microsoft Active Directory Server
(referred to AD server hereinafter)
◦ for the firmware version V01.500.101 and newer, you can connect to AD
server directly, or with the Cybersecurity Application Platform (CAP) as a
proxy. It is recommended to use the CAP as a proxy because it can
simplify your firewall setup.
◦ for the firmware version V01.402.201 and earlier, which only supports
RADIUS, it is necessary to use the CAP as a proxy to connect to your AD
server. This is because CAP can connect with the protection relay over
RADIUS and connect with AD sever over LDAP.
• If your existing authentication server is RADIUS, the protection relay can be
directly connected to the server
• We will use TekRADIUS as an example for connecting the protection relay
and mapping the roles.
AD Server
If the existing authentication server is an AD server, it is recommended to use the
CAP as a proxy to connect to the AD server. Using a CAP as a proxy can make
firewall setup easier.
NOTE: The description of CAP in this document serves as a quick guide. For
complete details on installing and using CAP, see the CAP documentation.
Figure 158 - Using the CAP as a proxy for connecting to the AD server
LDAP
RADIUS/LDAP
Login request request LDAP login request
OT device users RADIU/LDAP clients CAP server (Linux) Windows Active IT device user
Firewall Directory Server (Laptop, Workstation)
As shown above, the CAP server can be placed in Secure Zone 1 where
PowerLogic P5 is located. Within the same zone there can be other devices such
as RTUs, switches, and other protection relays. The firewall only needs to allow
connection between the CAP server and the AD server, which makes the setup
easier and more scalable.
NOTE: Secure Zone 1 is normally the most secure segment because it has
OT devices which control the critical infrastructure devices such as circuit
breakers and switches. Secure Zone 1 is more isolated than other network
segments. Secure Zone 2 is the network used for information management
services such as e-mail, file servers and Internet. Secure Zone 1 and 2 are
isolated using firewalls and/or network diodes to ensure that the Secure Zone
1 is better secured.
Alternatively, if the AD server resides in the same Secure Zone with PowerLogic
P5, there is no need to install the firewall, as shown below.
Secure Zone 1
LDAP
Grant access
Laptop 2 with CAE CAP server (Linux) Windows Active Laptop 1 with ADUC
Firewall Directory Server
After successful login, enter the following command to enter the CAP setting:
cap-config
When the CAP setting menu is displayed, navigate to the following item:
• Configuration/Configure RADIUS/AD proxy/Edit user configuration file
If you want to map the “ENGINEER” role in PowerLogic P5 to the “Relay
Engineer” group in AD server, do the following:
• In the editor, for the user group “Relay Engineer” in common name “Users”,
and domain “val.ctc.se.com”, add the following lines
◦ DEFAULT Ldap-Group == “CN=Relay Engineer,CN=Users,DC=val,DC=
ctc,DC=se,DC=com”
Reply-Message = “ENGINEER”
If you want to assign multiple roles in the PowerLogic P5 to one specific group in
AD server, for example to map “INSTALLER” and “ENGINEER” roles to group
“Relay Power User”, add the following lines:
• DEFAULT Ldap-Group == “CN=Relay Power User,CN=Users,DC=val,DC=
ctc,DC=se,DC=com”
Reply-Message = “INSTALLER”,
Reply-Message += “ENGINEER”
Figure 163 - CAP server RADIUS configuration for mapping groups to roles
When the above modification is done, press Ctrl + X, then press y and Enter to
confirm the modification and exit the nano editor with the changes saved.
The CAP will now restart the RADIUS service. To confirm the RADIUS service is
successfully restarted, navigate to the following menu to check the logs:
• Configuration/Configure RADIUS/AD proxy/Read logs
The message “Ready to process requests” means that the RADIUS server has
successfully restarted.
• client ctc-val-test {
ipaddr = 10.10.10.0/24
secret = Test*#12
}
The client name can be any text as you want, as an example we have used “ctc-
val-test” here.
The ipaddr shall be the network segment in which the PowerLogic P5 devices are
located, with 24 being the length of the subnet mask, the specified network
segment is 10.10.10.0 to 10.10.10.255 in this case.
LDAP setting
PowerLogic P5 versions later than V01.500.101 is equipped with an LDAP client
thus it is recommended to use LDAP as it offers better security than RADIUS.
The LDAP protocol details for the setting are as following:
• In the section LDAP Protocol Details, for Base DN, for the OU VALIDATION
and the domain val.ctc.se.com in this example, use value “ou=VALIDATION,
dc=val,dc=ctc,dc=se,dc=com”.
• Value of input box Server IP Address and Server Port:
◦ If you are using CAP as a proxy between PowerLogic P5 devices and the
AD server, provide the proxy IP address and port number.
◦ If PowerLogic P5 devices are connecting directly to the AD server, provide
the AD server address and port number instead.
NOTE: The port number depends on the type of protocol to be used. For
detailed information about the port number and corresponding protocols
please refer to the CAE and CAP documentation, and the setting of your
AD server. PowerLogic P5 supports LDAP and LDAP + StartTLS
protocols.
• To grant the ”ENGINEER” role privilege to the “Relay Engineer”, click Add a
new group button, input name Relay Engineer in the text box above the
button, and check ENGINEER in the list of Role(s), then click Add a new
group button again.
RADIUS setting
For older PowerLogic P5 versions, the only option is to connect to CAP over
RADIUS.
Most of the settings can be left as defaults, except for the following in the section
LDAP Protocol Details:
• Shared secret: it must be the same as set in the CAP server, which is
“Test*#12” in this example.
• Role attribute name: it must be “Reply-Message”.
• Mode and Port: For details about the settings of Mode and Port, please refer
to the CAE and CAP user documentation. PowerLogic P5 supports RADIUS_
CLEAN and EAP_TTLS protocols.
Congratulations! After completing the above steps, user Alice WANG can use her
credentials set by the AD server for PowerLogic P5 authentication and obtain the
role privileges in device mapped to her user group in AD server accordingly.
Figure 168 - RADIUS server in the same secure zone with PowerLogic P5
Secure Zone 1
RADIUS request
RADIUS accept
Login request RADIUS request
On the left side you can find all the usernames and groups in the RADIUS server
database. Note that the group “Engineer” here does not have any mapping
relation with the roles in PowerLogic P5.
On the right side you can find the attributes for highlighted user. There are two
attributes to be configured:
1. The first attribute specifies the password for user AAA1. The Attribute name
shall be User-Password. The Type shall be Check. The Value contains the
password.
2. To assign user AAA1 a role in PowerLogic P5, the 2nd attribute is needed. Its
Type shall be Success-Reply. The Attribute name can be anything but must
be the same as the Role attribute name setting in CAE. We use IEC62351-8-
RoleID as an example. The role to be assigned to user AAA1 shall be entered
in the Value field, which is INSTALLER in this example.
By providing the above two attributes, user AAA1 will get the INSTALLER role
privilege in PowerLogic P5.
If you want to assign multiple roles to user AAA1, for example to assign
“INSTALLER” and “ENGINEER” roles to AAA1, set the values of Attribute
IEC62351-8-RoleID as INSTALLER;ENGINEER by repeating the sequence of
operations above.
Now the user AAA1 can authenticate to PowerLogic P5 with the credential set in
the TekRADIUS server and obtain accordingly the role privileges as specified in
the TekRADIUS server.
Passwords
Password complexity
The following rule of password complexity is available for both Basic CS level and
Advanced CS level.
• Length of password must be 1 to 8 characters
• Passwords can be composed by the following ASCII [33 to 122] characters:
◦ Latin capital letters from A to Z
◦ Latin lowercase characters from a to z
◦ Figures from 0 to 9
◦ Non-alphabetic characters: [ \ ] ^ _ ’ ! “ # $ %` & ‘ ( ) * + , - . / : ; < = > ? @
NOTE: Passwords cannot contain the user account name or parts (no more
than two consecutive characters) of the user's full name. To help to secure the
PowerLogic P5 protection relay, the password should be as long as possible,
mixing lowercase and uppercase characters, figures and non-alphabetic
characters.
It is possible to configure password with CAE according to NERC and
IEEE 1686 standard recommendations.
Standard Configuration
Password reset
Password can be reset by a higher privilege user account.
If the higher privilege user account password is lost, the only option is to perform a
Cybersecurity factory reset and contact Schneider Electric Customer Care Center.
Basic CS level
With InstallerLevel account, the user can reset the passwords of OperatorLevel
and EngineerLevel.
With EngineerLevel account, the user can reset the password of OperatorLevel.
The reset can be done directly through the local HMI as described in Changing
password, page 189.
If the InstallerLevel account password is lost the only option is to perform a
cybersecurity factory reset and contact Schneider Electric customer care.
Advanced CS level
For Advanced CS level, CAE is the only method to modify a password. A security
admin role account can reset the password of all other accounts (including other
security admin accounts).
If the password of SecurityAdmin is lost but another SECADM account exists, the
CAE projects can be opened with the other SECADM account. After that you can
reset the SecurityAdmin password.
Reset code
The reset code can only be obtained from the Schneider Electric Customer Care
Center.
The reset code is intended for password recovery only. It is not a replacement
password that can be used continually. It can only be used once - for password
recovery.
Entry of the reset code causes the PowerLogic P5 protection relay to reset all
passwords back to factory default.
The "passwords set to default" message is displayed.
The reset code can be applied through any interface, local or remote. It will
achieve the same result regardless of which interface it is applied through.
It is the responsibility of the user to enter the new appropriate passwords.
NOTICE
RISK OF PASSWORD RECOVERY PROCESS FAILURE
• The reset code is only valid for its corresponding reset request code. Once a
new reset request code is generated on the PowerLogic P5 protection relay,
the reset code provided by the Customer Care Center becomes invalid.
• Avoid the circumstances that will cause a new reset request code to be
generated by the protection relay before entering the reset code.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in interruption of the
password recovery process.
The passwords can be reset to factory defaults through the following procedure:
1. Get the reset request code from the RBAC Reset to factory view of the
GENERAL SETTINGS menu as illustrated in the following figure.
2 Select Get request code from the RBAC Reset to factory view
3 Select on
4 Reset request code generated and displayed on the screen
4. Go to the RBAC Reset to factory view of the General SETTINGS menu and
select the Reset factory option.
RBAC Reset to factory 1/2
Reset to factory password
Get request code -
Reset factory -
5. Select On to confirm.
6. A caution message appears. Press to continue.
Caution
Any changes on RBAC and
security configuration will
be lost, then the factory
RBAC and security policies
will be applied.
Reset Cancel
7. Enter the reset code obtained in Step 3 above to start the reset.
Passwords of PowerLogic P5 and all security settings will be set to default values
now.
Port hardening
It is possible to disable PowerLogic P5 communication ports from the local panel,
eSetup Easergy Pro, or web HMI with ENGINEER access right.
Physical ports which can be disabled:
• Front mini-USB port (for eSetup Easergy Pro connection)
• Rear serial port
• Rear Ethernet port
The figure below shows the Port Hardening Configuration settings in the Protocol
Configuration view of the Communication menu in eSetup Easergy Pro:
The port hardening can also be set from the local panel through the Port
hardening configuration view of the General menu.
When the ports or the protocols on the Ethernet module are disabled or enabled,
reboot of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is needed.
Upgrades management
When the PowerLogic P5 protection relay firmware is upgraded – security
configuration remains the same until changed, including usernames and
passwords. It is recommended security configuration is reviewed after an upgrade
to analyze rights for new or changed device features and revoke or apply them
according to your company’s policies and standards.
• RBAC function is making sure that user cannot perform actions for which he
does not have privilege.
• Security event logs (CS Advanced only) are properly generated in
PowerLogic P5 locally and the remote Syslog server (if configured) keeps
record of them.
• Disabled logical and physical ports can no longer be accessed.
It is recommended to repeat the above tests after firmware update or security
policy update.
Use
Introduction
The local panel can be used for both entering all the data required for operation of
the PowerLogic P5 protection relay and accessing the data for equipment
management.
The following tasks can be handled from the local panel:
• Controlling switchgear units:
◦ View equipment status on an animated mimic diagram
◦ Local opening and closing of up to 6 devices controlled by PowerLogic P5
• Read out the list of enabled protections
• Readout and modification of settings
• Readout of live operating data including waveforms
• Read out logic status signals
• Readout of operating data logs and of monitoring signal logs
• Readout of event logs after overload situations, ground faults, or short circuits
in the power system
• Read out the PowerLogic P5 protection relay's module versions
• Device resetting and triggering of additional control functions used in testing
and commissioning
• Test the protection relay with dedicated IED modes (contact outputs forced or
not)
• Entering a password according to different access rights for settings and
operations (see Cybersecurity, page 176)
Control is also possible through the PC interface. This requires a suitable PC
installed with a specific operating program called eSetup Easergy Pro (see eSetup
Easergy Pro, page 239).
Local panel
Presentation
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay is equipped with a user friendly local panel.
1 2 3 4
5
ON !
Bay
6
0 A
0 A
0 A
0.00 A 7
22
9
21
20 10
19 11
18 12
Open
is perfect is a Queen
Jean-Marc Linda
Close
is perfect is a Queen
Jean-Marc Linda
13
14
17
15 P533MSB
16
1 2 3 4
5
ON !
Bay
6
0 A
0 V
0 VA
0 kW
0 kVAr 7
0 Hz
22
9
21
20 F1 F2 F3 10
19 F4 F5 F6 F7
11
18
Open
is perfect is a Queen
12
Jean-Marc Linda
Close
is perfect is a Queen
Jean-Marc Linda
13
14
17
P533MTB
16 15
Push buttons
Symbol Function
This push button allows the user to set the PowerLogic P5 protection relay to
remote control mode or local control mode.
LED indicators
Status indicators
This includes the 4 LEDs located on top of the LCD representing the different
status of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay regarding power, alarm, trip, and
operation mode (refer to item 1 to 4 in Local panel of PowerLogic P5x20, page
221 and Local panel of PowerLogic P5x30, page 222) and the LED associated
with the "Local/Remote" push button (refer to item 19 in Local panel of
PowerLogic P5x20, page 221 and Local panel of PowerLogic P5x30, page 222).
Indicators States
OFF ON Flash
Power OFF Power ON -
No trip Trip -
Configurable LEDs
These LEDs can be configured in three different colors: green, red and yellow, and
be individually latched or unlatched (see LED matrix, page 488).
These LEDs are configured by default according to LED1 to LED6 on PowerLogic
P5 x20, page 224 and LED1 to LED10 on PowerLogic P5 x30, page 224.
Green CB Open
PowerLogic P5V20
Green CB Open
Color LED 1 LED 2 LED 3 LED 4 LED 5 LED 6 LED 7 LED 8 LED 9 LED 10
Green CB Open
If it is, the PowerLogic P5 protection relay proceeds to the default screen; If it isn't,
a message is displayed, prompting the user to either keep or discard the content
of the extension module. If the user selects the “Block new backup” option, the
content is kept, the PowerLogic P5 protection relay will block the backup
operation; If the user selects the “Discard” option, the protection relay directly
reconfigures from the extension module.
Menu structure
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay has two levels of menus: the main menu
(home menu) and sub-menus.
NOTE: The hierarchy and navigation of the menu structure are the same on
PowerLogic P5x20 and PowerLogic P5x30, but due to a larger resolution, the
PowerLogic P5x30 LCD color screens can display data and graphics in
greater detail.
The PowerLogic P5 device is delivered with auto-login feature. It will be disabled
when the passwords for all three levels are changed from the default ones. For the
default passwords for all the levels, refer to Default settings, page 192.
1 2 3 4
P533MUA
The main menu screen has 2 widgets: the top title bar, and the main display area.
The top title bar shows the following items:
• Menu name: full name of the menu item that is being selected (the names
next to the menu icons use their short forms)
• Home icon: located on the left side of the top title bar, indicates that the
current screen is the home screen of the LCD display
• Padlock icon ( ): located on the right side of the top title bar, indicating that
no user has logged in to the device; the icon disappears when any user has
logged in.
• Remote/Local control icon: located on the right end of the top title bar,
indicates the protection relay's current control mode
P533MVB
P533RXA
The main display area lists all the menu items (sub-menus) of the PowerLogic P5
protection relay.
In the main menu, pressing the navigation keys on the local panel moves the
focus onto a main menu item (sub-menu). The sub-menu title is displayed in the
top title bar of the main menu screen. Pressing allows the user to enter the
highlighted sub-menu.
Sub menus
Figure 180 - The Measurement sub-menu
P533MWA
In the sub-menu, pressing or key moves the focus onto a sub-menu item
and pressing selects the item and allows the user to enter the setting page of
the item.
NOTE: There could be more menu items than is able to be displayed in the
view. The user needs to scroll to these items using the key.
Data/setting page
Some sub-menu items may have more than one data/setting pages, which is
indicated by an arrow on either the left or right end, or by arrows on both ends of
the title bar:
• Arrow on the right end
Pressing the key scrolls the screen to the next data/setting page.
• Arrow on the left end
Pressing the key scrolls the screen to the previous data/setting page.
• Arrows on both the left and right ends
Pressing the or key scrolls the screen to the previous or next data/
setting page, respectively.
Upon seeing the desired data/setting page, pressing allows the user to enter
the data/setting page, and after that, pressing the or key moves the focus
onto each parameter field.
NOTE: There could be more parameters than is able to be displayed in the
view. The user needs to scroll to these parameters using the key.
When an editable parameter is in focus, pressing opens the parameter
setting view and enables the user to change the value or option by pressing the
navigation arrow keys. When a non-editable parameter is in focus, pressing
key pops up a message, indicating that the parameter is not editable. When the
user is not fully authorised to edit the setting, pressing key pops up a
"Permission denied" message.
When changing the settings, use the navigation keys according to the following
instructions to get the result quickly:
• For selecting options, use the and keys;
• For changing the value of integer numbers, use either the and keys, or
the and keys;
• For changing the value of float numbers, first use the and keys to
quickly approach the integer part of the number in steps of 1 and then use the
and keys to adjust the decimal part in steps of 0.01.
In the protection menu, some protection stage items have a first setting page with
more than one view. These views belong to different setting groups of the
protection stage. In this case, upon selecting the menu item, an additional text line
"Press OK to edit groups" is displayed at the top of the main display area to
indicate that here the user can edit the settings of different setting groups.
Pressing the key to enter the group editing status. Pressing the and
keys to scroll to the setting view for the desired setting group.
OK
P533MXA
Figure 182 - Moving in the menu structure of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay
1 2 3 4 5
OK OK OK OK
OK P533MYA
Press key to enter the sub menu (2), the data/setting page selecting view (3),
the parameter selecting view (4), or the parameter editing view (5), depending on
where the user is situated in menu structure.
key is also used to confirm and finalise the editing in the parameter editing
view.
1 2 3 4
P533S4A
Login
The user may need to log in before changing settings or accessing the data
protected by password. The PowerLogic P5 device is delivered with auto-login
feature. It will be disabled when the passwords for all three levels are changed
from the default ones. For the default passwords for all three levels, refer to
Default settings, page 192.
The Login screen can be accessed from the main menu or through the key on
the local panel. The following login procedure starts from the main menu.
1. Press the navigation keys and then the key to enter the User Login menu
from the main menu screen.
The screen displays the Login view with the focus on the "Name" field.
2. Press to show the user list, which displays the three default user levels
provided by the PowerLogic P5: Engineer Level, Operator Level and Installer
Level.
3. Press or key to select a user name from the user list and then press
to confirm your choice.
4. Enter the password by first pressing or key to select the code position,
and then pressing or key to select different letter or digits and pressing
to confirm.
NOTE: After a correct password is entered, the LCD display returns to the
home screen and the padlock icon disappears from the screen title bar,
indicating that the user is now able to view/edit the settings, depending on the
access right level of the user type.
NOTE: To access the User Login screen using the key on the local panel,
press and then press the key. This feature enables the user to directly
access the User Login screen from wherever in the menu structure rather than
has to go back to the home screen.
Logout
By default, the user is automatically logged out if there is no action on the keypad
for 3 minutes.
The user can also logout manually by first going to the User Login screen from the
local panel and then pressing the key.
NOTE: To access the User Login screen using the key on the local panel,
press and then press the key. This feature enables the user to directly
access the User Login screen from wherever in the menu structure rather than
has to go back to the home screen.
5. Press key to go back previous view, or keep press the key for 3 seconds to
go back to default screen.
NOTE: The LCD contrast can alternatively be adjusted by pressing the key
and then pressing the and key. The contrast changes incrementally
with every step but the screen does not display the values.
Changing language
The interface language can be changed on the local panel according to the
following steps:
1. Press the navigation keys to select the General settings menu from the main
menu screen, then press key to enter. The screen displays the General
settings menu with the focus on the "Language" option.
2. Press the key to enter the Language setting page.
3. Press the key to focus on the setting item.
4. Press the key again to bring up the language list.
5. Press the or key to select the desired language and then press the
key to confirm the selection.
NOTE: The interface language can alternatively be changed through eSetup
Easergy Pro in the GENERAL menu/System info sub-menu.
WARNING
INOPERABLE PROTECTION RELAY
Make sure that the reboot of the protection relay has no impact on people and
equipment.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or
equipment damage.
After changing some settings, the protection relay needs to reboot. During this
time, the device is not operational.
Parameters can be changed on the setting pages of certain sub-menus:
1. In the main menu, enter the menu item that relates to the function you need to
access.
Refer to Main menu (home menu), page 226 for how to access the menu
items.
2. In the sub-menu, select the sub-menu item that includes the parameter you
want to change.
Refer to Sub menus, page 227 for how to access the sub-menu items.
3. With the related sub-menu item selected, press or key to scroll to the
specific setting page on which you can find the parameter and then press
to enter the setting page.
4. Press the or key to move the focus onto the parameter field and then
press the key to start editing the parameter.
5. Use the navigation keys to change the value of the parameter and then press
the key to confirm your change.
Refer to Data/setting page, page 228 for how to use the navigation keys
tactically.
6. Press the key once to go back to the previous view in the menu, or press it
for 3 seconds to return to the default screen.
5. Press the key once to go back to the previous view in the menu, or press it
for about 3 seconds to return the default screen.
NOTE: For viewing the alarm list, press key once to go to the Alarm list
page after Step 2.
Matrix operations
The matrix mapping operation can be performed on the local panel of the
PowerLogic P5 protection relay, in the eSetup Easergy Pro software tool, or
through the web HMI.
The following procedure describes the mapping operation on the local panel of the
PowerLogic P5 protection relay. The operation is much easier in eSetup Easergy
Pro and the web HMI due to their intuitive interfaces.
1. Select the Control function from the main menu, press to enter the sub-
menu.
2. Press or key to scroll to the menu item (e.g. DI) that needs matrix
mapping operation.
3. Press or key to scroll to the matrix mapping page and start the
mapping operation.
NOTE: The local panel LCD screen only shows the first line of mapping
relations already existing in the configuration. If no mapping relation is
available for the first line of the matrix, the screen only shows the digital
input or internal signal on the left side of the screen.
4. Press or key to scroll to the digital input or internal signal type and
then press to confirm. The first crossing point on the matrix line starts to
blink.
5. Press or key to scroll to the crossing point for which you want to set
the mapping status.
NOTE: Some crossing points may not be visible in the screen but the user
can view all the crossing points by pressing key.
6. Press or key to select the mapping status (enabled or disabled;
connected or unconnected; latched or unlatched, depending on which matrix
mapping operation is being performed) and then press to confirm.
The screen shows the current line of mapping relations, leaving the empty
crossing points invisible on the screen.
7. Press key to leave the matrix setting page and then key to return to the
preview level in the menu structure.
Controlling objects
The local panel provides buttons for directly controlling objects like circuit breaker
and earth/ground switch. The user do not need to go through the menu to find out
the options for closing/opening the objects.
1. Use navigation keys to select and press key to enter Device/Test sub
menu. Select USB key and press key to enter the view of Copy files to
USB. Insert USB Key to the USB port in front of local panel.
The USB key detected status will be changed from “No” to “Yes”
automatically.
Copy files to USB 1/1
USB key detected No Yes
P533OKB
2. Press key to enable selection. Select Copy to USB key and then select
All to copy all the files from the protection relay to USB key.
Copy files to USB 1/1
Copy P5 to USB
USB key detected Yes
Copy to USB key -
Safe remove -
Copy files to USB 1/1
Edit:Copy P5 to USB
-
ALL
P533OJB
3. A progress bar will be displayed on the screen for a short while. After finished
copy, a “Success” message will be displayed. Please press key to close
this message.
Success
P533O9B
4. To remove USB key, please select Safe remove, then select On and press
key.
Copy files to USB 1/1
Safe remove USB
USB key detected Yes
Copy to USB key -
Safe remove -
Copy files to USB 1/1
Edit:Safe remove USB
-
On
P533S0A
WARNING
INOPERABLE PROTECTION RELAY
Make sure that the reboot of the protection relay has no impact on people and
equipment.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or
equipment damage.
After changing some settings, the protection relay needs to reboot. During this
time, the device is not operational.
eSetup Easergy Pro is a setting and operating software tool for configuring
PowerLogic P5 devices, local operation and customisation functions.
The eSetup Easergy Pro software is supplied directly through the Schneider
Electric website www.se.com, along with the eSetup Easergy Pro program for
recovering disturbance recording files, and all the PowerLogic P5 documentation
in PDF format.
Figure 183 - eSetup Easergy Pro menu bar and tool bar
The eSetup Easergy Pro software has a graphical interface where the protection
relay settings and parameters are grouped under nine menu tabs:
• General
• Measurements
• Control
• Protection
• Matrix
• Logs
• Communication
• Device/Test
• Documentation
The contents of the tabs depend on the device type and the selected application
mode. Refer to the User Manual of eSetup Easergy Pro for detailed information on
the setting views of each menu.
The eSetup Easergy Pro stores the device configuration in a setting file. The
configuration of one physical device is saved in one setting file. The configurations
can be printed out and saved for later use.
When starting to work with eSetup Easergy Pro, there are three options:
• Create a new setting file without connecting to a protection relay
• Open an existing (previously saved) setting file without connecting to a
protection relay
• Connect to a relay and read the settings from the protection relay .
eSetup Easergy Pro can be connected to a single relay via the mini-USB port in
the protection relay's local panel or to a group of protection relays via Ethernet.
Operation modes
The eSetup Easergy Pro software can be used in three operation modes:
• Disconnected mode
• Single unit connecting mode
• Network connecting mode
NOTICE
UNINTENDED EQUIPMENT OPERATION AND NUISANCE TRIPPING
After writing new settings, configurations or firmware to a protection relay,
perform a test to verify that the protection relay operates correctly with the new
settings.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unwanted shutdown of
the electrical installation.
P533N5A
1. Connect the USB cable (reference 59700) to the front port of the
PowerLogic P5 protection relay and the PC (see Connecting a PC to the
PowerLogic P5 using a USB cable, page 240), after that look for a new COM
port under COM & LPT in the Device Manager window of the PC.
If you are unsure which is the right port, detach the USB cable and insert it
again when you are in this menu.
2. Right-click on the port and select Update Driver Software from the
contextual menu.
3. Select the option Browse my computer for driver software and locate the
driver in the P5 driver_files folder under the eSetup Easergy Pro directory.
4. Click the Install button in the prompt window to start installing the driver.
5. If the driver has been installed successfully, the connection now appears
under Network adapters in the Device Manager window each time you
connect the PC to a PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
Web HMI
Overview
The web HMI is used for operation and settings. It has the same functions as
eSetup Easergy Pro except the logic and mimic customisation.
The web HMI can be accessed using the following browsers343536:
pre-installed certification ■ ■ -
pre-installed certification ■ ■ ■
Firefox
1. Enter "https://192.168.1.21" in the Firefox address bar, it will show
the left message.
Click Advanced to show more information.
4. Close the certificate viewing window and then click the Confirm
Security Exception button.
The login page will be opened.
5. Now the certificate file is already imported into Firefox and you find
it in Certificate Manager of Firefox browser.
6. Click Finish to import the certificate and close the Certificate Import
Wizard window.
Edge in Windows 10
The following procedure for accessing the PowerLogic P5 web HMI uses the IE
browser for illustration. The screen shots for the Edge browser are identical.
5. Click Certificates in the left box and then click Add button.
The Certificates Snap-in window appears.
11. Click Browse and then, in the pop-up dialog box, select the path of
the certificate followed by the certificate name "192.168.1.21.p12" (the
suffix of the certificate is "p12").
Note that the file type should be All Files.
14. Type in the password "secbrick", check the Mark this key as
exportable... option, and then click Next.
The "Certificate Store" window appears.
.
15. Check the Place all certificates in the following store option,
browse to the certificate store folder "Trusted Root Certification
Authorities", and then click Next.
The certificate import settings page appears.
17. After the certificate has been imported successfully, set up the
Edge browser by checking the Use TLS 1.0, Use TLS 1.1, and Use
TLS 1.2 options under the Advanced tab of Internet options.
Protection functions
General features of protection stages
Enable/disable protection functions
The different stages of the protection function can be enabled/disabled
individually.
If a protection function stage is disabled, it is not shown in the PROTECTION
menu in the local panel.
To enable or disable a protection function stage:
• With eSetup Easergy Pro or Web HMI, enter the PROTECTION menu/Valid
protection stages sub-menu or directly go to each protection stage view in
the same menu.
• With the local panel, enter the Home menu/PROTECTION sub-menu/List of
protection enabled menu item/Enabled Stages menu item.
The Enabled Stages menu item allows to enable or disable the protection
stage(s) of a protection function. If a protection stage is enabled here, it
appears in the PROTECTION menu as a menu option.
For the motor protection, there is a dedicated Motor status view (PROTECTION
menu/Motor status sub-menu) where it is possible to enable or disable the
following protection functions:
• Thermal overload protection for machine (ANSI code 49M)
• Motor start-up supervision (ANSI code 48)
• Motor restart inhibition (ANSI code 66)
• Locked rotor (ANSI code 51LR)
• Motor Anti-backspin (ABS) protection
• Motor speed detection
• Emergency restart
NOTE: The Motor status view is comprised of settings (e.g. nominal motor
start current) common to these functions.
Setting groups
Setting groups are controlled by using controlling inputs like digital inputs, function
keys, virtual inputs, HMI or custom logic.
When none of the assigned inputs are active, the active setting group is defined by
parameter Setting group control in the PROTECTION menu/Valid protection
stages sub-menu via eSetup Easergy Pro.
When one controlling input activates, the corresponding setting group is activated
as well. If multiple inputs are active at the same time, the active setting group
follows the definition by 'Setting group priority'.
By using virtual I/O the active setting group can be controlled using the local panel
display, any communication protocol, or in-built programmable logic functions.
When a controlling input is configured, the Setting group parameter in the same
menu is not operational.
Setting group changes are applied simultaneously to all protection functions.
Directional operation
A global CT polarity setting is available in the GENERAL menu/Scaling submenu.
These phase and neutral CT polarity settings affect:
• up to version v01.4xx.yyy only the ground differential protection function REF.
NOTE: All other measurements and directional protection elements are
not affected from this setting and still operate on measured current(s) and
voltage(s) as per function description.
• from version v01.5xx.yyy additionally all measurements and directional
protection elements (directional phase and neutral overcurrent, directional
power, Wattmetric E/F, ...).
Blocking
Any protection function, except arc-flash protection (see Arc-flash (ANSI 50ARC),
page 369), can be blocked with internal and external signals using the block
matrix. Internal signals are, for example, logic outputs, start and trip signals from
other stages and external signals are for example digital and virtual inputs.
Some protection stages have also inbuilt blocking functions. For examples, phase
overcurrent has an input for inrush detection.
When a protection stage is blocked, it won't trip in case of a fault condition. If
blocking is activated during the operation delay, the delay counting is frozen until
the blocking condition is off or the start resets, that is, the fault condition
disappears. If the stage is already tripping, the blocking has no effect. See
Blocking matrix, page 486 for more information.
Overshoot time
Overshoot time is the time the protection relay needs to notice that a fault has
been cleared during the operate time. This characteristic is important when
grading the operate time settings between relays.
A
B
D P533A0B
For example, when there is a heavy fault in an outgoing feeder, it will start both the
incoming and outgoing feeder relay. However, the fault must be cleared by the
outgoing feeder protection relay and the incoming feeder relay must not trip.
Although the operating delay setting of the incoming feeder is more than that of
the outgoing feeder, the incoming feeder might still trip if the operate time
difference is not big enough. The difference must be more than the overshoot time
of the incoming feeder relay plus the operate time of the outgoing feeder circuit
breaker.
Definition for overshoot time, page 256 shows an overvoltage fault seen by the
incoming feeder when the outgoing feeder clears the fault. If the operation delay
setting would be slightly shorter or if the fault duration would be slightly longer than
in the figure, an unselective trip might happen (the dashed pulse in the figure). In
devices, the overshoot time is less than 50 ms.
Figure 186 - Disengaging time and adjustable reset time according to IEC
60255-151 standard
Energising
quantity above
Setting value
Start (pick-up)
signal
Operate
signal
Value of
internal time
delay counter
Tr Tr Disengaging time
The adjustable reset time is a definite or inverse time hold used mainly to detect
restriking faults (DT) or allow coordination with electromechanical protection
relays (Inverse). It can be used also for coordination with electromechanical
relays.
It is implemented in the following protection functions:
• Non-directional/directional phase overcurrent protection (ANSI 50/51/67)
• Non-directional/directional earth/ground fault overcurrent protection (ANSI
50N/51N/67N)
• Negative sequence overcurrent (ANSI 46)
B
C
D P533A2B
The reset ratio is the ratio between the reset level and the start level. To avoid any
chattering of the protection for low settings of thresholds, a reset ratio can be
claimed with a minimum value of hysteresis. For example: <93% with a minimum
of hysteresis of 0.005 Inom.
C
B
D P533A3B
Accuracy claims
All accuracy claims on operation and reset thresholds and times are based on
tests performed according to related functional standard of the IEC 60255-1xx
series.
Unless explicitly stated (or required per standard) the tests were executed under
reference conditions:
• quasi-stationary semisolid signals at nominal frequency fnom (frequency
protection excepted)
• total harmonic distortion ≤ 2 %
• ambient temperature 20°C (68°F)
• nominal auxiliary voltage VA.nom
Deviations are claimed relative to the setting under such reference conditions,
where required also with an additional absolute value (usually relevant at very
small/ low set thresholds only).
could contain information like time stamp, fault value, elapsed delay, fault current,
fault voltage, phase angle and setting group.
IS I
P533A4B
t (s)
It (A)
P533A5B
Operation modes
There are two operation modes to use the dependent time characteristics:
• Standard delays
Using standard delay characteristics by selecting the Operating curve
parameter in dedicated protection function. See Standard dependent
operation delay, page 262.
• Fully programmable dependent delay characteristics
Building the characteristics by setting 16 [current, time] points. The relay
interpolates the values between given points with second degree
polynomials. This mode is activated by the setting curve family to "PrgN",
where N = 1, 2, 3, corresponding to the three different programmable curves
available. Each programmed curve can be used independently by any
number of protection stages. See Programmable dependent time curves,
page 264.
Limitations
The minimum definite operation time starts when the measured value exceed the
GD37 value, which is varied for different curves.
Curve GD ( x GS)
IEC SI 30
IEC VI 30
IEC EI 20
IEC LTI 30
UK RECT 15
RI 36
IEEE MI 76
IEEE VI 76
IEEE EI 76
NI CO8 76
STI CO2 76
LTI CO5 76
MI CO7 76
VI CO9 76
EI CO11 76
IEC UTI 76
FR STI 76
BPN 76
ANSI NI 76
ANSI STI 76
ANSI LTI 76
k
t(s) = TMS × + c
(
α
G ( −p
GS
P533OWB
where:
• t(s) is the operate time in seconds.
• G is the measured value.
• GS is the start value.
• TMS is Time Multiplier Setting.
Description k c α p
according to
IEC60255-151
standard
Data attribute setParA setParB setParC setParD SetCharact
according to IEC
61850-7-3 standard
IEC Standard 0.14 0 0.02 1 9
Inverse (IEC/A)
IEC Extremely 80 0 2 1 12
Inverse (IEC/C)
Description k c α p
according to
IEC60255-151
standard
Data attribute setParA setParB setParC setParD SetCharact
according to IEC
61850-7-3 standard
Long-Time Inverse 4.842 1.967 1.1 1 23
(CO5)
NOTE:
• SetCharact is for DT curve: 5.
• The effective operate value GT defined in IEC 60255-151 is equal to 1.05
x GS.
tr
treset (I) = TMS ×
(
p
1 − G (
GS
P533OXB
The reset time characteristic is defined by a setting in the protection stage. The
allowed settings are dependent on the operate curve as shown in the table.
DT - - Yes
IEC Standard Inverse (IEC/A) 8.2 6.45 Yes
The TMS (inverse time coefficient) of the IDMT reset curve is the one defined for
the operating curve.
For all operating curves not listed in the table above, the reset curve is of DT type.
1 1.00 10.00 s
2 2.00 6.50 s
3 5.00 4.00 s
4 10.00 3.00 s
5 20.00 2.00 s
6 40.00 1.00 s
7 1.00 0.00 s
8 1.00 0.00 s
9 1.00 0.00 s
10 1.00 0.00 s
11 1.00 0.00 s
12 1.00 0.00 s
13 1.00 0.00 s
14 1.00 0.00 s
15 1.00 0.00 s
16 1.00 0.00 s
Example
Figure 191 - Functionality of cold load current feature
1 3 4
A
2
C P533AHB
C Cold load
1. No activation because the current has not been under the set Idle current.
2. Current dropped under the Idle current level but now it stays between the Idle
current and the pick-up current for over 80 ms.
3. No activation because the phase two lasted longer than 80 ms.
4. Now we have a cold load activation which lasts as long as the “CLPU time
delay” was set or as long as the current stays above the pick-up setting.
Characteristics
Table 49 - Settings and characteristics of cold load pick-up function
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Pickup current/Pickup
Resolution 0.01 s
CLPU time delay/Max time
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy 1% or ±20 ms
Operation
To implement the SOL function, downstream and upstream protection should be
set as follows:
Set the downstream protection to send the SOL1 trip signal to upstream relay:
1. Check the Enable for SOL box in the Selective overcurrent logic view of
PROTECTION Menu in Easergy Pro.
2. Select from the drop-down list of SOL signal number.
3. Set the value of CB trip clearing time.
4. Switch to MATRIX menu/Output matrix submenu, configure the PowerLogic
P5 output matrix:
Connect the start signals of the different protections involved in the logic
discrimination to the SOLxStart (x = 1 or 2) signal, then connect the SOLx trip
(x = 1 or 2) signal to a dedicated contact relay or GOOSE output.
Set the upstream protection to receive the SOLx trip signal:
1. Configure the PowerLogic P5 output matrix:
Connect the dedicated logic input (DI or GOOSE input signal), linked with the
downstream SOLx trip signal, to the SOL Inputx signal.
2. Switch to PROTECTION menu, select specific protection function in the left
column, set the SOL status to the value "SOLx"
3. Set the SOL operate delay to a value higher than the value of the setting
Operate delay.
Up to two output signals can be provided by the SOL function.
The value of the setting SOL operate delay should be greater than the value of
the setting Operate delay in the overcurrent protection plus the value of the
setting CB trip clearing time in the SOL function. The setting SOL operate delay
can make sure the downstream protection tripping with selectivity. The setting CB
trip clearing time is used to set the release time of the SOL trip signal for the
downstream protection.
If a fault occurs at downstream, the downstream protection issues a trip command
to isolate the fault according to the value of the setting Operate delay. Then a
global trip signal is activated by the trip signal. At the same time, a timer with the
value of the setting CB trip clearing time is triggered by the global trip signal and
starts timing. If the downstream protection successfully isolates the fault, the SOL
signal is released and all the P5 relays of the upstream protection will be reset. If
the downstream protection cannot clear the fault due to a CB fail, when the
tripping duration time of the downstream protection exceeds the value of the
setting CB trip clearing time, consequently upstream protection nearest to the
downstream protection will switch the value of the setting SOL operate delay to
the value of the setting Operate delay due to no reception of the SOL signal.
Then the protection will trip immediately.
The SOL operate delay of the upstream protection usually takes into account the
breaking device operating time and the protection reset time.
Downstream
Relay Prot. Start
CB Failure!
Matrix = Operate delay T
Prot. Trip
SOLx Start
Wire connection
or GOOSE message
Upstream
Relay
Digital Inputx
Matrix
“SOL operate delay” is selected
for Operate delay
SOL Status comparison
Prot. Start
= Operate delay T
Example 1
Figure 192 - Example 1: Radial distribution with use of time-based
discrimination
0.6
0.4
0.2
Example 2
Figure 193 - Example 2: Radial distribution with use of logic discrimination
Bay
A
0 V
0 VA
0 kW
0 kVAr
0 Hz
0
Bay
A
0 V
0 VA
0 kW
0 kVAr
0 Hz
0
Bay
A
0 V
0 VA
0 kW
0 kVAr
0 Hz
0
SOL
Bay
A
0 V
0 VA
0 kW
0 kVAr
0 Hz
0
P533S3B
B A
A Substation 1 B Substation 2
Starting at one end of the ring, the detection direction of PowerLogic P5 unit 1 and
2 of the directional protection functions should be alternated between line and
busbars.
Characteristics
Settings and characteristics Values
SOL1Start
Options39 -; Trip
SOL2Start
Options39 -; Trip
Range 1, 2
Resolution 0.01 s
PowerLogic P5
P533AJB
VA - VB
ZAB =
IA - IB - Ipre-fault P533AKB
IA Phase A current
IB Phase B current
The reference current setting is used to start the calculation of the fault locator
based on the pre-fault current magnitude. The calculation can be triggered by a
digital or logic input.
Example
An application example where the fault location algorithm is used at the incomer
side is presented below. The settings of the Incomer fault locator function is
configured in the PROTECTION menu/Incomer fault locator sub-menu.
Figure 195 - Illustration of the fault location algorithm used at the incomer
side
dI
I
A B D
C P533R1B
Characteristics
Table 50 - Setting parameters of incomer fault locator
VA - VB
ZAB =
IA - I B P533ANB
IA Phase A current
IB Phase B current
When the feeder fault locator is calculating ground fault impedance, the following
is used (e.g. for phase A):
VA
ZA =
IA + k IN P533APB
IA Phase A current
IN.calc = IA + IB + IC P533ARB
Example
An application example where the fault location algorithm is used at the feeder
side is presented below. The settings of the feeder fault locator function is
configured in the PROTECTION menu/Feeder fault locator sub-menu.
Figure 196 - Illustration of the fault location algorithm used at the feeder side
I dI
A B D
C
P533R2B
Characteristics
Table 52 - Settings and characteristics of the feeder fault locator function
(ANSI 21FL)
Operation
Operation of admittance protection
The admittance protection is non-directional. Hence, provided the magnitude of
admittance exceeds the set value YN>1, the protection relay will operate.
Ys
A
* Y = G + jB Y > Ys
P533AUB
A Operate zone
B B B
A A A A
G > Gs G < -Gs G < -Gs G > Gs
Gs G -Gs G -Gs Gs G
P533RYA
P533RZA
P533AVB
A Operate zone
NOTE:
Center of the characteristic area for forward direction occurs when IN is in
phase with -VN.
Assuming that the direction of the G axis is 0°. If the correction angle is set to
+30°, this rotates the boundary from 90°...270° to 60°...240°.
+30° A
G > Gs
Gs G
P533AWB
A Operate zone
B B B
A A
B > Bs B > Bs
Bs Bs
G G G
-Bs -Bs
A A
B < -Bs B < -Bs
P533S1A
P533S2A
P533AXB
A Operate zone
NOTE:
Center of characteristic area for forward direction occurs when IN leads -VN
by 90°.
Assuming that the direction of the G axis indicates 0°. If the correction angle is
set to +30°, this rotates the boundary from 0°...180° to 330°...150°.
A
B > Bs
+30°
P533AYB
A Operate zone
Block diagram
>
Start
&
& Register event
Trip
YN > &
Register event
& Drop off
VN > &
Register event
IN >
Start
&
A & Register event
GN > Trip
&
Register event
Drop off
&
Register event
Start
&
& Register event
BN > Trip
&
Register event
Drop off
GN C &
Register event
B
BN D
Inhibit Ctrl
Block
Characteristics
Table 55 - Settings and characteristics of the neutral admittance protection
Settings/ Values
characteristics
(description/label)
VN pick-up value/VN>
Resolution 0.001
Accuracy ±5%
IN minimum
Value 0.1 A primary (fixed), for current measured by CSH core balance CT
(2A)
1 A primary (fixed), for current measured by CSH core balance CT (20A)
0.005 pu43 (fixed) for current measured by sensitive EF CT
0.02 pu43 (fixed) for current measured by standard EF CT
0.005 pu43 (fixed) for current measured by standard EF CT (for CSH30
use)
0.05 pu43 (fixed) for calculated EF current value
Enable YN>1/GN>1/BN>144
Options Off/On
Pick-up value/YN>1
Pick-up value/GN>1
Settings/ Values
characteristics
(description/label)
Accuracy ±5%
Pick-up value/BN>1
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±5% or ±50 ms
SOL1/SOL1
Options Disable/Enable
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±5% or ±20 ms
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±5% or ±20 ms
Characteristic time
Start time ≤ 65 ms at 2 YN>1
100 ms at maximum
Overshoot time ≤ 40 ms at 2 YN>1
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 4
46. YN.nom
B V/f
n= =
Bn Vn / fn P533TJA
Where:
• n: the overexcitation ratio.
• B, Bn: actual and nominal values of flux density of transformer cores.
• V, Vn: actual and nominal voltage of transformer windings, phase to phase
voltage.
• f, fn: actual and nominal frequency.
According to the overexcitation ratio, one three-stage overfluxing (V/f) element
protects the transformer against overexcitation:
• One alarm stage with DT delay (V/f Alarm)
• One trip stage with DT or IDMT delay (V/f>1)
• One trip stage with DT delay (V/f>2)
The element measures the ratio of voltage to frequency and operates when this
ratio exceeds the setting. When the flux level drops below the reset value (set
pickup value minus hysteresis), the reset timer starts.
Conditions
The element is valid only when the VT measures VP or VPP. Otherwise, the
element is invisible on the HMI screen and in Easergy Pro.
Whether the VT measures VP or VPP, the voltage used in overfluxing element is
VPP.
The element is operational only when the measured frequency is 45Hz to 55Hz for
fnom = 50 Hz; 54Hz to 66Hz for fnom = 60 Hz.
The overfluxing element is equipped with a definite-time reset time for inverse-
time trip characteristic.
Function decomposition
V/f Alarm stage (DT)
The definite-time alarm stage is used to indicate unhealthy conditions before
damage of the transformer. The “V/f Alarm” signal is issued when the
overexcitation multiple is greater than the setting of pick-up value of the operate
delay.
The “V/f Alarm” signal can be issued only when “Enable for V/f Alarm” is on.
Definite-time delay
When the overexcitation multiple is greater than the setting of pick-up value, “V/
f>1 Start” signal will be issued. The “V/f>1 Trip” signal will be issued in case of the
“V/f>1 Start” signal is active for the operate delay.
Inverse-time delay
When the overexcitation multiple is greater than the setting of pick-up value, “V/
f>1 Start” signal will be issued. There are three delay curves for selection of
inverse time delay (IDMT) setting: Prg1, Prg2, Prg3. Each curve is composed by
16 operation values and delays. For overfluxing, the value of “Gs” is always 1.00.
The “V/f>1 Trip” signal will be issued according to the operation values of selected
curve.
V/f>1 Reset 0%
t
V/f
Reset
time
V/f>1 Start
t
P533TLA
This implies that the V/f>1 trip replica is limited to 100% and kept at 100%, even if
the V/f>1 Start condition persists (for example, broken trip circuit). Likewise, the V/
f>1 trip replica never can drop below 0% level.
Block diagram
Figure 204 - Block diagram of the Transformer Overfluxing Protection (ANSI
24)
Voltage >
V/f
Alarm
Vn / fn
Frequency
V/f>1 Start
>
V/f>1 Trip
V/f>1 Start
>
V/f>1 Trip
V/f>2 Start
>
V/f>2 Trip
Characteristics
Table 56 - Settings and characteristics of the transformer overfluxing
protection
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Enable On/Off
Pick-up value 1.05...1.60
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Definite-time delay
Inverse-time delay
Enable On/Off
Pick-up value 1.05...1.60
Characteristics
Starting resetting ratio 95% ±2%
47. Setting for the operate delay of the definite-time trip stage.
48. Setting for the reset time defines the decreasing rate at the inverse-time characteristic.
Condition to operate
Synchro request
request timeout
Sync OK
OK pulse length
Sync fail
P533ALB
NOTE: The CB close time setting can be used to anticipate the closing of the
CB and meet all the conditions to operate.
Voltage checking
When one of the two voltage is absent, coupling may be authorised according to
one of the seven checking modes.
• VAB and VABy absent (DD)
• VAB absent and VABy present (DL)
• VAB present and VABy absent (LD)
• VAB absent regardless of VABy state (present or absent) (DD/DL)
• VABy absent regardless of VAB state (present or absent) (DD/LD)
• One voltage is present while the other one is absent (DL/LD)
• At least one voltage is absent (DD/DL/LD)
The presence of each voltage is detected by comparing the voltage to the Vlive
limit setting. The absence of each voltage is detected by comparing the voltage to
Vdead limit setting.
Block diagram
Figure 206 - Block diagram of the synchro-check protection function (ANSI 25)
|Δφ| < dφ
&
< 2° sync ok
VABy >
≥1
close enable
< & DO
≥1 DD/DL/LD
< ≥1
DD/DL
LD T 0 no voltage
&
≥1
DL/LD
& DL
≥1
DD/DL
no VAB
no VABy
A Async B Sync
Characteristics
Table 57 - Setting and characteristics of the synchro-check function (ANSI
25)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01 s
Vdead limit setting/Vdead
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01 Hz
Accuracy ±20 mHz
Resolution 1°
Accuracy ±2° when Δf < 0.2 Hz; else ±5°
Resolution 0.1 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Setting groups/SetGrp
Number 4
t(G) = T
1 (G
GS ) P533ORB
where:
• t(G) is the theoretical operate time in seconds with constant value of G.
• T is the time delay setting (theoretical operate time for G = 0).
• G is the measured value of the characteristic quantity.
• GS is the setting value.
The [voltage, time] curve points are programmed using eSetup Easergy Pro.
There are some rules for defining the curve points:
• the configuration must begin from the top line
• the line order must be as follows: the smallest voltage (shortest operate time)
on the top and the largest voltage (longest operate time) on the bottom
• all unused lines (on the bottom) should be filled with G/GS= 1.00 and operate
time = 0.00 s
Here is an example configuration of curve points:
1 0.10 0.00 s
2 0.10 0.10 s
3 0.70 0.10 s
4 0.70 0.50 s
5 0.90 1.00 s
6 1.00 0.00 s
7 1.00 0.00 s
8 1.00 0.00 s
9 1.00 0.00 s
10 1.00 0.00 s
11 1.00 0.00 s
12 1.00 0.00 s
13 1.00 0.00 s
14 1.00 0.00 s
15 1.00 0.00 s
16 1.00 0.00 s
Reset delay
The V< stage has a settable reset delay that enables the detection of intermittent
faults. This means that the time counter of the protection function does not reset
immediately after the fault is cleared, but resets after the release delay has
elapsed. If the fault appears again before the release delay time has elapsed, the
delay counter continues from the previous value. This means that the function
eventually trips if faults are occurring often enough.
Operate mode
The setting "Tripping logic" is available to configure the operate mode. When
"Tripping logic" is "Any phase", the general trip signal "V< trip" is raised when any
phase operates. When "Tripping logic" is "Three phases", the signal "V< trip" is
raised only when all three phases operate.
Block diagram
Figure 207 - Block diagram of the Undervoltage protection function (ANSI
27)
≥1
A Trip
VTS Block ≥1
&
Block
≥1
B Trip
CB Open Blocking & Register event
&
≥1
C Trip
& Register event
≥1
V< start
Trip Logic Check
≥1
V< trip
P533OSC
A Select setting
B &
A
≥1
VA / VAB Start ≥1
VC / VCA Start
&
&
Tripping logic
P533OTB
C “Three ph”
Characteristics
Table 59 - Settings and characteristics of the Undervoltage protection (ANSI
27)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Enable V</V<
Options Off/On
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Options Off/On
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy DT: ±1% or ±10 ms
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±5% or ±30 ms
Hysteresis/Hysteresis
Resolution 1.0%
Accuracy ±2%
Characteristic times
Start time < 40 ms/35 ms with high speed
Number 4
52. Vnom = VT primary nominal (PP) or Vnom/√3 = VT primary nominal (PN) depending on measurement mode parameter setting.
H
D
B F
block limit
J
A G
time
A The maximum phase to phase voltage is below G The maximum phase to phase voltage
the block limit. This is not regarded as an is below the block limit and this is not
undervoltage situation. regarded as an undervoltage situation.
Block diagram
Figure 210 - Block diagram for the positive sequence undervoltage
protection
Start
&
Register event
VAB Max
> &
VBC & 0 t Trip
VCA
CB not closed
&
V1< < Register event
Characteristic
Table 60 - Settings and characteristics of the positive sequence
undervoltage protection stages V1<1 and V1<2
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Accuracy ±1%
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±30 ms
Accuracy ±2%
Characteristic times
Start time < 70 ms/65 ms with high speed
Number 4
53. Vnom/√3
54. Common settings for setting group 1, 2, 3, 4.
P
P
A B
P533B2B A B
P533B3B
The start setting range is from -200% to +200% of the nominal apparent power Sn.
The nominal apparent power is determined by the configured voltage and current
transformer values according to equation below.
There are two identical stages available with independent setting parameters.
Each stage is deactivated if the maximum voltage of all phases drops below 5% of
the nominal voltage value.
Block diagram
Figure 213 - Block diagram of the directional power protection
Start
P >0 <
0
VAB Max Trip
VBC < 5% VN
&
Register event
VCA
<0 >
&
Register event
Characteristics
Table 61 - Settings and characteristics of the directional power protection
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Resolution 0.5%
Accuracy ±3% or ±0.5% Sn
Resolution 0.1 s
Accuracy ±1% or ± 150 ms
Characteristic times
Start time < 250 ms
Disengaging time < 500 ms
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 4
IN = IA + IB + IC P533B6B
VN = VA + VB + VC P533B7B
Q0
A B
P0
C
D P533B8B
The protection is deactivated if the neutral voltage is lower than VN pick-up value
setting.
Operation
With a Petersen coil system, the current in a faulty feeder is usually inductive and
in a healthy feeder, capacitive.
For the forward output, a confirmation is applied on the start signal, because the
wattmetric is based on active power and when a restriking fault occurs with a
Petersen coil system, the following phenomenon needs to be considered:
For the backward output, the wattmetric protection is able to detect the capacitive
current circulation in healthy feeders, to see that the fault is on upstream side:
• In steady state, this capacitive current has a phase-shift of 90° with the
neutral voltage. So this capacitive current is not detected because it is outside
the backward characteristic, symmetrical to forward area.
• During the transient, the capacitive current goes first in the backward area,
before to go outside with at the end a phase-shift of 90°. This transient signal
is not used to detect a backward fault with capacitive current, but mainly to
block other protection functions of healthy feeders. This can be the case
when a HV/MV transformer supplies two incomers at the same time (see
Faulty feeder vs. healthy feeder, page 303).
VN
IN
INr IN
IN INv
INa VN VN
Tripping direction
The normal operate area, in PowerLogic P5 protection relay could be set to
forward or reverse area, because sometimes it is not possible to modify CT or VT
connections when there is a mistake in the wirings. In that case, to avoid a
modification of wirings, you can set the operate area to forward (default setting) or
reverse. So if you change the operate area, the confirmation must be applied to
the operate area (which could be forward or reverse).
Block diagram
Figure 216 - Block diagram of the wattmetric earth/ground fault protection function (ANSI 32N)
B Start
& 0 t &
A D Register event
C ≥1 &
0 0
Trip
Block &
Register event
&
S
> &
R
Inh
VN0> INVN> Mode VN> Memory mode: voltage Mem time t> Enable events
Sector Memory mode: time Reset time
P533BAB
C Forward D Confirmation
Characteristics
Table 62 - Settings and characteristics of the wattmetric earth/ground fault
protection
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
IN input/IN input
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Accuracy ±10%
VN pick-up value/VN>
Resolution 1°
Accuracy ±1° with IN and VN measured
±3° with IN and VN calculated
Hysteresis 1° with IN measured
3° with IN calculated
Operate delay/Operate delay
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Characteristic times
Start time < 50 ms/45 ms (with high speed) for power at 2 IN
pick-up value × VN pick-up value
< 55 ms/50 ms (with high speed) for power at 1.2
IN pick-up value × VN pick-up value
< 60 ms/55 ms (with high speed) for power at 1.05
IN pick-up value × VN pick-up value
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 4
Low-current self-blocking
The value of low-current self-blocking could be different in each setting groups. To
avoid unwanted tripping, phase undercurrent protection shall be blocked when
maximum of phase currents drops under the setting.
Phase undercurrent protection will automatically become inactivated if its pickup
threshold is set equal to or lower than this undercurrent blocking limit.
Block diagram
Figure 217 - Block diagram of the phase undercurrent protection function
(ANSI 37)
Trip
Max &
Register event
<
Block
Characteristics
Table 63 - Settings and characteristics of the phase undercurrent protection
function (ANSI 37)
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Resolution 0.1 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Characteristic times
Start time < 60 ms/55 ms with high speed
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 4
58. Inom
Block diagram
Figure 218 - Block diagram of the temperature monitoring function (ANSI 38)
> Trip
RTDx
X = 1-16
&
RTD fault
T > -30 ℃
Characteristics
Table 64 - Setting and characteristics of the temperature monitoring function
(ANSI 38)
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Unit °C
Accuracy ±1°C (±1.8°F)
Alarm delay/AlmDly
Accuracy 1% ± 20 ms
Operate delay/OperDly
Accuracy 1% ± 20 ms
Characteristic times
Start time <3s
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 1
1
( IA + a IB + aIC )
2
I2 =
3 P533BDB
with
2π
j
a=e 3
P533BEB
Block diagram
Figure 219 - Block diagram of the negative sequence overcurrent protection
function (ANSI 46)
IA I2 >
&
IB Start
IC &
Register event
≥1
Block Trip
&
Register event
IDMT characteristics
P533BFC
Characteristics
Table 65 - Settings and characteristics of the negative sequence overcurrent
protection
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
CT input selection60
Option DT;
IEC: SI, VI, EI, LTI, UTI;
IEEE: MI, VI, EI
ANSI: NI, STI, LTI
Others: UK_Rectifier, FR_STI, RI, STI_CO2, LTI_
CO5, MI_CO7, NI_CO8, VI_CO9, EI_CO11, BPN
Prg1-3
TMS/TMS
Setting range 0.020...20.000
Resolution 0.001
DT adder/DT adder
Setting range 0.00...1.00 s
Resolution 0.01 s
Minimum operate delay/Min operate delay
Resolution 0.01 s
Reset curve/Reset curve
Options DT; IDMT; Prg1-3
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Characteristic times
Start time < 50 ms/45 ms (with high speed) for currents at 2 x
Pick-up value
59. Inom
60. Available for P5T30 only.
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 4
1 ( IA + aIB + a2IC )
I1 =
3 P533BGB
1 ( IA + a2IB + aIC )
I2 =
3 P533BHB
If phase swapping feature is used, then this is considered in the calculation of the
sequence currents.
Block diagram
Figure 220 - Block diagram of the unbalance overcurrent broken conductor
protection function (ANSI 46BC)
> &
I2/I1 Start
&
Register event
Block Trip
&
Register event
Characteristics
Table 66 - Settings and characteristics of the unbalance overcurrent broken
conductor protection
Settings/characteristics Value
Resolution 1%
Accuracy ±3%
CT input selection61
Reset ratio
Value 95%
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Characteristic times
Start time < 50 ms/45 ms (with high speed) for currents at 2 x Pick-
up value
< 105 ms/100 ms (with high speed) for P5T30, for currents
at 1.05 x Pick-up value
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 4
t= T
V 1
GS P533BKB
where:
t is the theoretical operate time in seconds.
T is the operate delay setting (theoretical operate time for V = 2 × GS).
V is the calculated value of negative sequence voltage.
GS is the pick-up setting value of the negative sequence overvoltage protection.
The V stage has a settable reset delay that enables the detection of intermittent
faults. This means that the time counter of the protection function does not reset
immediately after the fault is cleared, but resets after the release delay has
elapsed. If the fault appears again before the release delay time has elapsed, the
delay counter continues from the previous value. This means that the function
eventually trips if faults are occurring often enough. This function is blocked by
VTS operation if the setting "VTS operating mode" is set to "Blocking".
Block diagram
Figure 221 - Block diagram of the negative sequence overvoltage protection
(ANSI 47)
> &
V2/Vn
V2
Start
&
Register event
≥1
Blk
VTSInh ≥1 Trip
No &
blk Register event
Block
Characteristics
Table 67 - Settings and characteristics of the negative sequence overvoltage
protection function
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Options DT;
IDMT(the characteristic follows the equation
provided in Description, page 316)
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy DT: ±2% or ±20 ms;
IDMT: ±5% or ±20 ms
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±2% or ±20 ms
Reset ratio
Value 98% ± 1% fixed
Minimum hysteresis 120 mV secondary
Characteristic times
Start time < 55 ms/50 ms with high speed for voltage from
0.9 Pick-up value to 1.1 Pick-up value
Overshoot time < 40 ms for voltage from 0.9 Pick-up value to 1.1
Pick-up value
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 4
Ieq(t) 2 Δt Δt
H(t) = H(t - Δt) + ( ) τ - H(t - Δt) τ
k Ib P533BMB
where:
• H(t) is the thermal level computed at time t ("Thermal level").
• H(t - Δt) is the thermal level computed at time t - Δt.
• Ieq(t) is the equivalent heating phase current at time t computed from the
maximum of the 3 phase RMS currents.
• Ib is "Basic current setting" or "Feeder basic current".
• k is the "k" factor applied to the basic current to define the maximum
continuous current.
• is the heating time constant of the feeder ("Heating time constant" or "Time
constant "), where is assumed to be much greater than Δt.
"[Ieq(t) / (k x Ib)]2x Δt / " expresses the heat transfer due to the phase current Ieq(t)
and "H(t - Δt) x Δt / " expresses the natural cooling of the feeder conductors.
The thermal overload protection operates when the thermal level is greater than
100%. This thermal level of 100% can be reached with a permanent current above
the basic current value Ib multiplied by the k factor.
With a continuous load current "Ieq", the thermal level "H" is equal to:
Ieq
H (Ieq) = ( )
2
k Ib P533BNB
The table below indicates the thermal level with different values of continuous load
current:
1 100% (operation)
0.9 81%
0.8 64%
0.7 49%
0.6 36%
0.5 25%
0.4 16%
0.3 9%
Generally, the basic current Ib is set to the “Basic current” of the feeder, and k
factor could be set to take into account the accuracy of the global current
measuring chain (phase CTs and the protection relay). The k factor is set to 1.0 by
default.
A thermal alarm ("49F alarm" output) is provided which operates when the thermal
level is greater than or equal to the "Thermal alarm value" setting (expressed in %)
and is usually set to be lower than 100%, the operate level. This threshold,
expressed in %, is available only in the current based setting mode.
The thermal level in % is accessible as an output measurement.
When thermal overload is managed in the several setting groups, the thermal level
is kept after the setting group change (no thermal level reset), and the thermal
level is computed according to the new settings.
leq (t) 2 Δt Δt
H(t) = H(t - Δt) + Fa ( ) τ - H(t - Δt) τ
k x lb P533BQB
Where common values are identical to the thermal level H(t) calculation formula,
and the additional "Fa" ambient temperature factor is defined with the following
equation:
Fa = Tmax - Tnom
Tmax - Ta P533BRB
where:
Where H(t), Tmax and Ta are defined according to the previous equations.
The thermal overload protection operates when the computed temperature
"Tobject" is above or equals the maximum temperature Tmax.
A temperature alarm is provided ("49F T> alarm" output). This output operates
when the temperature level is greater than or equal to the alarm temperature
setting(expressed in ℃).
The ambient temperature (Ta) and object temperature (Tobject) are accessible as
output measurements in ℃ (Ta = "Ambient temperature" output and Tobject =
"Object temperature" output). The default value of the ambient temperature is
equal to the "Default ambient temperature" setting.
Additional features
The thermal level computation expressed in % is always available with the feeder
thermal level output. The current thermal level is saved in a non volatile memory
when the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is powered off. If the current thermal
level is above 90%, a value of 90% is memorised to help prevent possible
nuisance tripping on supply restoration.
A measurement output where the estimated time to trip is provided, based on the
hypothesis that the load current present remains constant until thermal overload
operation occurs.
A time remaining alarm ("49F rsv alarm" output) is provided. It operates when the
calculated remaining time is less than or equal to the "Reserve time thermal
alarm" setting.
There is a digital input (“Feeder thermal level reset” signal) to reset the thermal
level value, when the digital input is asserted, the value of thermal level is set to
Zero.
It is possible to block the protection function using the block matrix.
Typical values of heating time constant:
Air-core reactors 40
Capacitor banks 10
Overhead lines 10 ( Cu: cross section greater than or equal to 100 mm2 (0.15 in2);
or AI: 150 mm2 (0.23 in2) )
Busbars 60
t=τ Ln ( Fa H(Ieq) - H0 )
Fa H(Ieq) - 100% P533BOB
where:
• is the heating time constant for the protected equipment.
• Ln( ) is natural logarithm function.
• Fa is the ongoing temperature compensation. In current based setting mode,
Fa = 1.
• H(Ieq) is the thermal level calculated with the continuous load current (Ieq) and
the basic current setting (Ib).
• H0 is the current thermal state corresponding to the last calculation.
In the same way, for a continuous current higher than the current threshold (k x Ib),
the time for the alarm to operate is:
t=τ Ln ( Fa H(Ieq) - H0 )
Fa H(Ieq) - Halarm P533BTB
where:
Halarm is "Alarm" (alarm temperature setting, in %). In temperature based setting
mode, the alarm temperature setting is expressed in ℃. The corresponding
thermal level in % (Halarm) is defined by the following equation:
Block diagram
Figure 222 - Block diagram of the thermal overload protection function (ANSI 49F)
Block Blocked
& &
≥1
Register event
> 100%
Trip
IA RMS
Max A
IB RMS
IC RMS % >
B
℃ >
& & Register event
RsvAlarm
RTD #8 <
Characteristics
Table 68 - Settings and characteristics of the thermal overload protection
stage 49F
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
CT input selection64
Resolution 0.01
Resolution 1%
Resolution 1 ℃ (1.8 ℉)
Resolution 1 ℃ (1.8 ℉)
Alarm temperature/T°alm
Resolution 1 ℃ (1.8 ℉)
Resolution 1 ℃ (1.8 ℉)
Resolution 1 ℃ (1.8 ℉)
63. Inom
64. Available for P5T30 only.
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.1%
Characteristics
Tripping time accuracy ±5% or ±500 ms (with the applicable factor
according to IEC 60255-149)
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 4
Motor status
Description
There are three possible status for a motor: stopped, starting or running.
The PowerLogic P5 detects motor start by CB position, motor current, or both CB
position and motor current using “Motor start detection mode”.
• CB Position: The CB position changes from open to closed.
• Current: Three phase currents have been less than 5% Inom(phase CT
primary nominal). Then any of the three phase currents increases and
exceeds the motor start detection current.
• CB Position and Current: Any of the three phase currents exceeds the motor
start detection current in 90 ms after CB position changes from open to close.
2 4
1 1
C B
3
P533BWB
A Stopped B Running
C Starting
2. If the motor start is not detected successfully and the criteria for motor in
“Stopped” state are not satisfied, the relay will consider the motor is in
“Running” state.
For example: if the motor start detection mode is “CB & Current” and all three
phase currents do not exceed the motor start detection current within 90 ms
after CB is closed, the motor start is not detected. Motor state changes from
“Stopped” state to “Running” after the 90 ms timing window. ④
Typical diagrams for the detection of successful direct-on-line start and soft start
are shown in the following diagrams, with the use of the “CB & Current” mode.
90 ms
E
100 ms
D
C P533BXB
E Motor running
90 ms
D
C P533BYB
General settings
Settings Value
(description/label)
65. Inom
1 2
T P533BZB
Characteristics Values
Pass-band (in Hz) > 2 Ωn x R/60
Ωn is rated motor rotation speed.
The proximity detector output pulses are at a voltage level which is compatible
with the logic inputs (24...240 V DC), which means that a logic input must be
mapped to a given proximity detector to perform the speed measurement. The
12I4O module contains a specific digital input (DI1) to detect the motor speed. It
can recognise the high voltage signal as status 1 with > 200 us pulse width and
the low voltage signal as status 0 with > 120 us pulse width.
PowerLogic P5 protection relay can only use one speed detection input. If several
12I4O modules (such as Slot C, Slot D, Slot E) are fitted in the PowerLogic P5
protection relay, the user can select the dedicated digital input from any of the
12I4O modules for motor speed detection. If there is no 12I4O module fitted in the
relay, the motor speed detection and motor overspeed / underspeed protection will
be invisible.
NOTICE
IMPROPER EQUIPMENT OPERATION
If the counting input DI1 on 12I4O is selected for motor speed detection, this
input cannot be used by any other protection functions.
Failure to follow this instruction can result in equipment damage.
When the motor speed detection function is Enabled and one specific digital input
is selected as motor speed input, the settings, such as “Delay”, “On Event”, “OFF
Block diagram
Figure 227 - Block diagram of zero speed detection
New pulse
Tzero 0
Absence of pulses Zero Speed
&
Register event
Characteristics
Table 70 - Settings and characteristics of motor speed detection protection
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 1 rpm
Resolution 1
Zero speed confirm time/Zero speed delay
Resolution 1s
Accuracy ±2% or ±150 ms
Resolution 1 rpm
Accuracy ±1 rpm
Refresh interval 1s
Measurement time 100 ms
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 1
(
2
InomMotSt (
T= Tstart
I P533C1B Equation 7.7
Where:
T = Dependent operate time
InomMotSt = Nominal motor start current
I = Maximum of IA, IB, IC
Tstart = Motor start time
Figure 228 - Example of an dependent operation time of the motor start time
supervision protection function
T(s)
250
200
150
100
50
A
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 I(x Inom)
B P533C2B
NOTE:
The pick-up current setting Istart> is the start detection level of the start current.
While the motor status is starting and the current exceeds the pick-up setting
Istart>, the motor start-up supervision stage starts to count the operate time.
When current drops below the setting Istart>, the motor start-up supervision
stage releases. Motor start-up supervision is active only during the starting of
the motor.
Block diagram
Figure 229 - Block diagram of the motor start time supervision function
(ANSI 48)
IA MAX
IB >
& & Start
IC &
Register event
≥1
Motor status = starting Trip
Block &
Register event
A
IMotStart> DT setting Delay Type Enable event
Characteristics
Table 71 - Settings and characteristics of the motor start time supervision
protection stage Ist>
Settings/characteristics Value
(description/label)
Resolution 0.1 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms (DT)
Characteristic times
Start time < 70 ms/65 ms with high speed
Setting groups/SetGrp
Number 1
NOTE: For motor start detection current and nominal start current settings,
see Motor status, page 324.
leq (t) 2 Δt Δt
H(t) = H(t - Δt) + ( ) τ1 - H(t - Δt) τ1
k lb P533C4B
where:
• H(t) is the thermal level computed at time t.
• H(t - Δt) is the thermal level computed at time t - Δt.
•
where:
◦ IA, IB, IC are the RMS phase currents.
◦ q is a user setting to define the unbalance factor ("Unbalance factor" or
"Factor q").
For an asynchronous motor, q is determined as follows:
TLR / ILR2
q=2 -1
Sn P533C6B
leq (t) 2 Δt Δt
H(t) = H(t - Δt) + ( ) τ2 - H(t - Δt) τ2
k lb P533C7B
Where 2 is the heating time constant during starting sequence or the phase
currents is greater than the motor start threshold ("Time constant for motor starting
" or "Time constant 2").
The digital output Motor TC2 active is asserted in this state.
Motor in stopped state
When the motor is stopped, the cooling effect is dominant since there is no
heating contribution, so a cooling time constant must be taken into account in the
stopped state. In that state, the thermal level H(t) is computed according to the
following equation:
Ieq
H (Ieq) = ( )
2
k Ib P533BNB
The table below indicates the thermal level with different values of continuous load
current:
1 100% (operation)
0.9 81%
0.8 64%
0.7 49%
0.6 36%
0.5 25%
0.4 16%
0.3 9%
Generally, the basic current Ib is set to the "Basic current” of the machine, and k
factor could be set to take into account the accuracy of the global current
measuring chain (phase CTs and the protection relay). The k factor is set to 1.0 by
default.
An thermal alarm ("49M alarm" output) is provided which operates when the
thermal level is greater than or equal to the "Thermal alarm value" setting
(expressed in %) and is usually set to be lower than 100%, the operate level. This
signal can be used to lock the CB reclosing until thermal state is back under the
alarm level.
The thermal level in % is accessible as an output measurement.
When thermal overload is managed in the several setting groups, the thermal level
is kept after the setting group change (no thermal level reset), and the thermal
level is computed according to the new settings.
leq (t) 2 Δt Δt
H(t) = H(t - Δt) + Fa ( ) τ - H(t - Δt) τ
k x lb P533BQB
Where common values are identical to the thermal level H(t) calculation formula,
and the additional "Fa" ambient temperature factor is defined with the following
equation:
Fa = Tmax - Tnom
Tmax - Ta P533BRB
where:
• Tmax is the maximum temperature of the equipment ("Max object temperature"
setting).
• Tnom is the limit of the ambient temperature designed for the protected
equipment to operate at rated loads without causing thermal degradation of
insulation ("Nominal ambient temperature" setting, typically equal to 40 ℃).
• Ta is the real time ambient temperature of the protected equipment measured
with the RTD number 8.
The ambient temperature of the protected equipment is computed with the
following formula:
Where H(t), Tmax and Ta are defined according to the previous equations.
The thermal overload protection operates when the computed temperature
"Tobject" is above or equals the maximum temperature Tmax.
A temperature alarm is provided ("49M T> alarm" output). This output operates
when the temperature level is greater than or equal to the alarm temperature
setting(expressed in ℃).
The ambient temperature (Ta) and machine temperature (Tobject) are accessible as
output measurements in ℃ (Ta = "Ambient temperature" output and Tobject =
"Machine temperature" output).
Additional features
The thermal level computation expressed in % is always available with the motor
thermal level output. The current thermal level is saved in a non volatile memory
when the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is powered off. If the current thermal
level is above 90%, a value of 90% is memorised to help prevent possible
nuisance tripping on supply restoration.
A measurement output about the remaining time to trip ("Estimated time to trip") is
provided, based on the hypothesis that the load current present remains constant
until thermal overload operation occurs.
A time remaining alarm ("49M rsv alarm" output) is provided. It operates when the
calculated remaining time is less than or equal to the "Reserve time thermal
alarm" time setting.
A remote command can be used to reset the thermal level (e.g. after
commissioning tests). This reset can be also performed from the local panel.
It is possible to block the protection function using the block matrix.
After each motor start sequence, the function is able to compute the thermal level
consumed by the latest start. This measurement is accessible with the
measurement output "Motor start thermal level/Motor start H(t)". When the thermal
level calculation is above (100% - Motor start H(t)), the output signal "Block motor
start" is asserted to inhibit CB Closing from taking place. The output time
measurement output "Time left for motor start" provides the remaining time until
the motor can be started.
There is a digital input (“MThLevRst” signal) to reset the thermal level value, when
the digital input is asserted, the value of Thermal level H(t) shall be set to Zero.
t=τ Ln ( Fa H(Ieq) - H0 )
Fa H(Ieq) - 100% P533BOB
where:
• is the heating time constant for the protected equipment.
◦ When the motor is in starting state, the time constant for motor starting is
used;
◦ When the motor is in running state, the heating time constant is used;
• Ln( ) is natural logarithm function.
• Fa is the ongoing temperature compensation. In current based setting mode,
Fa = 1.
• H(Ieq) is the thermal level calculated with the continuous load current and the
basic current setting.
• H0 is the current thermal state corresponding to the last calculation.
In the same way, for a continuous current higher than the current threshold (k x Ib),
the time for the alarm to operate is:
t=τ Ln ( Fa H(Ieq) - H0 )
Fa H(Ieq) - Halarm P533BTB
where:
Halarm is "Alarm", the alarm threshold setting in % of thermal level. In temperature
based setting mode, the threshold alarm threshold is expressed in ℃ with "Talm"
setting. The corresponding thermal level in % (Halarm) is defined by the following
equation:
k Ib start P533Q1B
where:
Fa = Tmax - Tnom
Tmax - Ta P533BRB
H(t)
t = τcooling Ln ( )
100% - Hstart P533Q2B
where:
• H(t) is the thermal level calculated at the moment.
• 3 is the cooling time constant when motor is stopped.
Block diagram
Figure 230 - Block diagram of thermal overload protection function (ANSI 49M)
Block Blocked
& &
≥1
Register event
> 100%
Trip
A
I2
%
add & &
B Register event
> 100% Blk Motor start
Max
IA RMS %
IB RMS C
IC RMS
>
℃
D >
& Register event
&
RTD #8 TmpAlm
<
T° mode Ib τ1 τ2 τ3
Characteristics
Table 72 - Settings and characteristics of the thermal overload protection
stage 49M
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01
66. Inom
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.1
Thermal alarm value/Alarm
Setting range 50%...100% of thermal level
Resolution 1%
Resolution 1 ℃ (1.8 ℉)
Resolution 1 ℃ (1.8 ℉)
Resolution 1 ℃ (1.8 ℉)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 1 ℃ (1.8 ℉)
Resolution 1 ℃ (1.8 ℉)
Characteristics
Tripping time accuracy ±5% or ±500 ms (with the applicable factor
according to IEC 60255-149)
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 4
NOTE: To test the thermal overload protection more easily and faster, it is
possible to set a thermal level init. value and a motor start thermal level init.
value from 0% to 90%. After test, it is possible to reset the values to 0%.
T = ( ImotNomSt
( 2
Tstart
I P533FNB Equation 7.8
Block diagram
Figure 231 - Block diagram of the locked rotor protection stage Ilr>
Characteristics
Table 73 - Settings and characteristics of the locked rotor protection stage
Ilr>
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Pick-up value/Ilr>
Resolution 0.1%67
Accuracy ±3%67
Resolution 0.1 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms (DT)
±5% or ±20 ms (INV)
Characteristic times
Start time < 60 ms/55 ms (with high speed) for currents at
2 x Ilr
< 70 ms/65 ms (with high speed) maximum
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 1
Motor start
ON
OFF
Time
Start Inhibition Reference period = 60 min
ON
OFF
tn = 8 min Time
P533F9B
ON
OFF
Time
Start Inhibition
Min time between motor starts
ON
OFF
Time
P533FAB
So, the motor restart inhibition function is active if any one of the following
conditions is satisfied:
• Blocking due to number of starts limitation
• Blocking due to minimum time between 2 starts
M
+
Output matrix
DO1 DOx
I> start
I> trip
N> alarm
N> motor start inhibit
P533FBA
Block diagram
Figure 235 - Block diagram of the motor restart inhibition function (ANSI 66)
C ≥1
Alarm
&
D Register event
Hot limit Interval T reference Max motor cold starts Enable events
A Min. time between motor starts B Count num. during reference period
Characteristics
Table 74 - Settings and characteristics of the motor restart inhibition
function (ANSI 66)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 1
Max motor/Cold starts
Setting range 1...20
Resolution 1
Min time between motor starts/Interval
Setting range 0.0...100.0 min
Setting groups/SetGrp
Number 1
Block diagram
Figure 236 - Block diagram of the motor overspeed stages Motor overspeed
Ω>1 12 and Ω>2 12
> &
Motor speed Start
&
Register event
Block Trip
&
Register event
Characteristics
Table 75 - Settings and characteristics of the motor overspeed protection
function (ANSI 12)
Pick-up value
Resolution 1% Ωn
Accuracy ±2%
Operate delay
Resolution 1s
Accuracy ±1% or ±25 ms
Characteristic times
Start time < 250 ms + 2 x (60000 ms/ (Ω x R))
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 1
0.05Ω n
Start
Operate
delay
Trip
P533FEC
Block diagram
Figure 238 - Block diagram of the motor underspeed stages Motor speed<1
and Motor speed<2
&
Motor speed A S
Q
R Start
&
< Register event
Trip
< 0.05 Ωn ≥1 &
Register event
Block
Characteristics
Table 76 - Settings and characteristics of the motor underspeed protection
function (ANSI 14)
Resolution 1% Ωn
Accuracy ±2%
Resolution 1s
Accuracy ±1% or ±25 ms
Characteristic times
Start time < 250 ms + 2 x (60000 ms / (Ω x R))
Setting group
Number 1
Block diagram
Figure 239 - Block diagram of Motor Anti-backspin (ABS)
&
Zero speed
≥1
&
Zero Speed DI
A &
AntiBkSpin Alarm
Motor Status Stopped
&
Register event
Time to restart
A ABSAllowRestart
Characteristics
Table 77 - Settings and characteristics of Motor Anti-backspin (ABS)
protection
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 1s
Accuracy ±1% or ±25 ms
Setting group
Number 1
Emergency restart
Description
It may be necessary to restart a hot motor when the system is in emergency. An
emergency restart can be enabled through digital input/HMI/remote
communication, then it removes all motor start inhibit. For a successful emergency
restart, the emergency restart input should keep asserted during the whole motor
starting period.
An operation counter is provided to record the number of emergency restarts.
Emergency restart counter can be cleared via a command in HMI or remote
communication.
Characteristics
Table 78 - Settings and characteristics of Emergency restart protection
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Inrush blocking
Description
Second harmonic inrush blocking detects high transient current flows that usually
occur when transformers are energised at no-load or the voltage is restored to the
transformer after a brief voltage dip/interruption. It helps prevent tripping for this
normal operation condition.
There are two ways to enable inrush blocking of protection functions:
• Within individual phase and neutral OC protection stages, check the Inrush
blocking in any or all setting group(s).
• By using the Block Matrix, map the “inrush detection” signal to individual
protection functions. This configuration is valid for all setting groups.
During transformer inrush conditions, the second harmonic level may not be the
same for all phases. So PowerLogic P5 protection relay calculates the ratio
between the second harmonic component and the fundamental frequency
component for each phase. When the ratio of the second harmonic component of
any phase is higher than the ratio setting, after a fixed delay (20 ms), the inrush
detection signal will be activated and the inrush current will be discriminated.
There are two operating modes for inrush detection which is configured via the
"Inrush operating mode" setting. When it is in the "Phase block" mode, after inrush
current is detected, it will block the related overcurrent function only in that phase
(or phases); when it is in the "Cross block" mode, if any phase inrush current is
detected, it will block the related overcurrent function in all 3 phases.
To avoid maloperation, the inrush detection is only active if the phase current is
greater than a fixed minimum current of 10% Inom. Otherwise, the output of the
inrush detection is reset. As additional constraint, a maximum threshold current is
settable. Currents above this threshold will bypass any inrush blocking. This
threshold is set based on the transformer reactance. This reactance will limit any
inrush current, therefore currents greater than this are treated as short circuits.
Conversely, to secure proper operation during evolving faults or for faults fed from
sources with high amount of harmonics, any established overcurrent protection
starting will block the inrush blocking function.
A fixed reset delay (30 ms) of the "inrush detection" signal is implemented to avoid
signal chattering and potential maloperation because of too fast unblocking the
protection stages, especially at the end of the inrush condition.
The inrush blocking signal requires the presence of second harmonic current for 1
period (20 ms). Similarly the reset of this condition requires the absence of second
harmonic component for 30 ms.
In transformer differential protection application P5T30 two stages of this inrush
blocking function are available with common functionality. Each stage evaluates
the currents from one end and determines inrush condition and its inrush blocking
signals accordingly for its end. This allows selective use of these signals in the
block matrix, namely to have a common link to one end from which currents are
measured in the OC stage and in the inrush blocking function.
Block diagram
<
& Register event
IB H2 > IB H2/ IB 20ms 30ms
& &
IB
> 0.1In Inrush detection
<
Characteristics
Table 79 - Settings and characteristics of the inrush blocking function
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Pick-up value/Pick-up H2
Resolution 1%
Accuracy ±1%
Hysteresis 1%
CT input selection69
Setting range CT-1 is fixed for stage 1, CT-2 is fixed for stage
2.
Max inrush current/CurBlkVal
Setting range 1.00...20.00 pu70
Characteristic times
Start time < 40 ms
Setting group
Number 1
Operation
Switch-on-to-fault function operates within the SOTF active operation time, page
356 and Switch-on-to-fault function does not operate after the SOTF active
operation time elapses, page 357 illustrate the operation of the SOTF function:
1. Switch-onto-fault gets not activated if the CB has not been in open position
before the fault. Open CB detection is noticed from the highest phase current
value which has to be under a fixed low threshold (0.02 x In). Opening of the
CB can be detected also with digital inputs (Dead line detection input = DI1 –
DIx, Fx, VI1 – VIx). In this case, digital input which is connected to 52a need
to be configured to this "Dead line detection input". The default detection
method is based on the current threshold, so the dead line detection input
parameter has value “–“.
2. Dead line detection delay defines how long the CB has to be open so that the
SOTF function gets active. If the set detection delay time is not elapsed when
the highest phase current value (maximum of IA, IB, IC) rises over the start
setting, the SOTF does not operate.
3. If the highest phase current value of IA, IB, IC goes successfully under the
low limit and rises to a value between the low limit and the start value, then if
the highest phase current value rises over the start setting value before the
SOTF active operation time expires, the SOTF trips. If this SOTF active
operation time is exceeded, the SOTF does not trip even if the start setting
value is exceeded.
Start setting
Active timer
SOTF trip
P533FIB
Figure 242 - Switch-on-to-fault function does not operate after the SOTF
active operation time elapses
1
Start setting
Active timer
SOTF trip
P533FJB
Block diagram
Figure 243 - Block diagram of the Switch On To Fault protection function
(ANSI 50HS)
&
IA Max
IB 0.02 In< ≥1
Operate
IC
Characteristics
Table 80 - Settings and characteristics of the switch-on-to-fault protection
function (ANSI 50HS)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Pick-up value/SOTF
Accuracy ±3%
Resolution 0.01 s
SOTF active after CB closure/Act time
Setting range 0.10...60.00 s
Resolution 0.01 s
Dead line detection input
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Characteristic times
Start time < 30 ms/25 ms (with high speed) when I/Iset > 2
Setting group
Number 1
72. Vnom = VT primary nominal (PP) or Vnom/√3 = VT primary nominal (PN) depending on P5 voltage mode
is going above the minimum voltage threshold (0.015 pu73), or during a maximum
time period of 5 s. If the input voltage loss continues longer than 5 s the directional
overcurrent is blocked.
VTS blocking
Voltage Transformer Supervision (VTS) blocking only affects the directional
overcurrent protection. When the “Direction mode” is selected as “Forward” or
“Reverse”, the setting "VTS blocking" will show up. When "VTS blocking" is set to
"Non-directional", the directional element will be ignored, and the directional
overcurrent protection will be switched to non-directional protection under VT
failure condition. When "VTS blocking " is set to "Blocked", the directional
overcurrent protection will be blocked under VT failure condition.
Inrush blocking
The user can block the overcurrent function by selecting the setting "Inrush
blocking" of each stage. The purpose is to make the overcurrent function
inoperative during the transformer energisation, otherwise a large primary current
flow for a transient period will cause an unwanted trip.
It is highly possible that inrush blocking is determined later than the trip of
instantaneous OC stage. Therefore, when the "Inrush blocking" setting is enabled
in overcurrent stage, an additional delay (25 ms fixed) gets applied to wait for
potential inrush blocking signal before start is ON.
To secure proper protection operation during evolving faults or for faults fed from
sources with high amount of harmonics, a confirmed starting from any overcurrent
protection stage will remove the inrush blocking from all overcurrent stages. This
needs to be considered in the setup of inrush blocking: all OC stages, with operate
threshold below the expected maximum inrush current have to be subjected to
inrush blocking. Alternatively, use of the blocking matrix could be considered.
73. Vnom = VT primary nominal (PP) or Vnom/√3 = VT primary nominal (PN) depending on P5 voltage mode
For further details please also refer to the related application note.
T (s)
A
I (A)
Is GD
P533OYB
Figure 245 - Minimum operate time setting impacts on IDMT operating curve
T (s)
T (min)
I (A)
Is
P533OZB
Tripping logic
When the “Tripping logic” is set to "1 out of 3" and any phase starts, the output of
the "Trip Logic Check" is TRUE. That means tripping can be allowed at any
started phase. When the “Tripping logic” is set to "2 out of 3" and any two phases
start, the output of the "Trip Logic Check" is TRUE. That means tripping can be
allowed at the two started phases. The tripping logic is shown in following
diagram.
Examples
Three modes are available: Non-directional, Forward and Reverse. In the Non-
directional mode, the stage is acting just like an ordinary overcurrent protection
function stage.
An example of directional overcurrent characteristic with the phase A fault is
shown as below.
+cap.
2°
B A
RCA
+res.
P533PCA
+cap.
4°
B A 0° C
D +res.
RCA = °
RCA = 18 °
P533PDA
When the setting "Tripping logic" is set to "1 out of 3", any of the three phase
currents exceeds the setting value and, in directional mode (Forward or Reverse),
the direction is located in the trip area, this stage starts and issues a start signal. If
the fault situation is present longer than the operate time setting, a trip signal is
issued.
Block diagram
Tripping logic
Operate delay*
Reset delay TMS*
Operating curve DT adder
Reset curve Min Operate delay
P533P1B
A Tripping logic
NOTE:
• Block input can be signals configured via Block matrix, due to inrush
condition detected.
• Pick-up value can be value from "Pick-up value" setting, "Dynamic
threshold" setting depending on the configuration.
• Operate delay can be the value from "Operate delay" setting, "SOL
operate delay" setting or "Dynamic operate delay" setting depending on
the configuration.
• TMS value can be the value from "TMS" setting, "SOL TMS" setting or
"Dynamic TMS" setting depending on the configuration.
IA > &
PhA start
≥1 & Register event
PhA trip
A &
VBC* Register event
IB > &
PhB start
≥1 & Register event
PhB trip
A &
VCA* Register event
IC > &
PhC start
≥1 & Register event
PhC trip
A & Register event
VAB*
NOTE:
• Block input can be signals configured via Block matrix, due to inrush
condition detected.
• Pick-up value can be value from "Pick-up value" setting, "Dynamic
threshold" setting depending on the configuration.
• Operate delay can be the value from "Operate delay" setting, "SOL
operate delay" setting or "Dynamic operate delay" setting depending on
the configuration.
• TMS value can be the value from "TMS" setting, "SOL TMS" setting or
"Dynamic TMS" setting depending on the configuration.
• VAB/VBC/VCA can be the calculated phase to phase voltage, or memory
value for close-up three-phase fault.
Voltage-controlled overcurrent
Voltage-controlled overcurrent protection can be used as system back-up
protection or as transformer back-up protection. Normally voltage-controlled
overcurrent protection is preferred for the applications where a generator is
directly connected to a busbar without a step-up transformer. It is recommended
as well to use this solution to increase the sensitiveness of overcurrent back-up
transformer protection. P5 relays provide a dynamic setting mode for each
overcurrent protection stage, so that overcurrent pick-up setting and operate delay
setting will be replaced by dynamic threshold and dynamic operate delay settings.
So the overcurrent protection adjusts the current setting according to the detected
undervoltage condition. The information about application and setting examples
can be found in the Application Book.
Characteristics
Table 81 - Setting and characteristics of the non-directional/directional
phase overcurrent protection (6 stages have the same settings)
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Pick-up value/I>1
CT input selection75
Operating Curve
Options DT;
IEC: SI, VI, EI, LTI, UTI;
IEEE: MI, VI, EI
ANSI: NI, STI, LTI
Others: UK_Rectifier, FR_STI, RI, STI_CO2,
LTI_CO5, MI_CO7, NI_CO8, VI_CO9, EI_CO11,
BPN
Prg1-3
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±10 ms
TMS/TMS
Setting range 0.020...20.000
Resolution 0.001
DT adder/DT adder
Setting range 0.00...1.00 s
Resolution 0.01 s
74. Inom
75. Available for P5T30 only.
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01 s
Direction mode/Direction mode
Options Non-directional; Forward; Reverse
Resolution 1°
Accuracy ±2°
VTS blocking
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±30 ms
Options Off/On
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±10 ms
Resolution 0.001
Dynamic mode/Dynamic mode
Options Off/On
Resolution 0.01 s
76. Inom
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.001
Voltage memory time
Value 5 s fixed
Angle memory
Value 5 s fixed
Minimum voltage for the direction determination
Characteristic times
Start time < 30 ms/25 ms (with high speed) for currents at
2 x Is pick-up value (non-directional)
Number 4
77. Inom
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION, OR ARC FLASH
Information on this product is offered as a tool for conducting arc flash hazard
analysis. It is intended for use only by qualified persons who are knowledgeable
about power system studies, power distribution equipment, and equipment
installation practices. It is not intended as a substitute for the engineering
judgement and adequate review necessary for such activities.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Description
The arc-flash protection function (ANSI code 50ARC) is a high speed protection
function able to detect arcing events in a few millisecond, to minimise equipment
damages.
The arc-flash protection contains 8 arc stages that can be used to trip the circuit
breakers. Arc stages are activated with overcurrent and light signals (or light
signals only). The allocation of light or "light + current confirmation" signal to arc
stages is defined in arc-flash protection matrix: current, light and output matrix.
The matrix are programmed via the dedicated arc-flash matrix menus. Available
matrix signals depend on the order code (see Order information, page 579).
Available signal inputs for arc-flash protection depend on the PowerLogic P5
protection relay's configuration with 3 or 6 light inputs.
In transformer differential protection application P5T30 the current inputs of the
arc-flash protection can be assigned to one of the 2 ends.
With 3 to 6 arc-flash input options, the PowerLogic P5x30 protection relay allows
to build a multi-zone arc-flash protection system.
Information like arc detection or current detection can be exchanged across the
system using two communication ways:
• GOOSE messages using the IEC 61850 protocol (preferred solution)
• Virtual outputs
ZONE 1
=Arc sensor
Device 3
ZONE 2
ZONE 3
T T
Device 1 Device 2
P533E0A
In this application example, the arc-flash sensor for zone 4.1 is connected to
Device 1. If the arc-flash sensor detects the fault and simultaneously Device 3
sends a current signal, the zone 4.1 is isolated by the outgoing feeder breaker.
The arc-flash sensor for zone 4.2 is connected to the Device 2 and operates the
same way.
The arc-flash sensors for zone 3 are connected to Device 1, 2 or 3. If a sensor
detects the fault in zone 3, the light-only signal is transferred to Device 3 which
also detects overcurrent and then trips the main circuit breaker.
An eventual arc-flash fault in zone 1 or 2 does not necessarily activate the current
element in Device 2. However, arc detection can be achieved by using the light-
only principle. If an arc-flash occurs in cable termination, zone 1 or zone 2, the
fault is cleared by the upstream circuit breaker.
Each arc-flash protection stage provides:
• One arc detection function, which can be connected either to one of the
available arc sensors (for local detection) or to a digital input or GOOSE
information (for remote detection).
• One current detection function, which can be connected either to phase or
earth/ground fault high-speed overcurrent (for local detection) or to a digital
input or GOOSE information (for remote detection).
• One trip input to other relays
The trip signal of arc-flash protection is not a part of the global trip. In this
case it is convenient to use Goose which provides a fast signal to the other
relay.
Earth/ground fault current can be only measured and detected, according to the
PowerLogic P5 protection relay, from:
• 1/5A neutral CT input
• CSH/CSH30 neutral current input
Each stage of the arc-flash protection can be blocked individually by a control
inputs such as digital input, virtual inputs and function keys.
Block diagram
Figure 251 - Block diagram of the arc-flash protection function
> ≥1
IA/IB/IC
& A
IN >
pulse Trip
Light &
&
Block B Register event
IN>1 int I> int Mode t> Hold time Enable events
P533E1C
Operation
Before configuring the arc flash protection, the arc sensors need to be installed
through eSetup Easergy Pro.
The installation process is as follows:
1. In eSetup Easergy Pro, select PROTECTION menu/ARC protection sub-
menu.
2. Under Settings view, click the “Install arc sensors” drop-down list and select
Install.
3. Wait until the Installation state shows Ready.
The installation of the sensors is now done.
The installed sensors and the sensor status can be viewed at the bottom of the
ARC protection view.
This is an online process only. The installation process is only applicable when
eSetup Easergy Pro is connected to an PowerLogic P5 protection relay. The
offline configuration does not have this menu visible.
The arc-flash protection is implemented by configuration in the following three
matrix (see Matrix menu in eSetup Easergy Pro):
• Arc matrix - current
• Arc matrix - light
• Arc matrix - output
The event configuration for the protection is done in the Event enabling - ARC
view of the Log menu in eSetup Easergy Pro.
NOTE: When an arc-flash sensor is disconnected, an alarm message is
automatically generated and displayed on the local panel.
Digital output On, Off DO1 to DO3 (slot B) or DO1 to DO4 (slots C, D, E)
according to the PowerLogic P5 configuration
Characteristics
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
Do not use the arc operation delay for primary trip.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
The arc operation delay is intended, with the separate arc stage, for the circuit
breaker failure scheme only.
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Stage Mode/Mode
Resolution 0.01pu78
Accuracy ±2.5%
CT input selection79
Resolution 0.01pu78
Accuracy ±2.5%
DI to block stage
Options Selection of one digital input (DI), one virtual input (VI), or one
function key (Fx).
Operate delay/Delay
Accuracy ±1% or 20 ms
Resolution 1 ms
Accuracy ±1% or 20 ms
Characteristic time
Tripping time 80
78. Inom
79. Available for P5T30 only.
80. With high speed high break contact relay (PowerLogic P5x30) only.
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Current based protection [IA<] & [IB<] & [IC<] & ( [IN<] or [IN.sens<] ) according to
(linked to CBF_ITrp in Output matrix) PowerLogic P5 model
Matrix use
To activate the circuit breaker failure function with current protection trip or with
non-current protection trip, it is required to connect the relevant signals in Output
matrix. These are the CBF_ITrp signal or CBF_nITrp signal respectively.
The digital inputs used for the external trip signal as well as for external reset
signal are directly set in the breaker failure function.
Block diagram
Figure 256 - Block diagram of the circuit breaker failure protection function
CBF 2 Trip
IN.sens trip S
IN.sens < ≥1 & ≥1
R
CBF 1 Trip
VA, VB, VC A
CB open position
Non-current protection trip (CBF_nITrp) S &
≥1 Register event
& ≥1 t 0
&
R
&
&
&
Characteristics
Table 87 - Settings and characteristics of the breaker failure protection
function (ANSI 50BF)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01 pu
CT input selection81
Setting range CT-1 is fixed for stage 1, CT-2 is fixed for stage 2.
Resolution 0.001
IN.sens< current set/IN.sens<
Setting range 0.002...0.800 pu82 for sensitive earth/ground fault
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Options Selection of one digital input DI, one virtual input VI, or one
function key
Options Selection of one digital input DI, one virtual input VI, or one
function key
Characteristic times
Reset time83 < 30 ms for any trip initiate, reset by I<;
< 30 ms for any trip initiate, reset by IN<;
< 50 ms for non-current protection initiate, reset by Pole Dead84
Setting group
Number 1
PowerLogic P5
A9
IA
A10
A11
IB
A12
A13
IC
A14
A15
IN.meas
A16
A17
IN.sens
A18
P533E4B
Normally, stage 1 is applied as the trip stage and stage 2 is applied as the alarm
stage. As well as current input IN , the phase current IA is used to polarise the
capacitor bank unbalance current for the standing unbalance current
compensation and the faulty phase location.
Compensation method
The unbalance current under normal conditions can be compensated to get better
protection sensitivity. There are two compensation modes, Normal mode and
Location mode. Stage 1 can only select Normal mode. Stage 2 can select Normal
mode or Location mode.
Normal mode
The compensation is performed manually during commissioning. Using eSetup
Easergy Pro (PROTECTION menu/Capacitor unbalance Icap>1 sub-menu/Icap>1
unbalance view) or relay HMI, the relay can get the standing unbalance current
vector (here, IA is the angle reference) and record the magnitude and angle. For
flexible compensation purpose, the magnitude of the standing unbalance current
to be compensated is user settable under Normal Mode (setting SetBal), while the
angle of the standing unbalance current is not settable, fixed as the recorded
angle during commissioning.
B
IA > &
IN A Start
D &
IN.CSH C Register event
Trip
>
&
Register event
Block
Location mode
As in the Normal mode, the initial standing unbalance current vector (magnitude,
angle referred to IA) can be recorded during commissioning. The magnitude of the
standing unbalance current to be compensated is not user settable, but the
automatic compensation feature is provided. In Location Mode the branch of each
faulty element can be estimated and thus improve the fault finding and
maintainability of the capacitor bank.
Sensitive Setting
The stage Icap>2 Pick up value should be set based on the calculated unbalance
current change of one faulty element. The calculation can use the following
formula:
VP-N VP-N
-1 −
(2·π ·f·C1) (2·π ·f·C2)
-1
3IN = 3 P533E6B
Figure 259 - How a failure in different branches of the bank affects the IN
measurement
PowerLogic P5 H I
A B G C
F D
E
P533E7B
Automatic Compensation
The operation time setting for stage Icap>2 specifies how long the relay must wait
until it is certain that there is a faulty element in the bank. After this time has
elapsed, the corresponding counter will contain the number of faults. If none of the
six counters reach the setting Max Allowed Faults, the stage Icap>2 makes a new
compensation automatically and the compensated unbalance current for this
stage is now zero. The Icap>2 stage will reset and be sensitive to a new faulty
element. Note the counters are not reset by this action and will continue to
accumulate any further faulty elements. As shown in Automatic compensation
under location mode, page 383, the current vector A is the initial recorded
standing unbalance current and the current vector B is the unbalance current with
the faulty capacitor elements. The new compensation current is “vector B – vector
A”. If one of the six counters reach the setting Max Allowed Faults, stage Icap>2 will
operate and the compensation current vector is recovered to the initial recorded
standing unbalance current vector A.
Note, the automatic compensation does not affect the measured unbalance
current of stage Icap>1.
90
IN
A
180 0
B
270 P533E8B
B
> &
IA
IN A Start
C &
IN.CSH
Register event
>
D Trip
Block &
Register event
Characteristics
Table 88 - Settings and characteristics of the capacitor bank unbalance
protection stage (ANSI 51C)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
IN input/Input
Resolution 0.01 pu
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Compensation Mode
Resolution 0.001 pu
Characteristic times
Start time < 40 ms/35 ms with high speed
Setting group
Number 4
85. PU is the per unit value based on Inom = phase CT primary nominal (IN.calc) or IN.nom = standard neutral CT primary nominal (IN.
meas) or IN.CSH.nom = CSH CT primary nominal (IN.CSH) or IN.sens.nom = sensitive neutral CT primary nominal (IN.sens)
86. PU is the per unit value based on Inom = phase CT primary nominal (IN.calc) or IN.nom = standard neutral CT primary nominal (IN.
meas) or IN.CSH.nom = CSH CT primary nominal (IN.CSH) or IN.sens.nom = sensitive neutral CT primary nominal (IN.sens)
t(G) = T
G
( ) −1
GS P533OUB
where:
• t(G) is the theoretical operate time in seconds with constant value of G.
• T is the time delay setting (theoretical operate time for G = 2Gs).
• G is the measured value of the characteristic quantity.
• Gs is the setting value.
Reset delay
The reset delay of V> stage is configurable, it enables the detection of intermittent
faults. The time counter of the protection function does not reset immediately after
the fault is cleared, but resets after the release delay has elapsed. If the fault
appears again before the release delay time has elapsed, the delay counter
continues from the previous value. This means that the function eventually trips if
faults are occurring often enough.
There are three delay types for select: DT, IDMT, or Prg 1-3. For the detail of Prg
1-3, please refer to Programmable dependent time curves, page 264.
Operate mode
The setting "Tripping logic" shall be available to configure the operate mode.
When "Tripping logic" is "Any Phase", the signal "General Trip" is ON when any
phase operates. When "Tripping logic" is "Three Phases", the signal "General
Trip" is ON when all three phases operate.
Block diagram
Figure 262 - Block diagram of the Overvoltage protection function (ANSI 59)
Block &
≥1
A Trip
&
Register event
&
≥1
B Trip
&
Register event
&
≥1
C Trip
&
Register event
≥1
General Start
≥1
General Trip
A Select setting
For the block diagram of the Tripping Logic, refer to Block diagram of the Tripping
Logic, page 294.
Characteristics
Table 89 - Settings and characteristics of the Overvoltage protection (ANSI
59)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Enable V>
Options Off/On
Pick-up value/V>
87. Vnom = VT primary nominal (PP) or Vnom/√3 = VT primary nominal (PN) depending on measurement mode parameter setting
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Measurement mode/MeasMode
Options Phase-Phase; Phase-Ground
Delay type/Type
Tripping logic/Triplogic
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy DT: ±1% or ±10 ms
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy DT: ±5% or ±30 ms
Hysteresis
Resolution 1.0%
Accuracy ±2%
Characteristic times
Start time < 40 ms/35 ms with high speed
Number 4
VNsec.meas [V]
◦ as per unit value,
VNsec.meas [V]
VNsec.meas [p.u.] =
VNsec.nom [V]
◦ in primary kilovolts,
VNsec.meas [V]
VNprim.meas [kV] = VNprim.nom [kV]
VNsec.nom [V]
• When the voltage measurement mode is 3VP: The neutral displacement
voltage is calculated from the phase voltages and therefore no separate
neutral displacement voltage transformer is needed. The calculated neutral
voltage exists:
◦ in secondary volts,
VNsec.calc [V]
VNsec.calc [p.u.] =
VNsec.nom [V]
◦ in primary kilovolts,
VNsec.calc [V]
VNprim.calc [kV] = VNprim.nom [kV]
VNsec.nom [V]
• When the “Voltage measurement mode” is VPP/VPPy, the neutral voltage
displacement feature is not applicable, as the calculated neutral voltage is not
reliable.
Block diagram
The neutral overvoltage protection function (ANSI code 59N) is used as non-
selective backup for earth/ground faults also for selective earth/ground fault
protection for motors having a unit transformer between the motor and the busbar.
This function is sensitive to the fundamental frequency component of the neutral
voltage. Whenever the selected neutral voltage value, measured or calculated,
exceeds the pick-up setting of a particular stage, this stage starts and issues a
start signal. If the fault situation is present longer than the operate time delay
setting, a trip signal is issued.
VN > &
Start
Blocking
&
Register event
Trip
&
Register event
Characteristics
Visibility of VT setting sections and VN setting sections depends on the fitted VTs
(and the selected measurement mode). The setting range will be updated as
required in the table below.
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Pick-up value
Operate delay
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±10 ms
Reset time
Setting range 0.00...300.00 s
89. √3 x Vnom
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±30 ms
Characteristic times
Start time < 50 ms/45 ms with high speed
Setting groups
Number 4
Evaluation VN
Options Measured/Calculated
15
Uc = Xc
UcLN ∑ In
n =1
h
Xc = 1
2·π ·f ·Cset
P533EJB where P533EKA
Uc = Amplitude of a pure fundamental frequency sine wave voltage, whose peak value is
equal to the maximum possible peak value of the actual voltage (including harmonics)
over a Y-coupled capacitor.
n= Order number of harmonic. n = 1 for the fundamental frequency component. n = 2 for 2nd
harmonic etc.
Ih = nth harmonic of the measured phase current. h = 1 - 15.
The above equation gives the maximum possible voltage, while the actual voltage
depends on the phase angles of the involved harmonics. The protection is
sensitive to the highest voltage of the three phase to neutral voltages. Whenever
this value exceeds the start setting of a particular stage, this stage starts and
issues a start signal. If the fault situation is present longer than the definite
operation delay setting, a trip signal is issued.
P533ELA
A
NOM
B
f
C
A B C
set
Mvar P533EMA
A
NOM
B
f
C
A B C
NOM
set AB
AB
P533ENA
P533ELA
Xc = 1
2·π ·f ·Cset P533EKA
The pure fundamental voltage Uc having a peak value equal to the highest
possible voltage with similar harmonic content as the measured reactive capacitor
currents is: Ucp1 = 31.806 x (181 / 1 + 3.62 / 2 + 12.67 / 3 + 9.05 / 5) = 6006 V
and in per-unit values: Ucp1 = 6006/8000 = 0.75
15
Uc = Xc
UcLN ∑ In
n =1
h
P533EJB
The same calculation is executed for phases B and C. The highest of the three
values is compared to the start setting.
Block diagram
Figure 266 - Block diagram of the capacitor overvoltage protection function
(ANSI 59C)
IA Uc Max
IB Uc > &
Start
IC Uc &
Register event
f Trip
Blocking &
Register event
Characteristics
Table 91 - Settings and characteristics of the capacitor overvoltage
protection Vcap>1
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Pick-up value/Uc>
Resolution 0.01
Accuracy ±3%
Resolution 0.01 μF
Resolution 1V
Operate delay/t> (DT)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.5 s
Accuracy < 1.5 s
Characteristic times
Start time < 1.5 s
Disengaging time < 1.5 s
Setting group
Number 4
Polarisation
The neutral displacement voltage used for polarisation is either directly measured
by neutral voltage channel of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay or, alternatively,
internally calculated from the three phase voltages depending on the selected
voltage measurement mode.
• 3VP, 3VP/VPPy and 3VP/VPy:
The neutral voltage is calculated from the phase voltages and therefore no
separate neutral voltage transformers are needed. The setting values are
relative to the VT primary value.
• 3VP+VN, 2VPP+VN, and 2VPP+VN+VPPy:
The neutral voltage is measured with dedicated voltage transformer for
example using a broken delta connection. The setting values are relative to
the VN primary value.
• VPP/VPPy
In this voltage measurement mode, only earth/ground fault overcurrent is
available in the eSetup Easergy Pro.
between the Cold Load Pick-up, and also to realize voltage-controlled overcurrent.
For more information, refer to Dynamic setting element, page 360.
Inrush blocking
The user can block the overcurrent function by selecting the setting "Inrush
blocking" of each stage. The purpose is to make the earth overcurrent function
inoperative during the transformer energisation, otherwise a large primary current
flow for a transient period will cause an unwanted trip. For more information, refer
to Inrush blocking, page 360.
• Sector
This mode is used with networks earthed/grounded with a small resistance. In
this context, "small" means that a fault current may be more than the rated
phase currents. The trip area has a shape of a sector as drawn in Two
examples of operation characteristic of the directional earth/ground fault
stages in Sector mode, page 397. The angle offset is usually set to zero
degrees or slightly on the lagging inductive side (negative angle).
• NoDir
This mode makes the stage equal to the non-directional stage IN>. The
phase angle and VN amplitude setting are discarded. Only the amplitude of
the selected IN input matters.
+90°
INsinᵠ >
CAP
Pick-up value
IN
RES
ᵠ
0°
INcosᵠ >
-VN
Pick-up value
P533EWB
IN
B
70°
A 120° 32°
0° 0°
15° 120°
70° -VN -VN
A
IN B
P533EXC
The drawn IN phasor in both figures is inside the trip area. The angle offset and
half sector size are user’s parameters.
• FWD IC
Phase C increases above the set limit and two other phases remain inside the
set (delta) limit. IN current angle is +/- 60 degrees from phase C’s phase
angle.
• FWD IA - IB
Phase A and B increase above the set limit and phase C remains inside the
set (delta) limit. IN current angle is between phase A’s and phase B’s phase
angles.
• FWD IB - IC
Phase B and C increase above the set limit and phase A remains inside the
set (delta) limit. IN current angle is between phase B’s and phase C’s phase
angles.
• FWD IC - IA
Phase C and A increase above the set limit and phase B remains inside the
set (delta) limit. IN current angle is between phase C’s and phase A’s phase
angles.
• FWD IA - IB - IC
All three phase currents increase above the set delta limit.
• REV 1 (any one phase)
One phase decreases below the set delta limit and other two phases remain
inside the delta limit.
• REV 2 (any two phases)
Two phases decrease below the set delta limit and third phase remains inside
the delta limit.
• REV 3 (all three phases)
All three phase currents decrease below the set delta limit.
IC IC
IA
0° 0° 0° 0°
IN
IB IB
IA IN
P533EEB
IC IC IN
IB
IA
0° 0° 0° 0°
IA
IN
IB
P533EFB
IC
IC IN
IA
0° 0° 0° 0°
IA
IN
IB IB
P533EGB
Fault recording
When a faulty phase is recognised, it is recorded in the earth/ground fault current
protection fault log (also in the event list and alarm screen). This faulted phase
and direction recording function have a tick box in eSetup Easergy Pro for
enabling/disabling in the protection stage settings.
Block diagram
Figure 272 - Block diagram of the non-directional/directional earth/ground fault overcurrent protection
function operating in ResCap mode (ANSI 50N/51N/67N)
> Start
&
Register event
≥1
Block*
Trip
&
Register event
NOTE:
• The IN input can be IN.calc, IN.meas, IN.sens based on the
configuration.
• The VN can be directly measured from an open delta VT or calculated
from three phase VTs.
• Block input can be signals configured via Block Matrix, due to inrush
condition detected, or blocked under the VTS condition based on the
configuration and operating condition.
• IN pick-up value is either the setting IN pick-up value or the Dynamic
threshold depending on the configuration and operating condition.
• Operate delay is either the setting Operate delay, the SOL operate
delay or the Dynamic operate delay setting depending on the
configuration and operating condition.
• TMS value is either the setting TMS, the SOL TMS or the Dynamic TMS
setting depending on the configuration and operating condition.
• Res / Cap: when working as Res mode, the operate characteristic follows
the equation: IN* cos (Angle (IN) - Angle(-VN) - Angle offset) > IN pick-up
value. when working as Cap mode, the operate characteristic follows the
equation: IN* sin (Angle (IN) - Angle(-VN) - Angle offset) > IN pick-up
value.
Figure 273 - Block diagram of the non-directional/directional earth/ground fault overcurrent protection
function operating in Sector mode (ANSI 50N/51N/67N)
IN input* &
A
VN*
>
Start
> &
Register event
≥1
Block*
Trip
&
Register event
A Directional check
The operate characteristic should follow the equation: | Angle (IN) - Angle(-VN) - Angle offset | < Sector
NOTE:
• The IN input can be IN.calc, IN.meas, IN.sens based on the
configuration.
• Block input can be signals configured via Block Matrix, due to inrush
condition detected, or blocked under the VTS condition based on the
configuration and operating condition.
• IN pick-up value is either the setting IN pick-up value or the Dynamic
threshold depending on the configuration and operating condition.
• Operate delay is either the setting Operate delay, the SOL operate
delay or the Dynamic operate delay setting depending on the
configuration and operating condition.
• TMS value is either the setting TMS, the SOL TMS or the Dynamic TMS
setting depending on the configuration and operating condition.
Figure 274 - Block diagram of the non-directional/directional earth/ground fault overcurrent protection
function operating in Non-dir mode (ANSI 50N/51N/67N)
&
IN input* >
Start
&
Register event
≥1
Block*
Trip
&
Register event
Enable events
IN pick-up value* Reset curve
Operating curve Min Operate delay
Operate delay* DT adder
Reset delay TMS* P533P4B
NOTE:
• The IN input can be IN.calc, IN.meas, IN.sens based on the
configuration.
• Block input can be signals configured via Block Matrix, due to inrush
condition detected, or blocked under the VTS condition based on the
configuration and operating condition.
• IN pick-up value is either the setting IN pick-up value or the Dynamic
threshold depending on the configuration and operating condition.
• Operate delay is either the setting Operate delay, the SOL operate
delay or the Dynamic operate delay setting depending on the
configuration and operating condition.
• TMS value is either the setting TMS, the SOL TMS or the Dynamic TMS
setting depending on the configuration and operating condition.
Characteristics
Table 92 - Setting and characteristics of the non-directional/directional
earth/ground fault overcurrent protection function (ANSI 50N/51N/67N)
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
IN Pick-up value/IN>
91. Inom for IN.calc; IN.nom for IN.meas; IN.sens.nom for IN.sens.meas; IN.CSH.nom for IN.CSH
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
VN Pick-up value/
IN input/Input
VN input mode
Operating Curve
Options DT;
IEC: SI, VI, EI, LTI, UTI;
IEEE: MI, VI, EI
ANSI: NI, STI, LTI
Others: UK_Rectifier, FR_STI, RI, STI_CO2, LTI_CO5, MI_CO7,
NI_CO8, VI_CO9, EI_CO11, BPN
Prg1-3
Resolution 0.01
Accuracy ±1% or ±10 ms
TMS/TMS
Setting range 0.020...20.000
Resolution 0.001
DT adder/DT adder
Setting range 0.00...1.00 s
Resolution 0.01 s
Minimum operate delay/Min operate delay
92. Inom for IN.calc; IN.nom for IN.meas; IN.sens.nom for IN.sens.meas; IN.CSH.nom for IN.CSH
93. Available for P5T30 only.
94. √3 x Vnom
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01 s
Direction mode/Direction mode
Options ResCap, Sector, Non_Dir
Angle offset/Offset
Resolution 1°
Accuracy ±2°
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±30 ms
Resolution 0.1s
Accuracy ±1% or ±10 ms
Resolution 0.001
Dynamic mode/Dynamic mode
Options Off/On
95. Inom for IN.calc; IN.nom for IN.meas; IN.sens.nom for IN.sens.meas; IN.CSH.nom for IN.CSH
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±10 ms
Resolution 0.001
Accuracy ±5% or ±20 ms
Characteristic times
Start time < 30 ms/25 ms (with high speed) for currents at 2 x Is pick-up value
(non-directional)
Number 4
NOTE: The timer accuracy is only for the pure timer accuracy, not including
the start time.
96. Inom for IN.calc; IN.nom for IN.meas; IN.sens.nom for IN.sens.meas; IN.CSH.nom for IN.CSH
97. The 2nd value is only for high speed high break digital outputs.
A
B
B
C
N
C
PowerLogic P5
IA
IB
IC
IN (or IN.sens)
IN (or IN.sens)
P533PFB
The Restricted Earth Fault (REF) protection principle has several advantages. It is
very selective because the protection zone is limited between the current
transformers that are used for the Restricted Earth Fault (REF) protection.
Because of its selectivity, the Restricted Earth Fault (REF) protection requires no
additional time delay for protection coordination. Therefore, the Restricted Earth
Fault (REF) protection is especially suitable for the protection of transformers and
rotating machines against internal ground faults. Because of the differential
protection principle, it is also very sensitive which makes it suitable for detecting
faults located near the neutral point of transformers and rotating machines.
The low-impedance Restricted Earth Fault (REF) protection function is sensitive to
the fundamental frequency component of the measured currents.
With transformer differential protection P5T30 two REF elements are available
with a fix link to the measured currents of one end (REF-1 to end 1, REF-2 to end
2).
Wording
REF is also referred to as Balanced Earth Fault (BEF) Protection, where this
terminology is usually used when the protection is applied to a delta winding. Also
in some areas the use of "Ground" instead of "Earth" is preferred.
5CT Application
For protection of 4 wire systems (including the dashed connections in Basic
biased REF scheme, page 406) the "5CT application" feature in REF has to be
enabled. In all other REF applications this feature shall remain disabled.
This feature is not available with P5T30.
CT polarity
Low impedance Restricted Earth Fault (REF) protection function measures phase
and neutral currents, as sketched in Basic biased REF scheme, page 406. When
calculating differential and bias currents, the sign of the measured currents must
be considered. Accordingly, settings are provided to adjust actual wiring to the
function needs. These settings can be found in the GENERAL menu/Scaling sub-
menu.
• Phase CT polarity: Standard/Opposite
• IN CT polarity: Standard/Opposite
• IN.sens CT polarity: Standard/Opposite
Standard polarity is given with CT star point outside the zone of protection.
NOTE: Configuration of the polarity of both neutral current CTs is only
required in case of “5CT application”. In 4 CT applications, just polarity of
that neutral CT must be set which is selected as IG input.
Amplitude matching
Neutral CTs can have smaller current ratio than phase CTs, reflecting different
expected fault currents for phase and ground faults as a result from power system
grounding impedances. In order to calculate correct differential and bias currents,
such differences in CT ratio must be considered.
For this purpose, Restricted Earth Fault (REF) protection function automatically
scales all currents to a common reference, which is the phase CT primary current.
This scaling uses matching factors which are calculated from the ratio of the
neutral and phase CTs.
• Standard earth fault current amplitude matching factor:
IN CT scaling factor = Neutral CT ratio / Phase CT ratio
Measurements
Low impedance Restricted Earth Fault (REF) protection will be blocked. Protection
function calculates differential and bias currents. The continuously updated values
of these measurements are displayed on device HMI and are available for
communication both to local operating tool as well as to remote SCADA systems
for monitoring during normal operation or check during commissioning.
The differential current is always calculated as vectorial sum of all currents, for
example:
• In 4 CT application: Id = | IA + IB + IC + I'G |
• In 5 CT application: Id = | IA + IB + IC + I'G + I’N |
Where:
• IA, IB, IC are the phase currents.
• I'G is the amplitude matched current flowing through the star point to ground
(measured through standard or sensitive neutral CT acc. to selected IG input).
• I’N is the amplitude matched current from the neutral wire CT in "5CT
application" (measured through remaining neutral CT, not set as IG input).
The bias current calculation depends on selected operating mode.
Operating modes
There are two operating modes selectable:
• Sum(IP) bias = Biased by sum of phase currents
• Max(IP) bias = Biased by maximum phase current
The difference between both is the definition of the restraining current and their
tripping characteristic.
3.0
Idiff
2.5
trip
2.0
k = 1.005
(fix)
1.5
no trip
1.0
The characteristic has a fixed slope of 1.005, beginning at the "Low set Id1". The
characteristics equation is: Id = Id1 + 1.005 x Ib.
The dashed blue line indicates the values of apparent differential and bias
currents (Id, Ib) in case of transient saturation of a phase CT during an external
phase fault. As per definition above for calculating differential and bias currents,
this characteristic is always below the tripping characteristic, hence in stable
region.
The slope provides slight increase of stability margin (slight increase of required
differential current for tripping) with increasing sum of phase currents.
NOTE: Low impedance REF biased by sum of phase currents is only
applicable where the protected object (e.g. transformer winding) has a neutral
point earthing which is fitted with a CT, because it needs measured ground
current to operate. So this mode cannot be applied for balanced earth fault
protection or delta windings. Its main advantage is an inherent stability against
transient phase CT saturation.
3.0
Idiff
2.5
trip
2.0
k2
1.5
no trip
1.0
0.5 m
k11 Trip characteristic
transient phase CT saturation
Id1
0.0
0.0 0.5 Ib1 1.5 2.0 2.5 Ibias 3.0
Also this characteristic starts at "Low set Id1", has a first section with "slope k1" for
bias currents up to "Bias current Ib1" setting and then a second section with higher
"slope k2" for increased stability at high bias current levels.
The characteristics equations for the two ranges are:
• For Ib ≤ Ib1: Id = Id1 + k1 x Ib
• For Ib > Ib1: Id = Id1 + k1 x Ib + (k2 - k1) x (Ib – Ib1)
The dashed blue line in the figure indicates the values of apparent differential and
bias currents (Id, Ib) in case of transient saturation of a phase CT (or likewise a
single phase current infeed test).
In order to reduce the risk of false tripping caused from phase CT saturation only,
this operating mode is accomplished with a check for minimum ground current. A
trip is released only if the measured current exceeds the set threshold “Min
measured IG”.
NOTE:
• It is recommended that this threshold is set below Id1, otherwise it
introduces a further restriction in the tripping characteristic. If this
constraint is intentionally not required, it could be disabled by setting the
threshold to 0 pu.
• This mode has the advantage of being universally applicable to all kinds
of protected objects with or without neutral point earthing, i.e. including
balanced earth fault protection for unearthed star or delta windings.
Unless minimum star point current constraint is set up, this bias definition
also allows the user to apply tripping test simply by shorting a phase
current (for simulation of neutral current) without the need of current
injection equipment.
Block diagram
Figure 278 - Low impedance REF function structure overview
Idiff
IA/IB/IC
IN A &
IN.sens
Start
Ibias
&
Block Register event
Trip
&
Register event
A REF calculation
Characteristics
Table 93 - Settings and characteristics of the low impedance restricted earth
fault protection function (ANSI 64REF)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
IG input/IG input
Option IN.meas/IN.sens
5 CT application/5 CT application
Option Enable/Disable
Option Standard/Opposite
Option Standard/Opposite
Option Standard/Opposite
Slope k1/Slope k1
Resolution 1%
Slope k2/Slope k2
Resolution 1%
Option Enable/Disable
Resolution 0.01 s
CTS operating mode/CTS operating mode
Option Indication/Blocking/Restraining
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Characteristic times
Start time < 40 ms/35 ms (with high speed) for currents at 2 x pick-up value
Setting group
Number 4
100. Inom
101. Available for P5T30 only.
Figure 279 - Typical line to neutral voltages, earth/ground fault current of the
faulty feeder and the neutral displacement voltage during two transient
earth/ground faults in phase A (the network is compensated)
VA
VB
VC
IN
VN
t (ms)
P533EYC
Block diagram
Figure 280 - Block diagram of the directional transient intermittent earth/ground fault stage IN.int>
IN samples IN
IN
IN peak
>
0.1 x In
A
DIV
IN FFT >
1.5
VN samples
VN VN Start
&
Register event
&
B Trip
VN > &
Register event
Block
Enable events
VN> Intermittent time
Min number of Peaks Operate delay
P533EZA
Operation
Direction calculation
The function is sensitive to the instantaneous sampled values of the earth/ground
fault overcurrent and neutral voltage displacement voltage. The sample of the
neutral voltage can be from a direct VN measurement with a voltage transformer,
or can be calculated from the three phase voltages.
NOTE: Connect the VN signal according to the connection diagram to achieve
correct polarisation.
Auto reclosing
The start signal of any IN>1 stage initiating auto reclosing (AR) can be used to
block the IN.int> stage to avoid the IN.int> stage with a long intermittent setting to
interfere with the AR cycle.
Usually the IN.int> stage itself is not used to initiate any AR. For transient faults,
the AR does not help because the fault phenomena itself already includes a
repetitive unsuccessful self-extinguishing.
Figure 281 - Peak amount condition is satisfied and operate time elapses
within intermittent time setting. Stage issues a trip.
UN
IN
TRIP
Setting for minimum number of peaks = 2
Time (s)
P533F0B
Figure 282 - Peak amount condition is not satisfied when operation delay
elapses but last required peak occurs during intermittent time. Stage then
issues instant trip.
UN
IN
Time (s)
P533F2B
Figure 283 - Peak amount condition is satisfied but intermittent time elapses
before operate time. Stage is reset.
UN
IN
Time (s)
P533F1B
Characteristics
Table 94 - Settings and characteristics of the transient intermittent earth/
ground fault protection stage IN.int>
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
IN input
Direction mode/Mode
Options Forward; Reverse
IN peak value/INPeak
VN Pick-up/VN>
Resolution 1% pu103
Accuracy ±3%
Resolution 1
Operate delay/t>
Resolution 0.02 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
Resolution 0.01 s
Intermittent time/Intmt time104
Setting range 0.01...300.00 s
Resolution 0.01 s
Characteristic times
Start time < 50 ms/45 ms (with high speed) maximum
Setting group
Number 4
102. Inom for IN.calc; IN.nom for IN.meas; IN.sens.nom for IN.sens.meas; IN.CSH.nom for IN.CSH
103. √3 x VT primary nominal (PN)
104. Common setting for setting group 1, 2, 3, 4.
Block diagram
Figure 284 - Block diagram of the 5th harmonic detection stage Ih5>
IA H5 Max
IB H5 > &
IC H5
Start
&
Register event
Block
Trip
&
Register event
Enable events
Pick-up value
Operate delay
P533F3B
Characteristics
Table 95 - Setting and characteristics of the 5th harmonic detection stage
Ih5>
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 1%
Accuracy ±1% or ±0.005 Inom
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or 30 ms
Characteristic times
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Setting group
Number 1
Purpose
Typically protection functions detect the fault and trigger the AR function. After
tripping the circuit breaker, the AR function can reclose the CB. Normally, the first
reclose (or shot) is so short in time that users cannot notice anything. However,
the fault is cleared and the feeder will continue in normal service.
Auto-recloser principle
Even though the basic principle of AR is very simple, there are a lot of different
timers and parameters that have to be set.
The PowerLogic P5 protection relays provide auto-reclosing with up to five shots.
A shot consists of open time (so called “dead” time) and closed time (so called
“burning” time or discrimination time). A high-speed shot means that the dead time
is less than one second. The time-delayed shot means longer dead times up to
two to three minutes.
There are four AR lines. A line means an initialisation signal for AR. Normally, start
or trip signals of protection functions are used to initiate an AR sequence. Each
AR line has a priority. AR1 has the highest and AR4 has the lowest priority. This
means that if two lines are initiated at the same time, AR follows only the highest
priority line. A very typical configuration of the lines is that the instantaneous
overcurrent stage initiates the AR1 line, time-delayed overcurrent stage the AR2
line and earth/ground fault protection will use lines AR3 and AR4.
I>1t AR-request) CB CB
I>2s I>1s
DirectTrip 0...300 s Reclaim time
0...300 s
Shot 1 AR1 In use succeeded
0...300 s 0...300 s 0...300 s 0...300 s
AR2 In use Move back
to shot 1
Shot
3...5
P533F4B
The AR matrix above defines which signals (the start and trip signals from
protection stages or digital input) are forwarded to the AR function. In the AR
function, the AR signals can be configured to initiate the reclose sequence. Each
shot from 1 to 5 has its own enabled/disabled flag. If more than one AR signal
activates at the same time, AR1 has highest priority and AR5 the lowest. Each AR
signal has an independent start delay for the shot 1. If a higher priority AR signal
activates during the start delay, the start delay setting will be changed to that of
the highest priority AR signal.
After the start delay, the CB is opened if it is still closed (i.e. if no trip has been
issued from another protection function in the mean time). When the CB opens, a
dead time timer is started. Each shot from 1 to 5 has its own dead time setting.
When dead time elapses, the reclose command is sent to the breaker and the
reclaim time is started. If the reclaim time elapses with no further starting or
tripping, the AR sequence is successfully executed and the AR function moves to
ready state and waits for a new AR request in shot 1.
It is recommended to configure the protection stage start signal to initiate the AR
function. A trip signal from the protection stage can be used as a backup. If AR
does not issue the open command, the protection trip signal still operates the CB.
The delay setting of the protection stage should be longer than the AR start delay,
CB operation time and protection reset time.
Operation
Manual closing
When CB is closed manually with the local panel, by remote, or with digital inputs,
the reclaim state is activated. Within the reclaim time, all AR requests are rejected.
The protection stages take care of tripping when they are connected to a trip relay
in the output matrix.
Manual opening
Manual CB open command during AR sequence stops the sequence and leaves
the CB open.
AR shots blocking
Each AR shot can be blocked with a digital input, virtual input or virtual output. The
blocking input is selected with the Block setting. When the selected input is active,
the shot is blocked. A blocked shot is treated like it does not exist and AR
sequence skips it. If the last shot in use is blocked, any AR request during
reclaiming of the previous shot causes the final tripping.
Starting AR sequence
Each AR request line has its own start delay timer. That AR line that is selected
depends on which starting delay elapses first. If more than one delay elapses at
the same time, the AR request of the highest priority is selected. AR1 has the
highest priority and AR5 has the lowest priority. First shot is selected according to
the AR request. Next AR opens the CB and starts counting dead time.
DI to block AR setting
This setting is useful with an external synchro-check device. This setting only
affects re-closing the CB. Re-closing can be blocked with a digital input, virtual
input or virtual output. When the blocking input is active, CB is not closed until the
blocking input becomes inactive again. When blocking becomes inactive, the CB
is immediately closed providing the close command is still active.
Figure 286 - Example sequence of two shots (after shot 2 the fault is cleared)
I> setting
Current
Open command
CB
Close command
CB
CBclose
state
CBopen
state
P533F5A
1. The current exceeds the I> setting; the start delay from shot 1 starts.
2. After the start delay, an OpenCB relay output is operated.
3. The CB opens. The dead time from shot 1 starts, and the OpenCB relay
output resets.
4. The dead time from shot 1 elapses; a CloseCB output is operated.
5. The CB closes. The CloseCB output resets, and the discrimination time
from shot 1 starts. The current is again above the I> setting.
6. The discrimination time from the shot 1 elapses; the OpenCB relay output
is operated.
7. The CB opens. The dead time from shot 2 starts, and the OpenCB relay
output resets.
8. The dead time from shot 2 runs out; the CloseCB output is operated.
9. The CB closes. The CloseCB output resets, and the discrimination time
from shot 2 starts. The current is now below I> setting.
10. Reclaim time starts. After the reclaim time elapsed the AR sequence is
successfully executed. The AR function moves to wait for a new AR
request in shot 1.
Characteristics
Table 96 - Setting and characteristics of the auto-recloser protection
function (ANSI 79)
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01 s
Discrimination time/Discrimination time
Setting range 0.02...300.00 s
Resolution 0.01 s
Reclaim time/Reclaim time
Setting range 0.02...3,000.00 s
Resolution 0.01 s
DI to block sync check/DI to block sync check
Options Selection of one digital input (DI), one virtual input (VI), one virtual
output (VO), or one function key.
Frequency
70Hz
Gs
Gs-20mHz
Start
T
Trip
Block
Time
P533NUB
Block
Time P533NWA
Block diagram
Figure 289 - Block diagram of the overfrequency protection (ANSI 81O)
Block ≥1 Blocked
VA
<
VB A &
VC
Start
> &
f Register event
Trip
&
Register event
Enable events
f>
LV block t> P533F6B
Characteristics
Table 97 - Setting and characteristics of the overfrequency protection stages
f>1 and f>2
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Pick-up value/f>
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Accuracy ±0.01 Hz
Operate delay/t>
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±10 ms
Characteristic times
Start time < 110 ms/105 ms with high speed, typically 80 ms
Number 4
Frequency
Gs+20mHz
Gs
35Hz
Start
T
Trip
Block
Time
P533NTB
df/dt
Set point
95% set point
Block
Time
P533NVA
Block diagram
Figure 292 - Block diagram of the underfrequency protection function (ANSI
81U)
Block ≥1 Blocked
df/dt >
VA V1
VB < &
VC
Start
< &
f Register event
Trip
&
Register event
Enable events
f<
LV block t> P533F7B
Characteristics
Table 98 - Setting and characteristics of the underfrequency protection
stages f<1, f<2...f<8
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Pick-up value/f<
Resolution 0.01 Hz
Accuracy ±0.01 Hz
Setting/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±10 ms
df/dt blocking
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±5% or 50 mHz/s
Resolution 1%
Characteristic times
Start time < 110 ms/105 ms with high speed, typically 80 ms
Number 4
df/dt blocking
The protection is blocked when the measured rate of change of frequency df/dt is
bigger than the set df/dt blocking limit. To ensure the RoCoF is safely blocked, a
short time delay such as 50 ms is suggested.
Block diagram
Figure 293 - RoCoF function structure overview
f Out of range ≥1
Function block
Blocked
V1 <
Start
Trip
f
Operate delay/Reset
Direction mode
df/dt blocking Frequency threshold
Under voltage blocking Meas. time window (s)
Pick-up value
Operating mode
P533F8B
Characteristics
Table 99 - Setting and characteristics of the rate of change of frequency
protection stages
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Operating mode/OpMod
Resolution 1%
df/dt blocking/BlkVal_dfdt
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±10 ms
Frequency threshold
Accuracy ± 10 mHz
Characteristic times
Start time < 135 ms at 2 Gs109 for df/dt > 0.1 Hz/s for ΔT = 50 ms
< 170 ms at 2 Gs109 for df/dt = 0.1 Hz/s for ΔT = 50 ms
Disengaging time < 180 ms for 2 Gs109 to 0 and ΔT = 50 ms
Setting group
Number 4
Latch function
This feature can be programmed for outputs in the MATRIX menu/Output matrix
sub-menu of the eSetup Easergy Pro. Any protection stage start or trip, digital
input, logic output, alarm and GOOSE signal connected to the following outputs
can be latched when required:
• Output contacts DOs
• LEDs on the local panel
• Virtual outputs VO1- VO20
NOTE: The latched signal is identified with a dot and circle in the matrix signal
line crossing.
The lockout can be released through the local panel with the key, or through
the eSetup Easergy Pro. See Releasing latches, page 490.
B
P533SQB
object side) or in opposite way. This affects the sign of the measured current.
Accordingly, settings are provided to adjust actual wiring to the function needs.
• Phase CT-1 polarity (HV) = Standard/Opposite, by default: Standard
• Phase CT-2 polarity (LV) = Standard/Opposite, by default: Standard
For the CT orientation and polarity, please refer to CT and LPCT typical
application, page 66.
Phase swapping
Hydro pump storage applications use motor/generators, where reversing the
operating mode is done by swapping 2 phases either on HV or LV side. If such a
reversing switch is inside the protected zone, the protection scheme is able to get
aligned.
Accordingly, the settings of phase swapping are provided:
• CT-1 phase swap = “No Swap”/A-B/B-C/C-A, by default: “No Swap”
• CT-2 phase swap = “No Swap”/A-B/B-C/C-A, by default: “No Swap”
Activation of phase swapping is controlled through a dedicated digital input signal
(Phase swap activation input = DI1 – DIx, Fx, VI1 – VIx).
Amplitude matching
Protection is based on comparison of the primary phase currents. In a transformer
protection application, these will be naturally different with a ratio inverse to the
nominal voltages of the windings.
These currents are measured through CTs with a different transformation ratio,
more or less according to the nominal currents of the power transformer.
For example, a 110kV/22kV power transformer with 60 MVA rated power has a
nominal current on HV side of 315 A and on LV side of 1575 A. Accordingly CTs
on HV side could be 400:1 A and on LV side 2000:1 A.
PowerLogic P5 takes into account such different nominal currents and ratios in the
data processing and provides amplitude matching settings to adjust the function
accordingly: all currents are scaled to reference currents, calculated based on a
common reference power Sref and the nominal voltages of each end. For
protection of transformers, motors, shunt reactors etc., this reference power is
usually the rated or nominal power of the protected object.
The reference currents are calculated from the set reference power Sref,
• End-1 (HV) reference current: Iref-1 = Sref / √3 · Vrated,end-1
• End-2 (LV) reference current: Iref-2 = Sref / √3 · Vrated,end-2
With these reference currents and the primary nominal currents of the CTs the
amplitude matching factors are calculated:
• CT-1 amplitude matching factor: kamp,1 = ICT-1,primary / Iref-1
• CT-2 amplitude matching factor: kamp,2 = ICT-2,primary / Iref-2
These matching factors are displayed at the P5.
If the value of a factor is outside the range from 0.1 to 32.0, the differential
protection function is blocked.
The measured phase currents from each end are scaled with these factors per
following equations:
• HV end phase currents: Iamp,p,2 = kamp,1 · Ip,CT-1
• LV end phase currents: Iamp,p,2 = kamp,2 · Ip,CT-2
where:
• amp = amplitude-matched
• p = phase A, B or C
A B
C C
B B
A A
-Iamp,A,b
Iamp,C,b - Iamp,A,b
Iamp,A,a 1 / 3 (Iamp,C,b - Iamp,A,b) Iamp,C,b
Iamp,B,b 5 x 30
Iamp,C,a Iamp,B,a
Iamp,A,b
P533SRA
A Winding a B Winding b
C C
B B
A A
IF.HV IF.LV
A
P533SSA
A DIFF
Setting Zero-sequence current filtering CT-1 = Yes Zero-sequence current filtering CT-2 = No
ms1 (A) Ims1,zero,HV = IA,HV - Izero,HV = 2/3 · IF,HV Ims1,zero,LV = IC,LV - IA,LV + Izero,LV = 2 · IF,LV
ms2 (B) Ims2,zero,HV = IB,HV - Izero,HV = - 1/3 · IF,HV Ims2,zero,LV = IB,LV - IC,LV + Izero,LV = - 1 · IF,LV
ms3 (C) Ims3,zero,HV = IC,HV - Izero,HV = - 1/3 · IF,HV Ims3,zero,LV = IA,LV - IB,LV + Izero,LV = - 1 · IF,LV
The following table lists all the mathematical phasor operations. It shows that for
all odd-numbered vector group characteristics the zero-sequence current on the
low-voltage side is basically always filtered out, whereas for even-numbered
vector group characteristics the zero-sequence current on the low-voltage side is
basically never filtered out automatically. The latter is also true for the high-voltage
side since in that case no mathematical phasor operations are performed. Vector
group matching and zero-sequence current filtering must therefore always be
viewed in combination.
Differential protection
Differential protection calculations
The differential protection is based on calculation of differential and restraint (or
bias) current, both calculated from amplitude matched, vector group compensated
and zero-sequence current filtered currents as detailed in Numerical processing
depending on vector group and zero-sequence current filtering, page 439.
The differential current is sum of HV and LV side current values (per phase), it is
calculated with:
Id = | Ivec,end1 + Ivec,end2 |
The bias current is the difference of HV and LV side current values (per phase),
scaled to be comparable with the load current in normal operation.
Differential characteristic
With high current flowing through the protected object, for example during external
fault conditions, a differential current might be apparent. The reason can be due to
different ratio errors and/or magnetizing/saturation characteristics of the CTs.
Therefore, the current differential protection gets provided with a biased tripping
characteristic, as shown in following figure:
Id
Id.HS
D
A
C
Id.LS
B
IR.s2 IR
P533STA
Whatever method is used, the calculated value pair of differential and restraining
current (Id and IR) is compared against this characteristic with three sections
(green characteristic in above figure). The first section is a horizontal line at set
pick-up threshold Id.LS up to the intersection with the line for single side infeed, with
value considering basic inaccuracies (transformer magnetizing current, …). The
first slope (slope 1) ensures sensitivity to internal faults, while providing increasing
restraint to for example compensate effect of false amplitude matching due to non-
compensated tap changer. The second slope provides stability against measuring
errors like CT saturation.
The high set unrestrained differential current level Id.HS defines the characteristic
boundary. Differential currents which are higher than this value indicate internal
faults (external faults are limited for example by transformer reactance) and
require the fastest fault clearance. Therefore, differential protection will operate
without consideration of the restraint current.
The differential operating current is calculated using the following characteristic
equations:
For IR > IR.S2 Id > Slope 2 x ( IR - IR.S2 ) + Slope 1 x ( IR.S2 - Id.LS / 2 ) + Id.Ls
Supplementary features
Inrush detection
Any sudden change of magnetizing voltage will cause a magnetizing inrush. This
most commonly occurs when energising a transformer (initial inrush), but it occurs
also upon voltage recovery after primary system failure (recovery inrush) or
voltage drop when energising a parallel transformer (sympathetic inrush).
This magnetising inrush current usually flows into one transformer winding only
and is not represented at the other transformer end, hence is seen as differential
current from the protection. Therefore, inrush current detection and prevention
from false tripping is an inherent part of the differential protection function.
Inrush condition is determined by evaluating the ratio of the 2nd harmonic to
fundamental current component, based on the phase segregated differential
currents. This signal analysis is executed only if the differential current is within
reasonable limits:
• the fundamental of the differential current is higher than a fixed minimum
current of 0.1 Iref
• the differential current is smaller than a set threshold, set above the expected
maximum inrush current
Further complementary conditions are checked prior to accepting an inrush
condition:
• the differential current waveform must show gaps (namely, periods of few
milliseconds with no current flow, as they are present with real inrush
currents)
• the inrush waveform has to be detected in at least 2 phases (there is no
three-phase transformer energisation condition, where only one phase shows
an inrush waveform).
If inrush detection is enabled and an inrush condition is determined, then
differential protection will be blocked.
The differential protection blocking is settable to be either phase-selective or
cross-blocking.
IH2_A
A &
IH1_A 20ms 30ms
&
IH2_B
A &
IH1_B 20ms 30ms
&
IH2_C
A &
IH1_C 20ms 30ms
&
A H2 / H1 > pick-up H2
CT saturation detection
During external faults CTs may saturate, either because of very high fault currents,
or because of slowly decaying DC offset of primary current. Appropriate measures
are implemented to detect such conditions to prevent false differential tripping. Yet
vice versa, a fast reset of this blocking feature is also provided for fast differential
protection tripping in case of consecutive faults inside the protection zone.
When CTS operates, it will raise its fast CTS alarm output instantaneously, while a
latched CTS alarm output is issued after a set delay has expired.
As a mutual constraint, differential CTS gets blocked and its output reset if (and as
long as) any inrush or overflux blocking signal is present.
Differential CTS is provided with three modes of interaction with differential
protection function:
• Indication only: no impact of CTS alarm on differential protection operation.
• Restraining: the minimum differential protection pick-up value is “shifted”
vertically to a set Id.CTS while CTS alarm is present, as shown below.
• Blocking: differential protection is blocked while CTS alarm is present.
Id
Id.HS
D
A
C
Id.CTS
Id.LS
B
IR.s2 IR
P533SUA
Inrush blocking ≥1
CTS: disabled
>
I1 CT1 & T R
S
Q Latched alarm
> R
I1 CT2
&
Register event
A
>
I2/I1 CT1 & & 0 R
Fast alarm CT1
>
I2/I1 CT2 ≥1 ≥1
Fast alarm
B
>
& & 0 R
Fast alarm CT2
>
&
Register event
Reset input
Block diagram
Figure 301 - Transformer differential protection function structure overview
Inhibit Block
D ≥1
IA-1 (CT1)
E
IB-1 (CT1)
IC-1 (CT1) &
G
&
IA-2 (CT2)
IB-2 (CT2)
IC-2 (CT2)
G Differential CTS
Characteristics
Table 101 - Settings and characteristics of transformer differential protection
function (ANSI 87T)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Reference power
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Low set Id
Setting range 0.10… 3.00 Iref
Slope 1
Resolution 1%
Resolution 1%
High set mode
High set Id
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ± 20 ms
Inrush blocking
Resolution 1%
Inrush cross block
Enable Inrush cross block On/Off
110. Phase shifting angle of an in-zone power transformer (= vector group x 30°)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Resolution 1%
Characteristics
Start time < 35 ms
Disengaging time < 50 ms
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 4
NOTE: The 'No Compare limit for mode <' value can only be set successfully
when it is smaller than the start values in all 4 setting groups. An attempt to set
it higher than the start value in any setting group is rejected, even if the setting
group is not active.
Available signals
Table 102 - Available signals to be supervised by the programmable stages
Signals Description
IN Neutral current
IN.sens Sensitive neutral current
f Frequency
Measurement functions
Primary, secondary and per unit scaling
All measurement values are shown as primary values although the PowerLogic
P5 protection relay is connected with its analogue voltage and current inputs to
secondary signals. Some measurement values are shown as relative values in per
unit or percent. Almost all pick-up setting values are using relative scaling.
The scaling is done using the rated values of VTs and CTs, or LPVTs and LPCTs
depending on the selected model order option.
Scaling settings
The scaling settings define the characteristics of measurement transformers
connected to the PowerLogic P5 protection relay and determine the correct
adaptation and performance of the metering and protection functions.
They are accessed via:
• eSetup Easergy Pro or web HMI Scaling view in General menu
• on local panel in the CT- VT view of the General menu
The scaling parameters are listed in List of scaling parameters, page 449.
VN.prim.nom Rated primary neutral voltage of VT Same setting as the rated primary
transformer voltage of transformer
Voltage Usage of voltage inputs for phase VT 3VP, 3VP+VN, 3VP/VPy, 3VP/VPPy, 2VPP
measurement voltage, neutral voltage or other +VN+VPPy, 2VPP + VN, VPP/VPPy
mode additional voltage
LPVT 3VP, 3VP+VN, 3VP/VPy, 3VP/VPPy
Current values
Primary and secondary values
Table 104 - Primary and secondary scaling
Secondary
-> Primary I np I nop Vsec
I prim = Isec ⋅ I0prim = I0sec ⋅ I prim= Ipr
I ns I nos k 22.5 mV
Primary
-> Secondary
Isec = I prim ⋅
I ns I0sec = I0prim ⋅ I nos Vsec =
I prim
k 22.5 mV
I np Inop Ipr
For neutral current measured by CSH core balance CTs, only primary values are
considered. CTprim is equal at 2A or 20A according to the connection on the
protection relay.
Examples
1. Secondary to primary (CT)
CT = 500 A / 5 A
If the current on PowerLogic P5 input is 4 A, then the corresponding primary
current is Iprim = 4 x 500 / 5 = 400 A.
2. Secondary to primary (LPCT)
LPCT = 100 A / 22.5 mV
If the voltage on the LPCT input is 30 mV, then the corresponding primary
current is Iprim = 30 / 22.5 x 100 = 136 A, whatever is K.
With K = 0.25, Vsec corresponds to 136 / (100 x 0.25) = 5.44 In.
3. Primary to secondary (CT)
CT = 500 A / 5 A
If PowerLogic P5 displays Ipri = 100 A, then the injected current is
Isec = 100 x 5 / 500 = 1 A.
4. Primary to secondary (LPCT)
LPCT = 100 A / 22.5 mV
If PowerLogic P5 displays Iprim = 640 A, then the injected current is
Vsec = 640 / 100 x 22.5 = 144 mV, whatever is K.
With K = 3.2, Vsec corresponds to 640 / (100 x 3.2) = 2 In.
I sec I sec
I pu = Ipu = Vsec / ( k 22.5) I pu = -
Ins Ins
Amp -> Per unit
Iprim= Ipu. Inp Iprim = Ipu · k · Ipr Iprim= Ipu. Inp Iprim= Ipu. Inp
Examples
1. Secondary to per unit for phase current (CT)
CT = 750 A / 5 A
If the current injected is 7 A, then the per unit current is
Ipu = 7 / 5 = 1.4 In = 140%.
2. Per unit to secondary for phase current (CT)
CT = 750 A / 5 A
If the protection setting is 2In = 200%, then the corresponding secondary
current is Isec = 2 x 5 = 10 A.
3. Secondary to per unit for phase current (LPCT)
LPCT = 100 A / 22.5 mV with K = 3.2
If the PowerLogic P5 protection relay displays Iprim = 640 A, then the injected
voltage is
Vsec corresponds to 640 / (100 x 3.2) = 2 In.
4. Primary to per unit for phase current (LPCT)
LPCT rated current = 100 A with LPCT Current factor k = 2 (45 mV at the
secondary)
If the primary current is 150 A (33.75 mV at the secondary), then the per unit
current (voltage) is Ipu = 150/200 = 33.75/45 = 0.75 In.
5. Per unit to primary and secondary value (LPCT)
LPCT rated current = 100 A with LPCT Current factor = 10
If protection setting is 1.5 In, the corresponding secondary voltage is
Vsec = 1.5 x 10 x 22.5 = 337.5 mV,
and the corresponding primary current is
Iprim = 1.5 x 100 x 10 = 1.5 kA.
6. Secondary to per unit for earth/ground fault current (CT)
CT0 = 750 A / 1 A
If for standard and sensitive earth/ground fault inputs or phase current input
(3 CT calculation) the current is 30 mA, then the per unit current is
Ipu = 0.03 / 1 = 0.03In0.
Voltage values
Rated phase and neutral voltage inputs
Voltage transformer scaling is always based on the phase to phase voltages in all
voltage measurements modes.
The rated phase and neutral voltage inputs are defined as below:
NOTE: V1 and V2 are respectively the positive and the negative sequence
voltages. VN is the neutral voltage (zero-sequence voltage x3).
PP PN V1 V2 VN
3VP V.prim. 3.25V/ V.prim. V.prim. V.prim. V. V.prim. V.prim.
nom/√3 √3 nom/ nom nom/√3 prim. nom/√3 nom/√3
√3 nom/
√3
Examples
1. Secondary to primary
Phase to phase voltage measurement mode (VT)
VT = 12000 V / 110 V
If voltage connected to the PowerLogic P5 input V1, V2 or V3 = 100 V, then
primary voltage is V.prim = 100 x 12000 / 110 = 10909 V.
Phase to neutral voltage measurement mode (VT)
VT = 12000 V / 110 V
If the three phase symmetric voltage magnitude is 60 V, then the primary
voltage is V.prim = √3 x 60 x 12000 / 110 = 11336 V.
2. Primary to secondary
Phase to phase voltage measurement mode (VT)
VT = 12000 V / 110 V
If the PowerLogic P5 protection relay displays V.prim = 10910 V, then the
secondary voltage is V.sec = 10910 x 110 / 12000 = 100 V.
Phase to neutral voltage measurement mode (VT)
VT = 12000 V / 110 V
If the PowerLogic P5 protection relay displays
VAB = VBC = VCA = 10910 V for a symmetric voltage system, then the
secondary voltages at V1, V2 and V3 are
V.sec = 10910 / √3 x 110 / 12000 = 57.7 V.
3. Phase to neutral voltage measurement mode (LPVT)
LPVT = 20 kV / 3.25 V with k = 0.5
If the PowerLogic P5 protection relay displays
VAB = VBC = VCA = 11 kV for a symmetric voltage system, then the
secondary voltages V1, V2, and V3 are
V.sec = 11000 / 20000 x 3.25 / √3 = 1.032 V.
Vprim
Vpu =
k Vpr
Vsec V V V
Voltage –> Per unit
Vpu = = prim Vpu = 3 ⋅ VTsec = 3 ⋅ VTprim
VTsec VTprim sec prim
Vsec
Vpu = 3
k 3.25
VTprim
Vprim = Vpu ⋅ VTprim Vprim = Vpu ⋅ Vprim = Vpu k Vpr
3
Examples
1. Secondary to per unit
Phase to phase voltage measurement mode
VT = 12000 V / 110 V
If the voltage input of V1 or V2 is 100 V, then the per unit voltage is
V.pu = 100 / 110 = 1.00 pu = 91%.
Phase to neutral voltage measurement mode
VT = 12000 V / 110 V
If the three symmetric phase to neutral injected to the voltage inputs are 63.5
V, then the per unit voltage is pu = √3 x 63.5 / 110 = 1.00 pu = 100%.
2. Per unit to secondary
Phase to phase voltage measurement mode
VT = 12000 V /110 V
If the PowerLogic P5 protection relay displays 1.00 pu = 100%, then the
secondary voltage is V.sec = 1.00 x 110 = 110 V.
Phase to neutral voltage measurement mode
VT = 12000 V / 110 V
If the PowerLogic P5 protection relay displays 1.00 pu = 80%, then the three
symmetric phase to neutral voltages injected to the inputs are
V.sec = 0.8 x 110 / √3 = 50.8 V.
3. Per unit to secondary for voltage measurement with LPVT
LPVT = 20 kV / 3.25 V with k = 0.8
If the phase to neutral voltage displayed is 0.5 x Vnom, the secondary value
injected to the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is 0.5 x 0.8 x 3.25 / √3 = 0.75
V.
Vprim 1
Vpu = Vpu = V1 + V2 + V3 sec
Vnop k Vpr
Per unit
-> voltage
Vsec = Vpu · Vnos V1 +V2 +V3 sec =Vpu · Vns V1 +V2 +V3 sec = Vpr· k · 3.25
Vprim =Vpu ·Vnop V1 +V2 +V3 prim =Vpu ⋅ Vnp V1 +V2 +V3 prim=Vpu · k ·Vpr
Examples
1. Secondary to per unit
Neutral voltage measurement (VT)
VN.sec = 110 V (this is a configuration value corresponding to VN at full
ground fault.)
If the voltage connected to the device's input V3 is 22 V, then the per unit
voltage is V.pu = 22 / 110 = 0.20 pu = 20%.
Neutral voltage calculated (VT)
VT = 12000 V / 110 V
If the voltage connected to the relay's input V1 is 38.1 V, while V2 = V3 = 0,
then the per unit voltage is
V.pu = (38.1 + 0 + 0) / ( √3 x 110) = 0.20 pu = 20%.
2. Per unit to secondary
Voltage measurement mode is "2PP + VN" (VT)
VN.sec = 110 V (this is a configuration value corresponding to VN at full earth/
ground fault.)
If the relay displays VN = 20%, then the secondary voltage at input V3 is
V.sec = 0.20 x 110 = 22 V.
3. Per unit to secondary
Neutral voltage calculated (VT)
VT = 20 kV /110 V
If the PowerLogic P5 protection relay displays VN = 20% and if V2 = V3 = 0,
then the secondary voltage at V1 is V.sec = √3 x 0.2 x 110 = 38.1 V.
Neutral voltage calculated (LPVT)
LPVT = 20 kV / √3 / 3.25 V / √3 with k = 1.5
If PowerLogic P5 protection relay displays 30% and V1 = V3 = 0, then the
secondary voltage of V2 is V.sec = 0.3 x 1.5 x 3.25 / 1.732 = 0.844 V.
Reading of measurements
All measurement values can be read out via:
• Local panel: Measurements menu ( ) and on the Mimic screen if they were
configured with eSetup Easergy Pro
• eSetup Easergy Pro: Measurements menu
• Communication interface (if the used protocol provide this)
• EcoStruxure Power Device application
The refresh interval, on automatic cyclic updates, is less than 1 second typically.
Phase currents
PowerLogic P5 measures the fundamental and RMS values of phase current
inputs using 1A CTs, 5A CTs, or LPCTs:
Value Description
Fundamental value
IA Fundamental value of phase 1 current IA
RMS value
IArms RMS value of phase 1 current IA
The RMS current measurement takes into account harmonics up to the 15th. The
calculation is done as follows:
2 2 2
IRMS = If 1 + If 2 + ... +If 15 P533Z1A
Magnitude
Phase angle116
116. Phase angle can only be detected when current is over 100 mA.
117. Nominal CT Rating
Neutral current
The neutral current is calculated by the vector sum of the 3 phase currents or
directly measured with a conventional CT or CSH core balance CT. Where the
neutral current is directly measured, the PowerLogic P5 protection relay uses
either the connected standard earth/ground fault input (IN) or alternatively the
sensitive earth/ground fault input (IN.sens).
IN.meas (IN 0.005...30.000 IN.nom A 0.01 A ±0.5% for In > 0.05 IN.nom
measured with ±1% for range 0.02...0.05 IN.nom
standard 1 A/5 A ±2% for In < 0.02 IN.nom
CT)
IN.sens (IN 0.002...4.000 IN.sens.nom A 0.001 A ±2% for In < 0.002 IN.sens.nom
measured with ±1% for In > 0.002 IN.sens.nom
sensitive 1 A CT)
Frequency
PowerLogic P5 protection relay determines the frequency based on the samples
of an available voltage or current signal. The frequency determination will be
automatically adapted to the availability and quality of the related signal inputs:
• Based on positive sequence voltage V1 or
• Based on any single phase to phase voltage or phase to neutral voltage or
• Based on currents when the voltage is not measured or below 15%Vnom.
The frequency is not measured if:
• The maximum of three phase to phase or phase to neutral voltages or
positive sequence voltage V1 is less than 15% Vnom
• The maximum of three currents or positive sequence current (I1) is less than
10%Inom.
The following table provides an overview of the characteristics for frequency
measurement:
Table 116 - Characteristics for frequency measurement
Characteristics Range
Units Hz
Resolution 0.001 Hz
Accuracy ± 0.01 Hz
Voltages
The PowerLogic P5 measures the fundamental and RMS values of phase to
phase voltages and phase to neutral voltages.
Value Description
VAB Fundamental value of the phase to phase voltage between phase A and phase B
VBC Fundamental value of the phase to phase voltage between phase B and phase C
VCA Fundamental value of the phase to phase voltage between phase C and phase A
VABrms RMS value of the phase to phase voltage between phase A and phase B
VBCrms RMS value of the phase to phase voltage between phase B and phase C
VCArms RMS value of the phase to phase voltage between phase C and phase A
These voltages are measured with the three analogue voltage inputs VA, VB and
VC.
A 4th analogue voltage input V4 is used to measure an additional phase to phase
voltage or phase to neutral voltage, which is usually used as a reference voltage
for the synchronisation checking function.
Vy : fundamental value of the additional phase to phase voltage
Vyrms : RMS value of the additional phase to phase voltage calculated as follows:
2 2 2
VRMS = Vf 1 + Vf 2 + ... +Vf 15 P533Z2A
For phase to phase (2VPP) connections, which can be applied for cost reasons in
isolated or compensated power systems, the three phase to phase voltages are
directly measured and the phase to neutral voltages are calculated taking into
account the neutral voltage measurement (VN) when it is measured. Otherwise,
the calculation considers a balanced power system.
For phase to neutral (3VP) connections, the three phase to neutral voltages are
directly measured and the three phase to phase voltages are calculated.
Table 118 - The voltage modes and the corresponding measurements and
calculated values
3VP/VPy VT, LPVT VA, VB, VC, VAB, VBC, VCA, VA'
VAy118 VABy
3VP/VPPy VT, LPVT VA, VB, VC, VAB, VBC, VCA VAB'
VABy118
Table 118 - The voltage modes and the corresponding measurements and
calculated values (Continued)
Depending on the phase rotation, the phase to phase values are defined
according to A-B-C network: phase to neutral and phase to phase voltages, page
461 and A-C-B network: phase to neutral and phase to phase voltages, page 461:
• For voltage between phases A and B:
VAB = VA - VB P533Z3A
VBC = VB - VC P533Z4A
VCA = VC - VA P533Z5A
Figure 302 - A-B-C network: phase Figure 303 - A-C-B network: phase
to neutral and phase to phase to neutral and phase to phase
voltages voltages
VC VB
VCA VAB
VA VA
VBC VBC
VAB VCA
VC
VB P533MLA
P533MMA
Neutral voltage
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay measures the fundamental value of a neutral
voltage VN by an open star/delta voltage transformer. If such a VT is not available,
the protection relay is able to calculate VN by taking the internal sum of the three
phase to neutral voltages:
VN = VA + VB + VC
If the calculation method is used, the measurement can only be considered as
valid if the power system is balanced.
The following table provides an overview of the measuring options:
The following table lists the characteristics for measuring neutral voltage:
Power calculation
The power values are calculated in detail as follows:
• By 3 wattmeter method:
• By 2 wattmeter method:
S = P +Q
2 2
P533ZAA
P533MOB
P533MNB
Cosφ = P P +Q
2 2
P533ZBA
means inductive i.e. lagging current and 'CAP' means capacitive i.e. leading
current).
cos = cos = +
PF = ind PF= cap
VREF 0°
III I IV
cos = cos = +
PF= cap PF = ind P533MPA
Q
+90°
II I
cos = cos = +
PF= cap PF = ind
S
P 0°
III IV
cos = cos = +
PF = ind PF = cap P533MQA
Characteristics
The following tables summarise the characteristics for power measuring:
Measurement 0 to 1 IND/CAP -1 to +1
range
Accuracy ± 1% typical126
∑h
i=2
i
2
THD =
h1 P533ZCA
where
h1 = Fundamental value
h2 - h15 = Harmonics
Example
h1 = 100A, h3 = 10 A, h7 = 3 A, h11 = 8 A
102 + 32 + 82 =
THD = 13.15%
100 P533ZDA
Demand values
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay calculates average demand values of phase
currents IA, IB, IC and power values S, P and Q. They are calculated over an
adjustable demand time in a range from 10 to 60 minutes.
The parameters used to configure or control the demand values in the
MEASUREMENTS menu/Demand values sub-menu of eSetup Easergy Pro are
the following:
RMS values
IARMSda A Demand of RMS phase current IA
Characteristics Range
VN Neutral voltage
f Frequency
PF Power factor
The clearing parameter "ClrMax" is a common reset for all min. and max. values.
Average current
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay calculates the average of the three phase
currents IA + IB + IC over a period of time defined by the “Average current
window” setting, in the 3_Phase Average current view of the Measurements
menu in eSetup Easergy Pro.
If the “Average current window” is set to “Demand Time”, the setting value will
depend on the “Demand time” setting, which is configured in the Demand values
view of the Measurements menu.
Table 132 - Demand values
The average current is refreshed each second when the “ Average current
window” is set to “1 s”, and it is refreshed each minute when the “Average current
window” is set to “1 min” or “Demand Time”.
The average current is available in eSetup Easergy Pro and all communication
interfaces.
Measurement mode
There are 3 selections in drop menu: Ph-Ph, Ph-G and Default, stand for different
types of measured voltage.
• Ph-Ph: phase to phase voltage
• Ph-G: phase to ground voltage
• Default: use the setting of “Voltage mode” from system setting.
Figure 306 - Example of SSW maximum time and SSW gap time
B
D D D
E E
P533TMA
Setting/characteristics Values
Measurement mode
Options Default (same as the scaling setting); Ph-Ph; Ph-G
Resolution 1% Un128
Resolution 1% Un128
Resolution 0.02 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±30 ms
Resolution 1% Un128
Maximum time
Setting range 10...1000 s
Resolution 1s
Gap time
Resolution 0.01 s
Characteristic time
Disengaging time < 60 ms
Temperature
Operation
This function gives the temperature value measured by Resistance Temperature
Detectors (RTDs):
• Platinum Pt100 (100 Ω at 0°C or 32°F) in accordance with the IEC 60751 and
DIN 43760 standards
• Nickel 100 Ω or 120 Ω (at 0°C or 32°F).
Each RTD channel gives one measurement: tx = RTD x temperature.
The function also indicates RTD faults:
• RTD disconnected (t > 205°C or t > 401°F)
• RTD shorted (t < -35°C or t < -31°F).
In the event of a fault, the display of the value is inhibited.
The associated monitoring function generates a maintenance alarm.
Readout
The measurements may be accessed via:
• RTD view of the Measures menu on the local panel of the PowerLogic P5
protection relay
• Temperature view of the MEASUREMENTS menu in eSetup Easergy Pro
• The communication link
Characteristics
Table 134 - Characteristics of temperature measuring
Characteristics Values
Range -30...+200°C (-22...+392°F)
L (km)
∆t (℃) = 2
S (mm2) P533ZFA
Control functions
Digital outputs
Description
Digital outputs are available for control and signalling purposes.
The number of available outputs depends on the number and type of board
options ordered.
The following digital output contact relays are available:
• Slot B
The digital output DO1 is normally opened (NO) contact (and high speed high
break contact for P5x30 only) used for control. The digital output DO2
(Change Over contact) is usually used for control.
The digital output DO3 (Normal Open) is usually used for control.
The digital output DO4 (change over contact) is dedicated to the watchdog
(signalling).
Both the tripping DO2 relay and the watchdog relay have normally open (NO)
or normally closed (NC) contacts. Refer to Selecting the trip command and
examples of use, page 511.
• Slot C, D, E (6I4O option)
The digital outputs DO1 to DO4 (Normal Open single pole single throw) are
for signalling only.
Slot C, D, E (5I5O option)
The digital outputs DO1 and DO2 (Change Over contact single pole double
throw) are usually used for control.
The digital outputs DO3 (Normal Open single pole single throw) are for
control.
The digital outputs DO4 and DO5 are normally opened (NO) contact and high
speed high break contact used for control.
Slot C, D, E (12I4O option)
The digital outputs DO1 to DO4 are independently controlled normally open
signalling contacts with DO1 & DO2 and DO3 & DO4 having a common
connection point.
• Slot D, E (Arc-flash option)
The digital output DO1 (Normal Open) is usually used for control.
The digital output DO2 (Change Over contact single pole double throw) is
usually used for control.
The digital output DO3 (Normal Open single pole single throw) is usually used
for signalling.
The contacts are (SPST) normal open (NO) type, except signal relay DO2
and DO4 (watchdog) which has a changeover contact (SPDT).
The digital outputs can be set in Normal Open or Normal Close position with
eSetup Easergy Pro and Web HMI in the Relays polarity view of the Control
menu.
The status of the digital outputs can be read:
• with eSetup Easergy Pro in the Relays view of the Device/Test menu
• by the local panel in the digital output Slot x view under the menu option DO
of the Device/Test sub-menu
• EcoStruxure Power Device application
• Web HMI
Label and description texts can be edited with eSetup Easergy Pro or the Web
HMI in Names for output relays view according to the demand. Labels are the
short parameter names used on the local panel display and descriptions are the
longer names used by eSetup Easergy Pro (the Names of the output relays view
in the Control menu).
Any internal signal can be connected to the output relays using the output matrix.
An output relay can be configured as latched or non-latched. (see Output Matrix
view in the Matrix menu of eSetup Easergy Pro and Web HMI).
D E A B C
1 1 1 1
2 2 1 2 2 2
3 3 3 3
4 4 3 4 4 4
5 5 5 5
6 6 5 6 6 6
7 7 7 7
8 8 7 8 8 8
9 9 9 9
10 10 10 10
11 11 9 10 11 11
12 12 12 12
13 13 11 12 13 13
14 14 14 14
15 15 13 14 15 15
16 16 16 16
17 17 15 16 17 17
18 18 18 18
19 19 17 18 19 19
20 20 20 20
L M N P
P533NCA
No option DO1...DO3
+ WD
1 x 6I/4O DO1...DO3 DO1...DO4
+ WD
2 x 6I/4O DO1...DO3 DO1...DO4 DO1...DO4
+ WD
3 x 6I/4O DO1...DO3 DO1...DO4 DO1...DO4 DO1...DO4
+ WD
Characteristics
Table 136 - Characteristics of the digital outputs
Label String of max. Short name for digital outputs on the Editable parameter
16 characters local display. (password needed)
Default is "DO1...DOx". x is the
maximum number of the digital outputs.
Description String of max. Long name for digital outputs. Editable parameter
32 characters Default is "Digital output 1...Digital (password needed)
output x". x is the maximum number of
the digital outputs.
Digital inputs
WARNING
FIRE
Do not connect power greater than 0.5 W to each digital input for ambient
temperature lower than 70℃ (158℉), or 0.8 W for lower than 45℃ (113℉).
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or
equipment damage.
Digital inputs are available for control purposes. For example, the digital inputs
can provide the position of the circuit breaker and make it possible to change
setting group, block/enable/disable functions, program logic, and indicate object
status.
The number of available inputs depends on the number and type of option boards.
The digital inputs require an external control voltage (AC or DC) and are activated
after the voltage exceeds the pick-up threshold. Deactivation follows when the
voltage drops below the drop-off threshold limit.
Figure 308 - The Digital inputs setting section in the Digital inputs view
1s 1s
V
0
Digital input
0 P533R4C
Digital inputs on/off events and alarm pop-up message display can be enabled
and disabled in Digital inputs setting view of eSetup Easergy Pro or Web HMI.
Individual operation counters are located in the same view as well. The maximum
value of the counters is settable and is the same for all counters.
The status of the digital inputs can be read:
• with eSetup Easergy Pro and Web HMI in the Digital inputs view of the
CONTROL menu
• by local panel in the Digital inputs view of the DI menu option in the Control
menu
• EcoStruxure Power Device application
• Communication according to the protocol
The configuration of the digital inputs in eSetup Easergy Pro is common for all
digital inputs on the same board.
The digital inputs can be set for the following voltage values with pre-defined
setting values or settable values:
• Universal (by default)
• Standard AC or DC voltages (24 V DC, 48 V DC, 110 V DC, 220 V DC and
220 V AC)
• Customisable AC (settable from 90 V AC to 230 V AC), customisable DC
(settable from 24 V DC to 220 V DC)
Timing diagram of a digital input during pick-up, page 480 and Timing diagram of a
digital input during a drop-off, page 480 below illustrate the timing diagrams of a
digital input during pick-up and drop-off:
C
D
E
F P533NEB
D
E P533R9C
E DI low
Label and description texts can be edited with eSetup Easergy Pro according to
the demand. Labels are the short parameter names used on the local panel and
descriptions are the longer names used by eSetup Easergy Pro.
The digital input signals can be connected to the different outputs of the Output
matrix, Block matrix, Object block matrix, Auto-recloser 79 matrix views in
the MATRIX menu of eSetup Easergy Pro and Web HMI or used in the custom
logic function.
D E A B C
1 1 1 1
2 2 1 2 2 2
3 3 3 3
4 4 3 4 4 4
5 5 5 5
6 6 5 6 6 6
7 7 7 7
8 8 7 8 8 8
9 9 9 9
10 10 10 10
11 11 9 10 11 11
12 12 12 12
13 13 11 12 13 13
14 14 14 14
15 15 13 14 15 15
16 16 16 16
17 17 15 16 17 17
18 18 18 18
19 19 17 18 19 19
20 20 20 20
L M N P
P533NGA
No option DI1...DI4
Characteristics
Table 138 - Characteristics of the digital inputs
Parameter Value
Universal Standard voltage Customisable voltage
Power maximum 0.5 W for ambient temperature less than 70℃ (158 ℉);
0.8 W for ambient temperature less than 45℃ (113 ℉);
Delay 0.00...60.00 s
Parameter Value
Universal Standard voltage Customisable voltage
Counters 0 to 255 - 511 - 1023 - 2047 - 4095 - 8191 - 16383 - 32767 - 65535
Reset automatically to 0 if the limit is exceeded.
Name of digital inputs Label: short name for display on the local panel.
String of max. 10 characters. Default is "DI1...DIx".
NOTE: Digital inputs can be assigned to a signal with normal state or inverted
state.
Number of 50
Virtual Inputs
Number of 20
Virtual Outputs
Label String of Short name for virtual inputs and Editable parameter
max. 10 virtual outputs on the local display. (password needed)
characters Default is "VI1...VIn" and "VO1...
VOn". n is the maximum number of
the digital inputs or outputs.
Description String of Long name for virtual inputs and Editable parameter
max. 32 virtual outputs. Default is "Virtual input (password needed)
characters 1 (or Virtual output 1)...Virtual input n
(or Virtual output n)".
n is the maximum number of the
virtual inputs or virtual outputs.
Matrix
General information
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay has several matrices that are used for linking
the hardware and software elements together to create a protection chain:
• Output matrix
Used to link various inputs, outputs, statuses and signals to send a command
to the contact relays and virtual outputs, to activate disturbance recording,
and to provide SOL status.
• Block matrix
Used to block protection stages
• LED matrix
Used to control LEDs on the local panel
• Object block matrix
Used to inhibit object control
• Auto-recloser matrix
Used to control auto-recloser
• Arc-flash matrix
Used for Arc-flash detection functions
• Event matrix
See Logging and recording functions, page 515.
• Goose matrix
Used in association with IEC61850 (see the Goose matrix view in the
communication menu).
It allows to associate up to 250 Goose messages (NIx) to a virtual input or a
Goose message (NI).
Protection stages
Directly
measured Block matrix Output matrix User’s logic
I n
n values START I
TRIP N
V START
n Calculate TRIP P
START U
S, P, Q, n BLOCK TRIP T
cosφ, tanφ, INPUT
symmetric BLOCK S
components INPUT
etc. BLOCK
INPUT OUTPUTS
... n
Digital
inputs
n Output relays Virtual
DI and indicators outputs
n Optional
delay
and
inversion n
Output matrix
The output matrix is used for connecting signals issued by different functions to
the output relays (DO), virtual outputs (VO) and disturbance record trigger (DR).
The connecting signals to the outputs are the following:
• Protection signals from the different stages including setting changes
• Auto-recloser information
• Digital inputs
• Virtual inputs and outputs
• Object control command
• Function keys
• Goose
• Voltage sag/swell and interrupt
• Timers
The Output matrix setting view of eSetup Easergy Pro and Web HMI represents
the state (de-energised/energised) of the digital output's coil. For example, an
orange vertical line in the Output matrix and a logical "1" in the Relays view
represent the energised state of the coil. The same principle applies for both NO
and NC type digital outputs. The actual position (open/closed) of the digital
outputs' contacts in coil's de-energised and energised state depends on the type
(NO/NC) of the digital outputs. De-energised state of the coil corresponds to the
normal state of the contacts.
A digital output can be configured as latched or non-latched. The releasing latches
procedure is described in Releasing latches, page 490.
Programming matrix
Matrix connection without latch
The connection is shown as a single bullet.
• When the input signal is activated, the output is activated
• When the input signal is released, the output is released
Latched matrix connection
The latched connection is shown as a single bullet surrounded by a circle.
• When the input signal is activated, the output is activated
• When the input signal is released, the output will remain active until cleared
manually (refer to Releasing latches, page 490).
No connection
The line crossing is empty.
NOTE: Logic outputs (see Logic functions, page 498) are also assigned
automatically in the output matrix when defined in any user programmable
logic scheme.
Blocking matrix
The operation of any protection stage can be blocked using the blocking matrix in
the MATRIX menu/Block matrix sub-menu. The blocking signal can originate
from the digital inputs or it can be a start or trip signal from a protection stage or an
output signal from the user's programmable logic.
The Blocked status becomes visible only when the stage is about to activate.
Figure 315 - A view from the setting tool showing a DI input blocking
connection (left picture) and the result for the I> stage when the DI is active
and the stage exceeds its current start value
NOTICE
UNINTENDED AND NUISANCE TRIPPING
• In the online mode, the blocking matrix is dynamically controlled by selecting
and deselecting protection stages.
• Activate the protection stages first, then store the settings in the protection
relay. After that, refresh the blocking matrix before configuring it.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unwanted shutdown of
the electrical installation.
LED matrix
The LED matrix defines the use of the Alarm LED , the trip LED , and the
configurable LEDs on the local panel of PowerLogic P5 protection relay. A lot of
functions can be assigned to each LED.
Protection, arc and green or red Normal/ Different type of protection Set
programmable stages Latched/ stages can be assigned to
BlinkLatch LEDs
Digital/virtual inputs and green or red Normal/ All different type of inputs Set
function buttons Latched/ can be assigned to LEDs
BlinkLatch
Object open/close, object green or red Normal/ Information related to Set
final trip and object failure Latched/ objects and object control
information BlinkLatch
Local control enabled green or red Normal/ While remote/local state is Set
Latched/ selected as local the "local
BlinkLatch control enabled" is active
Logic output 1-20 green or red Normal/ All logic outputs can be Set
Latched/ assigned to LEDs at the
BlinkLatch LED matrix
Manual control indication green or red Normal/ When the user has Set
Latched/ controlled the objectives
BlinkLatch
Setting error, self green or red Normal/ Self diagnostic signal Set
diagnostic alarm, pwd open Latched/
and setting change BlinkLatch
All the LEDs (6 for PowerLogic P5x20; 10 for PowerLogic P5x30) can be assigned
as green or red in the MATRIX menu/LED matrix sub-menu of eSetup Easergy
Pro. The selection of green and red at the same time will result in yellow.
The connection can be normal, latched or blink-latched (flashing).
NOTE: It is not possible to control LEDs directly from logics.
Normal connection
When the connection is normal, the assigned LED is active when the control
signal is active. After deactivation, the LED turns off. LED activation and
deactivation delay when controlled is approximately 10 ms.
Latched connection
A latched LED activates when the control signal activates but remains lit even
when the control signal deactivates. Latched LEDs can be released by pressing
the key on the local panel.
Blink-latched connection
When the connection is "BlinkLatch", the assigned LED is active and blinking as
long as the control signal is active. After deactivation, the LED remains latched
and blinking. The latch can be released by pressing the key on the local panel.
Auto-recloser matrix
The auto-recloser matrix is used to link digital inputs, virtual inputs, protection
stage outputs, object statuses, logic outputs, alarm signals and GOOSE signals to
control the auto-recloser. For more information, see Auto-recloser function (ANSI
79), page 420.
Arc-flash matrix
The arc-flash detection matrix uses three types of matrix:
• Arc-flash light matrix
The arc-flash light matrix is used for connecting light signals detected by
sensors or Goose or any virtual inputs to the different stages of the Arc-flash
detection function.
• Arc-flash current matrix
The arc-flash current matrix is used for connecting current signals and any
virtual inputs to the different stages of the Arc-flash detection function.
• Arc-flash output matrix
The arc-flash output matrix is used for connecting the different arc stage
signals to the digital outputs.
See Arc-flash (ANSI 50ARC), page 369 for more information on the arc-flash
protection function of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
Releasing latches
According to the matrix configurations different outputs and indicators can be
latched or non-latched. A non-latched output or indicator follows the controlling
signal. A latched output or indicator remains active after the controlling signal
releases.
There is a common "release all latches" signal to release all the latched relays.
This release signal resets all the latched digital outputs and indicators.
Each digital output can be latched or not independently through the output matrix.
The release of the latches can be done:
• Directly with the key on the local panel
• With a digital input/output or virtual input/output set in the CONTROL menu/
Release latches sub-menu of eSetup Easergy Pro or Web HMI
• With eSetup Easergy Pro, click Device button in the toolbar and select
Release all latches
• With Web HMI
• Through communication
Mimic display
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay can display multiple mimic screens (up to 5)
on the local panel. The mimic screen can be entered from the main screen/default
screen.
When pressing the mimic entry, the first mimic is shown on the local panel. The
user can use the left/right navigation keys to switch between mimics. If the first
mimic is currently displayed, only right navigation key is functional. If the 5th mimic
is currently displayed, only left navigation key is functional. It is not possible to add
or remove any mimic, but it can be hidden by clicking the Visibility button in the
mimic configuration screen.
There are two ways to configure a mimic screen, from scratch, or from one
existing mimic by clicking the Duplicate button located in the mimic configuration
screen. The name and the content of each individual mimic can be edited. The
content of each mimic is independent of the others. The user can click the left/right
shift button to switch between mimic screens. The mimics can be configured in
online mode (connected to the PowerLogic P5 by mini-USB port or Ethernet port)
or offline mode.
Each mimic can display a single-line diagram, which can be created in eSetup
Easergy Pro through the Mimic view of the GENERAL menu. Up to 8 analogue
measurements (voltage, current, power...) based on the selection and up to 5
digital signals with fixed assignment can be displayed in one mimic. In order to
display all the required information, the user can spread the information across
multiple mimics.
Considering checking all the five mimics on default screen scenario, the user can
use the up/down navigation keys to switch between mimics, and use the left/right
navigation keys to view the Main measurements, firmware version and the
Alarm list screens from the PowerLogic P5.
O P Q R
A B C D E F G
J
K L
H
M
I
N
B Draw line: used to draw lines in the view K Remote / Local state
To draw a line, select the tool, click the left Depending on the state, some settings
mouse button at the start point and then and actions are not allowed
move the cursor to the second point and The remote / Local state can be changed
click again. in the Objects view of the CONTROL
menu.
E Zoom in: used to increase the size of the N Up to 8 freely selectable measurements
view To select the measurements to be shown
To zoom in, click the tool until the view in the view
reaches the desired size.
F Zoom out: used to decrease the size of O The sequence number of the mimic
the view
To zoom out, click the tool until the view
reaches the desired size.
G Clear view: used to remove all objects P Shift key: used to switch between
from the view different mimics
To clear the view, click the tool and select
OK to confirm.
H Different choice of configurable objects Q Visibility key: used to hide/unhide the
The object's number corresponds to the mimic
number in the Object menu.
I Some predefined drawings for use in the R Duplicate key: used to copy the current
view. mimic
Virtual input 1–4 0 Change the status of virtual inputs while the
1 password is enabled. Position can be changed.
Display evt time not sync Checked Event time shown normally if
unchecked relay is synchronised, or
otherwise in brackets.
Object for control buttons Object 1 - Object 6
Clear events -
Clear
Default screen Used to set the default home
screen of the local panel.
Controllable objects
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay allows the control of six objects, that is,
circuit-breakers, disconnectors and earthing/grounding switches by the "select
before operate" or "direct control" principle.
The object block matrix and logic functions can be used to configure interlocking
to help ensure the control before the output pulse is issued. The objects 1 - 6 are
controllable whilst the additional objects 7 - 8 are only able to show the status.
Controlling of objects 1–6 is possible in the following ways:
• through the object control buttons (I/O)
• through the local panel and display using single line diagram
• through the function key
• through a digital input
• through a remote communication
• through eSetup Easergy Pro setting tool
• through Web HMI
• through the EcoStruxure Power Device application
The connection of an object to specific controlling outputs is done via an output
matrix (object 1 – 6 open output, object 1 – 6 close output). There is also an output
signal "Object failed" that is activated if the control of an object is not completed.
Object states
Each object has the following states:
Open
Close
Undefined (11)
DI for "obj open" None, any digital input, virtual input Open information
or virtual output
DI for "obj close" Close information
Max ctrl pulse 0.02...600 s Pulse length for open and close
length commands. Control pulse stops
once object changes its state
If changing the states takes longer than the time defined by the "Max ctrl pulse
length" setting, the object is inoperative and the "Object failure" matrix signal is
set. Also, an undefined event is generated. "Completion timeout" is only used for
the ready indication. If the "DI for 'obj ready'" is not set, the completion timeout has
no meaning.
NOTE: The Object can only be controlled when its position is in a known state.
Output signals of controllable objects
Each controllable object has two control signals in the matrix:
DI for "obj open" None, any digital input, virtual input Open information
or virtual output
DI for "obj close" Close information
If changing states takes longer than the time defined by "Object timeout" setting,
an "Object failure" matrix signal is set, and an undefined-event is generated.
The selection of the L/R digital input is done in the CONTROL menu/Objects sub-
menu of the eSetup Easergy Pro or Web HMI.
Setting Active
If the protection relay is in a local control state, the remote control inputs are
ignored and vice versa. An object is controlled when a rising edge is detected from
the selected input. The length of digital input pulse should be at least 60 ms.
Status 0 Disabled
1 Enabled
Selected control V1...V50 Virtual input
Fn Function key n
Object for control - Disabled: the control buttons do not control Set
buttons any object.
Obj1...Obj6 Button
Timers
Description
The PowerLogic P5 protection platform includes four settable timers that can be
used together with the user's programmable logic or to control setting groups and
other applications that require actions based on calendar time. Each timer has its
own settings. After setting the selected on-time and off-time you can then select
whether the timer is activated every day or just selected days of the week (See the
setting parameters for details). The timer outputs are available for logic functions
and for the block and output matrices.
P533NIA
You can force any timer, which is in use to on or off. The forcing is done by writing
a new status value. Unlike the digital inputs no forcing flag is needed.
The forced timer status remains as forced until the next forced change or the next
time the timer automatically changes status.
The status of each timer is stored in the non-volatile memory when the auxiliary
power is switched off. At startup, the status of each timer is recovered.
Setting parameters
Table 145 - Setting parameters of timers
MTWTF The timer switches on and off every day except Saturdays and
Sundays
MTWTFS The timer switches on and off every day except Sundays.
SatSun The timer switches on and off every Saturday and Sunday.
Logic functions
PowerLogic P5 protection relay supports user-defined programmable logic for
boolean signals. User-configurable logic can be used to create functionality that is
not provided by the protection relay as a default. You can see and modify the logic
in the Logic setting view of the Control menu in the eSetup Easergy Pro or Web
HMI.
Table 146 - Available logic functions and their memory use
AND 1
OR 1
XOR 1
AND+OR 2
CT 2
(count + reset)
250
INVAND 2 (An input gate can include 20
any number of signals.)
INVOR 2
OR+AND133 2
RS 2
(set + reset)
RS_D 4
(set + D + load +
reset)
Set
Virtual input 1 & & RS TCS alarm Virtual output 1
Reset
2000
≥1
CB Open_DI1
&
CB Close_DI2
≥1
CB Open_DI1
CB Close_DI2
P533NJB
On Signal mapping window, make Timer mode setting checked, a Logic output
(t) will be shown. By clicking on the Logic output(t), requested timer mode could be
selected together with the dedicated time configured.
The protection relay’s HMI screen could display a countdown logic timer pop-up
window. It could be enabled in the Logic timers view of the Control menu of
eSetup Easergy Pro or the local panel. The popup window could be closed by
pressing any key.
Settings/characteristics Value
Timer mode
Setting range Op./Rel.delay; Op.delay/Pulse; Op./Rel.retrig;
Op./Pulse.retrig; Minimum time
t1
Settings/characteristics Value
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
t2
Setting range 0...60,000.00 s
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±20 ms
The following figures show the time characteristics for the various timer stage
operating modes.
Logic output n
t1 = 0 s
Logic output n
t1, t2 > 0 s
Logic output n
Logic output n
t1 = 0 s
Logic output n
t1, t2 > 0 s
Logic output n
t2 = 0 s
Logic output n
Retrigger pulse
t1 = 0 s
Logic output n
t2
Retrigger pulse
t1, t2 > 0 s
Logic output n
Logic output n
P533NOB
t1 minimum time
Logic output n
t1 = 0 s
Logic output n
Retrigger pulse
t1, t2 > 0 s
Logic output n
AND
In Out
A Y
0 0
1 1
In Out
A Y
0 1
1 0
In Out
A B Y
0 0 0
1 1 1
1 0 0
0 1 0
In Out
A B Y
0 0 1
1 1 0
1 0 1
0 1 1
AND+OR
In Out
A B Y
0 0 0
1 1 1
1 0 1
0 1 1
CT
(count+reset)
In Out
A B Y Y
Cont Reset Setting New
1 3 0
1 3 0
1 3 1
1 3 0
OR
In Out
A B Y
0 0 0
1 1 1
1 0 1
0 1 1
In Out
A B Y
0 0 1
1 1 0
1 0 0
0 1 0
In Out
A B C Y
0 0 0 0
1 0 0 1
1 1 0 1
0 1 0 1
1 1 1 1
In Out
A B C Y
0 0 0 1
1 0 0 0
1 1 0 0
0 1 0 0
1 1 1 0
INVAND
In Out
A B Y
0 0 0
1 0 1
1 1 0
0 1 0
INVOR
In Out
A B Y
0 0 1
1 1 1
1 0 1
0 1 0
OR+AND
(AND+OR
reversed) In Out
A B Y
0 0 0
1 1 1
1 0 0
0 1 0
RS
(set+reset)
A B Y
Set Reset Y
1 0 1
1 1 0
0 0 0
0 1 0
RS_D
(set+D+load+reset)
A B C D Y
Set D-input Load Reset Y
0 0 0 0 0
1 x x 0 1
0 1 0 0 0
0 1 1 0 1
x x x 1 0
XOR
In Out
A B C Y
0 0 0 0
0 0 1 1
0 1 0 1
0 1 1 0
1 0 0 1
1 0 1 0
1 1 0 0
1 1 1 0
Advanced logic
PowerLogic P5 protection relay can also support an advanced programming tool
(ISaGRAF™ Workbench of Rockwell Automation) for developing user-defined
programmable logic. The advanced logic can be used in conjunction with the
programmable logic to create a very flexible and strong logic capability. The
programmable logic is optimised for execution speed whilst the advanced logic of
ISaGRAF™ provides flexibility. Typically, high speed interlocks and tripping
functions should use the programmable logic whilst less time demanding functions
such as complex control functions are more suited to the advanced logic.
ISaGRAF™ offers a solution compliant to the IEC 61131 and IEC 61499 standards.
To know whether the PowerLogic P5 protection relay supports the advanced logic
function or not, check the second last bit of the model number. For PowerLogic P5
with V01.40x.yyy firmware version C stands for Advanced logic and CS Basic. D
stands for Advanced logic and CS Advanced. For PowerLogic P5 with
V01.500.101 firmware version and next ones, F stands for Advanced logic and CS
Settable (CS Basic or CS Advanced).
P 5 x 2 0 - _ _ _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ C _
P 5 x 3 0 - _ _ _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ D _
P 5 x 3 0 - _ _ _ _ - _ _ _ _ _ - _ _ F _
Settings/characteristics Value
Inputs
Number 2048
Outputs
Number 128
Execution rate
Value 40 ms
Timer
Accuracy ±1% or ±40 ms
The eSetup Easergy pro provides several parameters about the advanced logic
function. Project files CRC is Cyclic Redundancy Check for project files, which is
to check whether the content of the logic is changed. Project name, Project
comment, Configuration name and Configuration comment can be
customised in the ISaGRAF™ Workbench.
In order to create an advanced logic, the ISaGRAF™ Workbench software of
Rockwell Automation needs to be installed on the computer and a license for
activating the ISaGRAF™ is needed. For more information on the license, please
contact RAisagraf_sales@ra.rockwell.com or local Rockwell Automation Sales
Office.
NOTICE
IMPROPER OPERATION
The property resource name should not be modified in the ISaGRAF™
Workbench.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in improper operation.
3. When the logic is built, click Save and close the ISaGRAF® workbench. A
pop-up window showing the information “Do you want to attach advanced
logic project (ISaGRAF™) to the configuration?” appears on the screen of the
eSetup Easergy pro. Click Yes.
4. In the eSetup Easergy pro, click Save as to save the complete configuration
file, which includes the created advanced logic, locally.
5. Connect the P5 device through the eSetup Easergy pro, and open the saved
configuration file. Then Write the configuration file to the P5 device.
eSetup Easergy Pro is the only way to download ISaGRAF™ logic into P5 device.
In the process of downloading, if there are invalid signals, an alarm window will
pop-up (while the ISaGRAF™ program continues to run).
2. Click the Edit advanced logic in the CONTROL menu/Advanced logic sub-
menu via the eSetup Easergy Pro.
3. Update the advanced logic in the ISaGRAF™ Workbench.
4. After updating, click Save and close the ISaGRAF™ Workbench. Then A pop-
up window appears on the screen of the eSetup Easergy pro. Click Yes.
5. Write the configuration file to the P5 device via the eSetup Easergy Pro.
eSetup Easergy Pro is the only way to download ISaGRAF™ logic into P5 device.
Commissioning
NOTICE
CYBER SECURITY
The ISaGRAF™ debugging protocols are without any security capabilities. The
data is transmitted in clear text. Thus, the debug function must only be used in
secured communication networks.
It is strongly recommended to disable this debug (or commissioning) feature in
normal operation mode, as done with default settings.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in improper operation.
3. Enter the IP address of the mini-USB port or the Ethernet port of the
PowerLogic P5 in the Properties panel at the right side of the ISaGRAF™
Workbench.
4. Save the configuration, click BUILD and choose Build Solution the logic.
5. Download the advanced logic via the ISaGRAF™ Workbench to the P5 device
by right clicking IsaPrj, and then select Download.
Circuit Breaker with Shunt Trip Coil Circuit Breaker with Undervoltage Trip
Coil
The circuit breaker stays closed if The circuit breaker opens automatically if
PowerLogic P5 protection relay goes into the PowerLogic P5 protection relay goes into the
fail-safe position. fail-safe position.
Monitoring is required to detect whether the The circuit breaker opens if the substation
protection is no longer operational. auxiliary voltage disappears.
NOTICE
RISK OF UNPROTECTED ELECTRICAL INSTALLATION
Always connect the watchdog output to a monitoring device to mitigate and take
appropriate action when the selected trip command does not result in the
installation tripping or when the PowerLogic P5 protection relay fails.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in unprotected electrical
installation.
Trip
Breaker closed Breaker open
B B
11 9 5 B 7 B
Inhibit closing DO1 DI3 DI4
DO2 12 10 6 8
13
Closing DO3 15
Figure 326 - Example of use with undervoltage trip coil with fail-safe
condition (diagram 2)
Trip
Breaker closed Breaker open
B B
11 9 5 B 7 B
Inhibit closing DO1 DI3 DI4
DO2 12 10 6 8
13
Closing DO3 15
P533NQC
Figure 327 - Example of use with undervoltage trip coil without fail-safe
condition (diagram 3)
Trip
Breaker closed Breaker open
B B
11 9 5 B 7 B
Inhibit closing DO1 DI3 DI4
DO2 12 10 6 8
13
Closing DO3 15
Closing Trip
Contactor
1 C 3 C
2 4
(1) (1)
DI5 DI6
Shunt
trip coil (1) Standard assignments;
can be modified.
Event buffer
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay provides a logging and recording of all
important events that happen during operation. All “operationally relevant” signals,
each fully tagged with date and time at signal start and signal end, are registered
and stored in chronological order. For example, an event can be, start-on, start-off,
trip-on or trip-off of any protection stage, alarm-on or alarm-off, a digital input
change, etc. Each event is associated with a unique code. The selection of signals
to be considered in the event logging and recording can be configured by the user.
As an example, a typical trip event is shown in Example of I>1 trip-on event and its
visibility in local panel and communication protocols, page 515.
Table 151 - Example of I>1 trip-on event and its visibility in local panel and
communication protocols
Event desc: I>1 trip on 2 pu Event text and fault value Yes No
Timestamp is truncated to 1 ms in event list. The logged events can also be read
using:
• Local panel (see the Events list view under the Events option of the Logs
menu)
• eSetup Easergy Pro or Web HMI (see the Event buffer view in the LOGS
menu)
• Communication: In this case, only the latest event can be read.
On the local panel, the code is replaced by a ranking number.
With eSetup Easergy Pro, the events can be stored to a file, which is very helpful if
the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is not connected to a SCADA system.
SCADA systems are reading events using any of the available communication
protocols.
Event configuration
To configure which events are recorded the event enabling matrices are used (see
the Event enabling views in the LOGS menu of eSetup Easergy Pro). This allows
the optimisation of reporting by selecting the most useful events and deselecting
the ones of no interest. This prevents them from being written to the event buffer.
• Event enabling - stages 1
This matrix is used to activate an event when there is a change of the Start
and Trip status of a protection function/ stage. Select On, Off or both.
• Event enabling - stages 2
This matrix is similar to the Event enabling - stages 1 matrix but dedicated to
functions which provide more information than start and trip signals (e.g.
thermal image protection).
• Event enabling - objects
This matrix is dedicated to generate events associated to the defined objects
such as circuit breaker status and controls.
• Event enabling - AR
This matrix is dedicated to the auto recloser function and is used to generate
events associated with auto reclose states and status.
• Event enabling - logic
This matrix is used to generate events when one of the logic equations (up to
20) gets true or false.
• Event enabling - other
This matrix is dedicated to system monitoring including setting group change.
The maximum size of the buffer is 2000 events and can be exported as a PDF file
via eSetup Easergy Pro Print menu. 300 events can be displayed by eSetup
Easergy Pro. Only the latest 300 events, or the oldest 300 events, can be read on
the local panel according to the scroll order parameter.
All events are stored in non-volatile memory inside the PowerLogic P5 protection
relay and can be saved every 150 ms in the backup memory if available
(Extension board option).
When the buffer is filled the oldest event will be overwritten when a new event
occurs. The shown resolution of a time stamp for an event is one millisecond, but
the actual resolution depends on the particular function creating the event. For
example, most protection stages create events with a 5 ms, 10 ms or 20 ms
resolution. The absolute accuracy of all time stamps also depends on the
protection relay's time synchronisation.
Characteristics
Table 152 - Setting parameters for events
Clear events/Clear -
events
Clear Clear the buffer of events
Fault value scaling/Fault Scaling of event fault value
value
PU Per unit scaling
Display evt time not in On (check mark) Event time shown normally if relay is
sync/Event synchro. synchronised
Disturbance recording
Description
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay provides for fault events a disturbance
recording with the sampled analogue values of pre-selected analogue currents
and voltages before, during and after a fault event. Additionally, the calculated
frequency, the states of digital inputs (DI) and output (DO) signals are provided for
detailed fault analysis. The complete list of provided signals is shown in
Disturbance recording parameters (measurements and monitored values), page
519.
Triggering the recording
The recording can be triggered by any start or trip signal from any protection
stage, by a digital input, logic output or GOOSE signals. The triggering signal is
selected in the output matrix (vertical signal DR). The recording can also be
triggered manually. All the recordings are time stamped. The recording can be
made at 48 samples/cycle or 24 samples/cycle rate.
Reading recordings
The recordings can be downloaded with eSetup Easergy Pro. The recording is in
COMTRADE format. This also means that other programs can be used to view
and analyse the recordings made by the PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
PowerLogic P5 disturbance records can be read as well thru IEC 61850 and
DNP3 ethernet protocols and DNP3 and IEC 60870-5-103 serial communication
protocols. In case disturbance record is downloaded with sFTP, PowerLogic P5
generate and compress disturbance recorder COMTRADE data file with
DEFLATE format (rfc1950) by using public domain zlib functions. To decompress
the COMTRADE data file, please follow inflate API process defined in Zlib
specification. For detail, please visit home page of zlib (http://www.zlib.net/).
Number of channels
A maximum of 30 records can be stored with a mix of analogue and digital signals:
• 14 Analogue signals
• 124 Digital Signals (40 Digital inputs; 20 Digital outputs; 32 Start signals; 32
Trip signals)
A pre-selection of the channels and their order in the fault recording is made per
default and can be changed by the user with the parameters shown in Disturbance
recording parameters (measurements and monitored values), page 519.
134. Digital input signal means digital inputs (DI), virtual inputs (VI), etc.
135. Digital output signal means digital outputs (DO), virtual output (VO), etc.
NOTE: eSetup Easergy Pro provides directly the maximum recording length
when the signals to record are selected (see the bottom section of the
Disturbance recording view in the General menu).
NOTE: If the disturbance record is not correctly displayed in eSetup Easergy
Pro, please try to change the setting of Encoding in Wavewin. You can find the
.exe file from ...\Easergy Pro\Wavewin\Wavewin.exe. Double click
wavewin32.exe, click on Options\Display from the menu bar, in pop-up
System Settings window, select Language tab, then change the setting of
Encoding: to UTF8, click Ok button.
Parameters
Table 155 - Disturbance recording parameters (measurements and
monitored values)
Parameter
Value Description
(description/label)
Status of recording
- Not active
Status/Status
Run Waiting for a triggering
Trig Recording
VN Neutral voltage
Parameter
Value Description
(description/label)
Characteristics
Table 157 - Disturbance recording characteristics
The recording time and the number of records depend on the time setting and the
number of selected channels.
Table 158 - Example of I>1 LOG and its visibility in local panel and
communication protocols
Elapsed delay/End delay 100% Elapsed time of the operating time setting. 100% =
trip
Table 159 - Example of VT supervision and its visibility in local panel and
communication protocols
Settings / characteristics
Table 160 - Running hour counter settings/characteristics
Resolution 10 s
Start counter/Starts
Setting range 0...65535
Voltage interruptions
Description
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay includes a simple function to detect voltage
interruptions. The function calculates the number of voltage interruptions and the
total time of the voltage-off time within a given calendar period. The period is
based on the relay's real-time clock. The available periods are:
• 8 hours, 00:00...08:00, 08:00...16:00, 16:00...24:00
• one day, 00:00...24:00
• one week, Monday 00:00...Sunday 24:00
• one month, the first day 00:00...the last day 24:00
• one year, 1st January 00:00...31st December 24:00
After each period, the number of interruptions and the total interruption time are
stored as previous values. The interruption counter and the total time are cleared
for a new period. Previous values are overwritten.
Voltage interruption is based on the value of the positive sequence voltage V1 and
a set limit value. Whenever the measured V1 goes below the limit, the values of
the interruption counter and the total time counter starts are incremented.
The shortest recognised interruption time is 40 ms. If the voltage-off time is
shorter, it may be recognised depending on the relative depth of the voltage dip.
If the voltage has been significantly above the limit V1< and then there is a small
and short under-swing, it is not recognised.
t
P533K1A
On the other hand, if the limit V1< is high and the voltage has been near this limit,
and then there is a short but very deep dip, it is recognised.
t
P533K2A
Parameter Value
Voltage low limit/V<
Resolution 1% Vn136
Reset ratio > 103%
Accuracy 3%
Characteristic time
Start time < 60 ms
Disengaging time < 60 ms
136. Vnom
S ■ Apparent power ■ ■
P ■ ■ Active power ■ ■
Q ■ ■ Reactive power ■ ■
The timebase can be a value from one cycle to one minute. Also a demand value
can be used as the timebase and its value can be set between 10 and 60 minutes.
Table 164 - Parameters of the day and month registers
137. This is the fundamental frequency RMS value of one cycle updated every 20 ms.
Mode Priority
IEEE1588 1
IRIG-B 2
SNTP 3
SNTP backup 4
DI pulse signal 5
Modbus 6
IEC101/103 7
DNP3 8
Synchronisation with DI
The clock can be recognised by reading minute pulses from digital or virtual
inputs. The sync source is selected with the SyncDI setting. When a rising edge is
detected from the selected input, the system clock is adjusted to the nearest
minute. The length of the digital input pulse should be at least 50 ms. The delay of
the selected digital input should be set to zero.
Synchronisation correction
If the sync source has a known offset delay, it can be compensated with this
setting. This is useful for compensating hardware delays or transfer delays of
communication protocols. A positive value compensates a lagging external sync
and communication delays. A negative value compensates any leading offset of
the external synch source.
Sync source
When the protection relay receives new sync message, the sync source display is
updated. If no new sync messages were received within the last 1.5 minutes, the
protection relay switches over to internal sync mode.
Sync source: IRIG-B
IRIG-B synchronisation is supported by the IRIG-B module connected to the
optional extension module of the protection relay.
Deviation
The time deviation means how much the system clock time differs from the sync
source time. The time deviation is calculated after receiving a new sync message.
The filtered deviation means how much the system clock was really adjusted.
Filtering takes care of small deviation in sync messages.
Auto-lag/lead
The protection relay synchronises to the sync source, meaning that it starts
automatically leading or lagging to stay in sync with the master. The learning
process takes a few days.
DI Digital input
Minute sync pulse DI/ The digital input used for clock synchronisation.
SyncDI138 Possible value depends on the type of I/O card
installed.
- DI not used for synchronising.
138. Set the DI delay to its minimum and the polarity so that the leading edge is the synchronising edge.
Latest time deviation/ ± 32767 ms Latest time deviation between the system clock and
Dev the received synchronisation
dd-mm-yyyy
mm-dd-yyyy
Time zone/Time zone -15.00...+15.00140 UTC time zone for SNTP synchronisation.141
Fault recorder
P5 provides a dedicated fault recorder panel to display the last fault information.
Compared to the fault data logging, fault recorder can provide the magnitude of all
the phases.
Fault record is triggered instantaneously by general trip signal. This function
records the fault information right after the global trip signal is issued.
From the fault recorder panel, you will find the following information:
• IA, IB, IC magnitudes in primary [A]
• VA, VB, VC magnitudes in primary [V]
• IN.calc (derived value regardless sensing mode) in primary [A]
• VN.calc (derived value regardless voltage connection mode) in primary [V]
• f magnitude in [Hz]
• Trip time stamp (= Time when global trip (on event))
• Clearing time (the interval from trip to CB open) = Time when CB open (on
event) – Time when global trip (on event)
Monitoring functions
Trip circuit supervision (ANSI 74)
Description
Trip circuit supervision monitors the wiring from the protective device to the circuit
breaker trip coil. This function monitors the availability of the circuit when it is
requested to trip and reports an issue if needed.
By default, this user-configurable supervision function uses the PowerLogic P5
programmable logic to monitor the circuit continuity, loss of auxiliary supply
voltage or mismatching of the CB position indication contacts. Depending on user
settings, the function inhibits closing of the circuit breaker.
wire 1
Trip
relay(s) CB open DI1 CB closed DI2 PowerLogic P5
wire 2a
wire 2b
Circuit breaker
Trip
coil
wire 3
P533RJB
In the normal condition, when the trip circuit is OK, the status of inputs is opposite
(0,1) or (1,0). When the trip circuit is not OK (coil, wires, auxiliary contact state or
auxiliary voltage failure), both logic inputs are in the same state and an alarm is
issued after a delay. This delay is needed to help prevent false signaling during
breaker opening events. The timing is set based on breaker operating time and
trip pulse length.
The following table summarises the TCS alarm output depending on the CB and
its auxiliary contact positions as well as possible wiring failure conditions.
142. "failure" indicates that one or more of the components are permanently open circuit or short circuit.
CB open DI 1 =1
0 T
TCS alarm
CB closed DI 2 T=2s
P533RKB
Figure 335 - TCS with two digital inputs when the CB is in closed position
Digital inputs
TCS alarm
=1
2s
52b 52a
P533RLB
143. "failure" indicates that one or more of the components are permanently open circuit or short circuit.
Figure 336 - TCS two digital inputs when the CB is in open position
Digital inputs
TCS alarm
=1
2s
52b 52a
P533RMB
The figure below shows the default logic configuration of TCS in PowerLogic P5.
In this example the TCS is latched when an error condition is encountered and
reset using a virtual input.
DO2(B)
DO3(B)
TCS alarm
P533RQB
Status Description
- Normal status, function is enabled and in normal operation (= in none of the following
statuses);
or function is not enabled.
Alarm Function is enabled and in normal operation (not blocked) and any of the alarm input
signals is active (= any of the 5 DIs for insulation alarm/ oil temperature alarm/ gas
alarm/ oil at minimum level/ oil at maximum level is active).
Trip Function is enabled and in normal operation (not blocked) and any of the trip input
signals is active (= any of the 2 DIs for gas trip/ oil flow trip is active).
Blocked Function is enabled and input assigned at “DI for blocking” is active.
NOTE: The names of VI1 to VI8 have been customised in the figure above.
DI signal
Table below lists the digital input signal for one instance of transformer monitoring.
Characteristics
Table 169 - Characteristics of the transformer monitoring (ANSI 26/63)
Status
DI for blocking
Electrical wear
Breaker curve
The permitted CB operation number is defined by a CB permissible operation
curve (CB wear curve). This curve is usually available in the documentation of the
CB manufacturer. The curve specifies the permissible number of operations for
every level of broken current.
10000
1000
100
50
20
10
100 200 500 1000 10000 100000
Broken current (A) P533JEA
As shown in the figure below, in the PowerLogic P5 protection relay, this curve is
parameterised in the CB monitoring function with a maximum of eight points in the
form of [CurveIx, CurveNx]. If less than eight points are needed, the unused points
are set to [IBIG, 1], where IBIG is more than the maximum breaking capacity.
Table 170 - Values of the above circuit breaker wear characteristic graph
4-8 100 1
The values are taken from the figure above. The table (circuit breaker curve) is
edited with eSetup Easergy Pro or Web HMI in the CB Monitoring view of the
protection menu.
a
C= n
I P533JFA
where
C = permitted operations
I = broken current
a, n = constant according to the following two equations, where ln represents the
natural logarithm function, Ck/Ck+1 is the permitted number of operations defined
by CurveN, Curve(N+1) in the breaker curve table, and Ik/Ik+1 is the corresponding
broken current defined by CurveIk, CurveI(k+1) in the breaker curve table.
a = Ck I k
n
P533JJA
Ck
ln
C k +1
n=
I
ln k +1
Ik P533JGA
Each time a trip signal is detected, the corresponding permitted operations shall
be calculated based on the broken current Ibrk:
a
Cbrk = n
Ibrk P533JHA
Calarm
∆=
Cbrk P533JIA
• 80 operations at 31 kA
if the alarm 2 current setting is 6 kA, then the permitted number of operations can
be calculated as follows:
ln 10000
80
n= = 1.5038
ln 31000
1250 P533JKA
6
a 454 10
Calarm2 = n
= 1.5038
= 945
Ibrk 6000 P533JMA
Calarm
∆1,2 = = 945 = 3
Cbrk 313 P533JOA
In phase C, the current is less than the alarm limit current 6 kA. For such currents,
the decrement is one (just mechanical wear).
Five ranges of cumulative current
Each time the CB opens, the broken current is added to the corresponding total
cumulative broken current, phase by phase. The cumulative broken current is
given in (kA)2.
In addition to the total cumulative broken current, there are five cumulative broken
current ranges to assess the breaking device pole condition. Each range’s high
limit value is configurable and the low limit value equals to the high limit of its
previous range. Each range has three different counters, one for each phase, to
record how many times the broken current falls into the range. The cumulative
broken current record is configured in the PROTECTION menu/CB Monitoring
sub-menu.
The cumulative broken current is also computed by phase. When the PowerLogic
P5 protection relay is in test mode or the CB has been withdrawn, the cumulative
broken current is not updated.
An alarm signal will be generated when the cumulative broken current of any
phase exceeds the "broken I alarm setting".
Mechanical wear
CB Open counter, Protection Trip counter and Rack out counter
The “CB Open” counter is to record the number of CB close to open operation. It is
incremented even if the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is in test mode.
The “Protection Trip” counter is to record CB open times issued from Global trip.
This counter can also be set to a custom value but it does not increment during
test mode.
If, for whatever reason the circuit breaker does not open successfully after the
pulse setting time out (configured in object), the trip counters are not incremented.
The “Rack out” counter is to record the number of racking in/out operations of the
CB truck. It is incremented in both, normal and test mode.
Open time, close time and charging time
If two different digital signals are used to indicate the 52a (open) and 52b (close)
status of the CB position, the open time is measured from the moment when the
“52b” status becomes false to the moment when the “52a” status becomes true;
the close time is measured from the moment when the “52a” status becomes false
to the moment when the “52b” status becomes true, as shown in Figure below.
52b
A B
52a
P533JPB
However, if the CB position is only configured as 52a or 52b, the open time and
close time will be recorded as 0 each time when its related status changes.
The charging time is computed from the moment when the CB position changes to
close to the moment when the spring status changes to ready. The spring status is
configured through "DI for object ready" setting in Objects.
Open/close times and charging times are recorded for 8 latest operations in the
PowerLogic P5, each with a timestamp. If the time recorded exceeds the range,
the time will be tagged as a "dummy" value (65535) which allows the customer to
easily detect something is wrong with the CB.
These CB open times, close times and charging times are also recorded when the
PowerLogic P5 is in test mode.
CB monitoring status
Alarm 2
Current level 0.00...100.00 kA Alarm2 current level Editable
Operation limit 100,000...1 Alarm2 limit for operations left Editable
High limit 0.0...100.0 kA High limit setting for each range Editable
'Op. limit alarm 1 On' On ; Off Enable/disable the 'Alarm1 on' Editable
event event
'Op. limit alarm 1 Off' On ; Off Enable/disable the 'Alarm1 off' Editable
event event
'Op. limit alarm 2 On' On ; Off Enable/disable the 'Alarm2 on' Editable
event event
'Op. limit alarm 2 Off' On ; Off Enable/disable the 'Alarm2 off' Editable
event event
‘Broken I Alarm on’ On ; Off Enable/disable the ‘Broken I Editable
event Alarm on’ event
‘Broken I Alarm off’ On ; Off Enable/disable the ‘Broken I Editable
event Alarm off’ event
Parameter Accuracy
Charging time ±1 s
Block diagram
LPCTlost
IA < 1% Inom &
IB > 5% Inom
Loss of phase A
< 1.2 Inom 20ms 0 ≥1
IC > 5% Inom
Loss of phase B
S
< 1.2 Inom
Loss of phase C
IB Angle
110° - 130°
IC
≥1
Min ≥1 ≥1 T 100ms
> 0.1 Inom Fast Alarm
R
&
Register event
Reset DI input T 100ms Alarm
& &
Register event
IN >
VN <
Enable events
IN> VN< Operating mode Operate delay
P533R6B
Characteristics
Table 173 - Settings and characteristics of the current transformer
supervision function (ANSI 60)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Accuracy ±3%
CT input selection147
Accuracy ±3%
Resolution 0.01 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±30 ms at IN and VN
Characteristic times
Disengaging time < 160 ms
146. Inom
147. Available for P5T30 only.
148. √3 x Vnom
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Settings of CTS
Block diagram
Inhibit Ctrl
MCB open ≥1
LPVT loss
V2 >
&
I2 <
≥1 &
IA Max(I) S
IB >
IC
&
VAB Max(V)
VBC < 0.3 pu &
Register event
VCA
& R
VTS alarm
VN.calc +
∑ >
&
VN.meas - &
Register event
Enable VN compare
Enable events
V2> I2< I> (min) Delta_VN> Reset time
I< (max) t> P533OPB
Characteristics
Table 175 - Settings and characteristics of the voltage transformer
supervision function (ANSI 60)
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
Enable VTS
Options Off/On
V2> setting/V2>
Resolution 0.1
Accuracy ±2% or ± 0.2 V (secondary), whichever is bigger
I2< setting/I2<
Resolution 0.01
Accuracy ±2% or 0.02 pu150, whichever is bigger
Resolution 0.02 s
Accuracy ±1% or ±10 ms, whichever is bigger
Inhibit ctrl/InhCtrl
149. √3 x Vnom
150. Inom
Settings/characteristics Values
(description/label)
I>(min) setting/I>(min)
I<(max) setting/I<(max)
V<
Value 30% pu152, fixed
Enable VN compare
Options Off/On
Delta_VN>
Value 10 s
Accuracy 30 ms
Characteristic times
Reset time < 30 ms
Setting group/SetGrp
Number 1
151. Inom
152. √3 x Vnom
Settings/characteristics Description
Any output latched Any latched trip which still needs to be reset by
the user
Auto reclosing in progress A definite trip or ends up with an unsuccessful
reclosing
The user can select one or more of the above settings as the conditions to trigger
the signaling “Protection active”. When any signal from the selected setting(s) is
presented, the status of the signaling “Protection active” changes to “Protection
active”, otherwise the status is in idle state.
The signaling can be used:
• For local indication via LED, for example: to increase the awareness of the
PowerLogic P5 and bay condition prior to any local operation
• For local or remote indication via outputs
• As the blocking condition in object control, for example: to help prevent
dangerous bay open/close commands while the status changes to “Protection
active”
• For remote information by logging related event(s)
Maintenance
The PowerLogic P5 protection relays together with their extension units,
communication accessories, arc-flash detection sensors and cabling, require
maintenance in work according to their specification. Keep a record of the
maintenance actions. The maintenance can include, but is not limited to, the
following actions.
Safety instructions
This page contains important safety instructions that must be followed precisely
before attempting to install, repair, service or maintain electrical equipment.
Carefully read and follow the safety instructions described below.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• NEVER work alone.
• Turn off all power supplying this equipment before working on or inside it.
Consider all sources of power, including the possibility of backfeeding.
• Always use a properly rated voltage sensing device to confirm that all power
is off.
• Do not power a withdrawn mobile part of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay
with voltage > 24 V. Put back the withdrawable part in the fixed part before
powering it on.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
DANGER
FIRE HAZARD
If you are authorised to withdraw the relay:
• Disconnect the power supply before removing or replacing a module or the
withdrawable part of the protection relay.
• Never touch electronics parts (risk of damage due to electrostatic
discharge).
• Before replacing the withdrawable part, clean all debris and contaminants
from the case, the withdrawable part, and the connectors.
• In case of module or withdrawable part replacement, perform the
commissioning operations before using the protection relay.
• Apply proper tightening torque to all wire connections.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
CAUTION
RISK OF SETTING CHANGES ERASED
Never plug in or draw out the communication modules while the PowerLogic P5
protection relay is in service.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment
damage.
Self-monitoring
Watchdog relay
The PowerLogic P5 protection relays are equipped as standard with a watchdog
relay (digital output 4 in slot B). This is a changeover relay which is kept
permanently in the on-position by the PowerLogic P5 protection relay. In the event
of protection relay failure, or if the auxiliary power supply fails, the watchdog relay
reverts to the off-position.
Maintenance/Test LED
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay has gone into the fallback position following
detection by the embedded self-tests of the failure of one of its internal
components. In this case, the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is no longer
operational. This LED may light up when the protection relay is energised
during all the start phase of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay (for about 60
seconds). This is normal and does not indicate any internal failure. When the start
phase of the protection relay is completed, the LED is off if no internal failure is
detected.
List of self-tests
The self-tests are described in the table below.
Table 177 - List of self-tests
Power supply
EEPROM boards
NOR Flash memory
DDRAM memory
On energisation and during
Back up memory
operation
Internal bus
Display and graphic libraries
Micro processor
Digital inputs
Digital outputs
Backup memory
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay has an optional feature of a removable back
up memory. This feature provides a mechanism for storing the product settings
and other related information separately to the removable part of PowerLogic P5.
The memory allows quick, restoration of settings should there be a need to
exchange the withdrawable part. As a result, the mobile part can be replaced and
back in service in a matter of minutes.
The optional back up memory is included in the extension module that can be
installed in Slot P. This extension module also includes connectivity to support
IRIG-B and thermal sensors.
Figure 345 - The optional extension module (slot P) that includes the back-
up memory
Automatic storage
The PowerLogic P5 automatically stores all settings, events and disturbance
recordings at 2AM local time every day.
As indicated above the secured process means that the memory can not be
corrupted as the save is verified before previous data is overwritten.
NOTE: Due to this unique feature the important data and settings are always
secured locally and not based on any remote storage on a control system.
1. Press the key to enter the main menu and then select the Device/Test
icon using the arrow keys.
2. Press the key to enter the Device/Test sub menu.
3. Select the Back-up option using the key and press .
4. Press , select Man. Trig and then press .
Backup Memory 1/2
Trigger backup memory
Status Idle
Man. Trig -
Ignore Restore
Press the key to keep the information in the back up memory or the button
to discard and help prevent the pop up occurring again.
NOTE: This action does not restore the settings. Follow the ‘Restore from
Backup memory’ process described below.
1. Press the key to access the main menu and then select Device/Test by
using the arrow keys.
2. Press the key to enter the Device/Test sub menu.
3. Press the key to select the Back-up option and then press .
4. Press the key to enter the second setting page Restore Memory and
then press .
5. Press the key to select the Trig restore memory parameter and then
press .
6. Press the key to select On.
The PowerLogic P5 shows the following notification window:
CAUTION
All the settings, events,
records will be replaced
by backup. Don’t apply an
unverified backup against
unpredictable risks.
Recheck relay after restore.
Restore Cancel
1. Select the second screen in the Back-up sub menu by pressing the key.
The screen does not display any information while restoring is in progress.
2. When restoring is completed, the device information appears on the screen.
The Compliance check parameter shows status “Checking” for a short while
and changes to “True” after a successful restoring process.
Restore memory 2/2
Update -
Firmware -
Ref. -
Compliance check -
Manual restore -
Preventive maintenance
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay requires maintenance in order for it to work
according to the specification.
WARNING
UNEXPECTED SYSTEM OPERATION
Carry out periodic system testing as per the testing recommendation in this
manual or if the protection system scheme has been changed.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in death, serious injury, or
equipment damage.
Introduction
To obtain the maximum availability of the installation, it is essential to help ensure
that the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is operational at any times.
The PowerLogic P5 protection relay's internal self-tests, the watchdog relay, and
the LED alert the user in the event of internal protection relay failure.
Nevertheless, elements outside the PowerLogic P5 protection relay are not
subject to these self-tests and it is therefore necessary to carry out regular
preventive maintenance.
Check the PowerLogic P5 protection relay visually and pay attention to dirty
components, loose wire connections, damaged wiring, user interface screen and
LEDs, and other mechanical connections.
Then, to perform maintenance, carry out all the recommended commissioning
tests.
First test all the digital inputs and outputs involved in tripping the circuit breaker. A
test of the complete chain including the circuit breaker is also recommended.
The software setting tool, eSetup Easergy Pro, is especially useful during
maintenance tests and procedures.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Apply appropriate personal protective equipment (PPE) and follow safe
electrical work practices. See NFPA 70E, NOM-029-STPS-2011, or
CSAZ462.
• The arc fault detection system is not a substitute for proper PPE when
working on or near equipment being monitored by the system.
• Information on this product is offered as a tool for conducting arc-flash
hazard analysis. It is intended for use only by qualified persons who are
knowledgeable about power system studies, power distribution equipment,
and equipment installation practices. It is not intended as a substitute for the
engineering judgement and adequate review necessary for such activities.
• Only qualified personnel should install and service this equipment. Read this
entire set of instructions and check the technical characteristics of the device
before performing such work.
• Perform wiring according to national standards (NEC) and any requirements
specified by the customer.
• Observe any separately marked notes and warnings.
• NEVER work alone.
• Before performing visual inspections, tests, or maintenance on this
equipment, disconnect all sources of electric power. Assume all circuits are
live until they are completely de-energised, tested, and tagged. Pay
particular attention to the design of the power system. Consider all sources
of power, including the possibility of back feeding.
• Always use a properly rated voltage sensing relay to ensure that all power is
off.
• The equipment must be properly grounded.
• Connect the device's protective ground to functional earth according to the
connection diagrams presented in this document.
• Do not open the device. It contains no user-serviceable parts.
• Install all devices, doors and covers before turning on the power to this
device.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Intervention frequency
Test the PowerLogic P5 protection relay periodically according to the end user's
safety instructions and national safety instructions or law.
The necessary time between visual inspections and functional checks depends on
the installation operating conditions. Generally, we recommend to carry out
periodic checks or tests every four (4) years. In corrosive or harsh offshore
environments, functional testing should be carried out more often; we recommend
every three (3) years.
For the testing procedures, see Commissioning, page 144.
The table below summarises the recommended frequency of interventions.
Test Periodicity
Test Periodicity
CAUTION
RISK OF SETTING CHANGES ERASED
• Never plug in or draw out the communication modules while the PowerLogic
P5 protection relay is in service.
• Check and make sure that the communication module is locked.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment
damage.
DANGER
HAZARD OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, EXPLOSION OR ARC FLASH
• Use the appropriate (3 or 4-terminal) copper jumper for common
connections.
• After cabling, protect the rear connector A with the two protective caps.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Check the wiring connections in the rear panel: for the type of screws, screwdriver
to be used, and torque (see Installation, page 37).
In addition to the periodic wiring and connections check, a thermal measurement
with thermal camera is recommended to make visible any warm points of the
installation so that loose connections could be detected and corrected before a
real issue occurs.
Check the earth/ground connections (two ends).
Place back the two protective caps (connector A) before powering on the
PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
DANGER
HAZARD OF UNEXPECTED SYSTEM OPERATION
• If the arc-flash detection unit is no longer supplied with power or is in
permanent non-operational state, the protection functions are no longer
active and all the output contacts are dropped out.
• To detect a power-off or a permanent fault state, connect the watchdog (SF)
output contact to a monitoring device such as SCADA or DCS.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Hardware cleaning
Pay special attention to help ensure that the device, its extension units and
sensors do not become dirty.
DANGER
HAZARD OF UNEXPECTED SYSTEM OPERATION
• Do not use any type of solvents or gasoline to clean the device, sensors or
cables.
• When cleaning the sensor, make sure that the cleaning solution does not
contact anything other than the sensor.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in death or serious injury.
Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting assistance
The PowerLogic P5 is a withdrawable protection relay. The faulty protection relay
can be removed from its outer case without disconnecting the wires from the
terminals. This allows to quickly replace a protection relay, provided that the spare
part is available.
The replacement of a protection relay is done with the following steps:
1. Perform a diagnostic check on the protection relay:
• The status of the watchdog relay (DO4 contact relay on slot B)
• The status of the " " and " " LEDs as well as the configurable LEDs
• The LED and the " " LED on the local panel
• The messages displayed on the local panel
• The alarm list and maintenance file downloaded with eSetup Easergy
Pro
2. Check the compatibility of the spare part: the labels on the fixed and the
withdrawable parts are the same.
3. Recover the configuration from the backup memory (optional) and restart of
the new protection relay, following the instructions displayed on the local
panel.
The PowerLogic P5 is a modular protection relay. The modules that can be
replaced individually are:
• The communication modules
• The extension modules with back-up memory
Identification of the modules can be accessed:
• From the local panel of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay ( in the Device/
Test menu)
• From eSetup Easergy Pro (Boards view of the Device/test menu)
• From the web server and the EcoStruxure Power Device application
Maintenance message with: Mismatch between hardware Check the model number on
Module ID = 3 configuration and product fixed part with model number
Error type = -7 model number. on the withdrawable.
1st five characters after the
application reference should
be the same:
P5xx0-AAAA-Axxxx-xxxx
Maintenance message with: Hardware failure detected on Change the fix part of the
Module ID = 3 the fixed part (slot A) when the PowerLogic P5 protection relay
Error type = -5 PowerLogic P5 protection relay with the equivalent one.
Completed by one of these is powered on.
references: The message specifies the
• 3CT-CSH board impacted by the defect.
• 3CT-4VT-CSH
• 5CT
• 5CT-4VT
• 4VT
• LPCT-LPVT
Maintenance message with: Hardware failure detected on Change the withdrawable part
Module ID = 3 the withdrawable part when the of the PowerLogic P5
Error type = -5 PowerLogic P5 protection relay protection relay with the same
Completed by one of these is powered on. model number.
references: The message specifies the
• 6DI-4DO board impacted by the defect.
• ARC-FLASH
• CPU P5x20
• CPU P5x30
• PSU30H-DI-DO
• PSU30L-DI-DO
• PSU20-DI-DO
Alarm message completed by Hardware failure detected on Check that the hardware
one of these references: the optional boards when the resources are equivalent or
• EXTENSION-BKUP PowerLogic P5 protection relay exceeds those used in the
• COM SRL RS485 is powered on. configuration file.
• COM SRL FO
• COM ETH 2TP-M (on
slot M)
• COM ETH 2FO-M (on
slot M)
• COM ETH 2TP-L (on slot
L)
• COM ETH HSR/PRP
Message appears during a Major issue on the CPU board Change the withdrawable part
reboot of the PowerLogic P5 of the PowerLogic P5 of the PowerLogic P5
protection relay. The boot is not protection relay. protection relay with the same
complete and the following model number.
message is displayed:
- Firmware not complete (in
English only)
Alarm message completed by MET148-2 loose connection Check the MET148-2 module
the reference: is well connected to the
MET148-2 Extension and backup memory
board.
Alarm message completed by The RTD number x on the As the message is common to
“RTD x Open Circuit Fault On” MET148-2 module is the RTD channels of the
or by: “RTD x Short Circuit disconnected or short- MET148-2 module, go to the
Fault On”, circuited. temperature measurement
display screen to determine
where x is the number of the which RTD is affected by the
RTD defect.
Measurement displayed:
• Tx.x = -**** = RTD
disconnected (T > 205 °C
(401 °F))
• Tx.x = **** = RTD short-
circuited (T < -35 °C (-31
°F))
Then check the connection of
RTDs.
Alarm message “Incompatible Incompatible firmware or Check the firmware or
hardware or firmware version, hardware versions hardware version.
operation stopped”
The trip signal does Faulty trip circuit wiring. Check that the wiring of the trip circuit is
not reach the circuit not faulty.
breaker.
The protection does The protection needs both Check the dip switch configuration. The
not trip even when a light and current information protection may be configured to require
sufficient light signal to trip. both the light and current condition to trip.
is provided.
Faulty sensor wiring Loose sensor wire. Check the sensor wiring. The sensor wire
detected by the self- may have loosened in the terminal blocks.
supervision.
Error message Light pulse to the arc-flash Check that the light pulse to the arc-flash
indicating blocked sensor is too long. sensor is not too long.
sensor channel.
If light is supplied to the arc-flash sensor for
more than three seconds, the self-
supervision function activates and switches
the light sensor channel to daylight
blocking mode, and the sensor channel is
blocked.
MET148-2 green LED on. No response from the Check the position of the
MET148-2 red LED off. MET148-2 module. module number selection
jumper:
• MET1 for first MET148-2
module (temperatures T1
to T8)
• MET2 for second
MET148- 2 module
(temperatures T9 to T16).
• If the jumper position
needs to be changed,
reboot the MET148-2
module (by disconnecting
and reconnecting the
interconnection cord).
• Change the extension
module.
MET148-2 red LED flashing. Faulty wiring, MET148-2 Check module connections:
powered but loss of dialogue • RJ45 plugs of CCA77x
with base unit. cords clipped correctly
into sockets.
• If the MET148-2 module
is the last in the chain,
check that the line
terminating jumper is in
the Rc position. In all
other cases, check that
the jumper is in the
position marked
.
MET148-2 red LED on. More than 3 remote modules Remove a remote module.
connected.
MET148-2 module internal Change MET148-2 module.
failure.
Firmware upgrade
NOTE: This section applies to firmware upgrade operation only. For firmware
downgrade, please contact Schneider Electric Customer Care Center.
From time to time it may be necessary to upgrade the firmware of your
PowerLogic P5. There could be a number of reasons for this, new functionality,
security patches or correction of product behaviour.
The firmware upgrade feature of the PowerLogic P5 protection relay provides the
possibility for the user to upgrade the application firmware themselves through
eSetup Easergy Pro.
Upgrading the firmware requires the eSetup Easergy Pro software to be
connected to the device to be upgraded. This can be done either through the mini-
USB port on the local panel or one of the rear Ethernet ports.
You must also have access to the zip file containing the firmware version you wish
to upgrade to. This file typically has the format PowerLogic-P5-firmware-Vxx.xxx.
xxx.zip. Please contact Schneider Electric Customer Care Center to get the
package.
Please be aware that the contents of this file must come from Schneider Electric
and the firmware signature will be checked to help ensure that it has come from a
genuine source before the product is updated.
NOTICE
RISK OF DATA LOSS
• Please save your configuration files, disturbance records and events before
starting the firmware upgrade.
• After the firmware upgrade is done, the operator needs to first connect to the
device and retrieve all configurations through eSetup Easergy Pro, open the
saved file, and then select the Copy all to DEVICE option from the File
menu.
• The operator needs to rebuild the logics and matrix.
• The operator needs to reload the second language package.
Failure to follow these instructions will result in loss of all configurations,
disturbance records and events.
The process for upgrading the firmware on the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is
as follows:
1. Connect the laptop that runs eSetup Easergy Pro to the PowerLogic P5
protection relay and log in with “InstallerLevel”.
2. Open the main menu from the top-left corner of the application, select the
Update firmware... option, and then select the new firmware package from
the folder where you saved the package.
3. The application performs the following operations before starting the upgrade:
a. Check User's rights
b. Checking firmware package
4. If every check is passed, the application gets ready to upgrade the firmware
and prompts the user to confirm. Click OK to confirm and the application will
reboot the device, and after that the new firmware will take effect.
5. After rebooted, a message Firmware update successful will be displayed in
alarm list.
2
P533JUA
① Fixed rack
② Withdrawable part
To limit the time of interventions for maintenance reasons, the faulty protection
relay can be removed without disconnecting the wires or the connections. This
allows to quickly replace an PowerLogic P5 protection relay, provided that the
spare part is available.
The spare withdrawable part must be compatible with the one which is replaced.
The compatibility rules are as follows:
• The spare part must have the same hardware resources
• The spare part must have the same product model number
• The spare part must have the same major software version
To avoid any unintended withdrawing, and for security reasons, the removable
part is fixed to the rack by 3 screws for PowerLogic P5 x20 and 4 screws for
PowerLogic P5 x30 protection relays.
The procedure for replacing the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is as follows:
• The Alarm list and Maintenance file to checked and downloaded with eSetup
Easergy Pro
Preliminary operations
NOTE: If the PowerLogic P5 protection relay is still working, do not hesitate to
save configuration, settings and parameters to the back-up memory of the
extension module (optional) if it is available in the protection relay. For saving
(backup), go to the backup view of the Device/Test menu on the local panel.
1. Power off the PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
2. Unscrew the 3 screws on PowerLogic P5 x20 (or 4 for PowerLogic P5 x30)
that fix the local panel to the relay outer case. Refer to Unscrewing the front
face locking screws, page 50.
Tools (-) 6.5 mm (1/4 in.) or (+) PZ2 screwdriver (Digital torque
screwdriver for installing)
3. Push upward the handle lock that locks the device handle.
4. Close the shutter of the local panel if it is open.
Removal
1. Using the device handle, pull the withdrawable part of the protection relay to
detach it from the outer case (pull the device handle from the top and bottom
when side access is difficult).
P533JSA
2. Extract the withdrawable part of the protection relay, using your both hands to
help ensure a secure grip.
3. Check the model numbers on both the withdrawable part and the outer case.
Installation
1. Before replacing the module:
• For compatibility of the spare part, check that the identification on the
labels on the fixed and the withdrawable parts are the same.
• Visually check the cleanliness and state of the rear connectors (rear part
and lower part).
2. With the device handle fully open, insert the withdrawable (spare) part gently
into the fixed part.
3. Push down the handle to lock the withdrawable part. The lock tab on the
handle locks the handle to the local panel automatically.
P533JTA
4. For highly vibrating environment, put in place the screws (3 for PowerLogic
P5 x20 and 4 for PowerLogic P5 x30) for locking the local panel to the relay
case.
NOTE: The screws are not mandatory for the installation of the spare part, but
recommended for security reasons.
Subsequent operations
After installing the PowerLogic P5 protection relay, perform the following
operations if necessary:
1. Switch on the PowerLogic P5 protection relay and check the relay operation.
Check the model number (from the Device/Test menu on the local panel) and
compare it with the associated model number displayed in eSetup Easergy
Pro.
2. If an extension module with backup memory is available on the PowerLogic
P5 protection relay, update the device configuration.
3. For recovery of the configuration from the backup memory (optional) and
restart of the new protection relay, follow the instructions displayed on the
local panel.
CAUTION
RISK OF SETTING CHANGES ERASED
• Never plug in or draw out the communication modules while the PowerLogic
P5 protection relay is in service.
• Check and make sure that the communication module is locked.
Failure to follow these instructions can result in injury or equipment
damage.
Preliminary operation
Before changing a communication module:
1. Power off the PowerLogic P5 protection relay.
2. Check if it there is enough space (> 15 cm or 6 in.) in the rear and lower part
of the case to extract the modules. If not possible, remove the case from its
support.
Removal
The module can be easily removed from the PowerLogic P5 protection relay:
1. Push down the locking tab ①.
2. Gently pull the communication module forward ②.
2
1
P533JVA
Installation
Install the module according to the following steps:
1. Before replacing the module, check visually the front plate ① and the
connector ②.
1 2
P533JWA
Subsequent operation
After installing the module:
1. Check that the module is locked (visual check).
2. Switch on the PowerLogic P5 protection relay and verify that the module has
been detected:
• On the local panel, enter the Home menu/Device/Test sub-menu and
check this in the Board menu item.
• With eSetup Easergy Pro see the Device/Test menu/Device Info sub-
menu.
End of life
At end of life, PowerLogic P5 protection relays must be dismantled to facilitate the
recovery of the various constituent materials.
The proportion of recyclable material is higher than 65%. This percentage
includes the metallic materials and marked thermoplastics conforming to the
current legislation, as well as the subassemblies that must be sent to specialised
treatment systems: 3 to 5 electronic cards, and an LCD screen that can easily be
disassembled.
It is calculated according to "ECO’DEEE recyclability and recoverability calculation
method" (version V1.20, September 2008, presented to ADEME, the French
Agency for Environment and Energy Management).
Revision history
Document version Description
P5/EN M/11A First edition for initial product release
2019-05 Hardware version A
Firmware version V01
Release / Build 001.029
Configuration tool eSetup Easergy Pro V2.0.0 or later
CET850 V3.1.2 or later
P5/EN M/22A Hardware version A
2019-11 Firmware version V01
Release / Build 200.008
Configuration tool eSetup Easergy Pro V2.2.0 or later
CET850 V3.2.0 or later
Hardware LPCT/LPVT available for P5U20
Ethernet communication module with RSTP redundancy
(reference REL51042)
Local panel Local panel layout enhanced
U2>, U2>> Negative sequence overvoltage protection (ANSI 47)
I0/U0>, I0/U0>> Neutral admittance protection (ANSI 21YN)
N> Motor restart inhibition function (ANSI 66) enhanced
CB monitoring CB monitoring function enhanced
Firmware upgrade Firmware upgrade feature
USB data transfer USB data transfer function available
I2> The following features are available:
I>, I>>
• STI and CO8 curves to the IEC and IEEE curve types,
I0>,
respectively
I0’>, I0’>>
Iφ>, Iφ>> • IDMT reset curve
I0φ>, I0φ>>, I0φ>>>
Logic gate Logic gate number increased to 250
P5/EN M/33A Hardware version A
2020-07 Firmware version V01
Release / Build 300.103
Configuration tool eSetup Easergy Pro V3.0.0 or later
CET850 V3.3.0 or later
Hardware 12I4O and 5I5O modules available
24 to 48 V DC voltage power supply module available for
P5x30
Motor speed detection Motor speed detection available
Motor speed>1, Motor Motor overspeed (ANSI 12) protection available
speed>2
Motor speed<1,Motor Motor underspeed (ANSI 14) protection available
speed<2
Advanced logic engine More complex logic feature with ISaGRAF available
P5/EN M/44B Hardware version A
2022-07 Firmware version V01
Release / Build 402.101
Configuration tool eSetup Easergy Pro 4.2.0 or later
CET850 V4.2.0 or later
Easergy Studio V9.4.0 or later
Rate of change of Algorithm revised, frequency and frequency + RoCoF
frequency protection modes introduced. Increased accuracy. 9 independent
stages with the same settings and performance introduced.
Overcurrent protection Definite time setting range updated.
Undercurrent protection Pick-up setting range updated. Low-current block limit
setting introduced. The function is now available in P5F30.
Broken conductor Algorithm revised. The precondition for operation is the
protection positive phase sequence component greater than 5% of
nominal value. 2nd stage with the same settings and
performance introduced.
Emergency restart New automation function for motor application introduced.
Virtual inputs VI1 to VI10 are configurable virtual inputs, they can operate
in pulse mode with a settable pulse length.
Default mimic Improved manipulation of default mimic screens. Use
arrow-up or arrow-down keys to scroll between visible
Mimics 1-5.
Disturbance recorder Auto-Reclose, CB monitoring, SOL, CTS/VTS related
signals added to Disturbance Recorder.
Alarms Fault direction added to 67/67N related alarms.
System Confirmation popup window displayed when firmware
upgrade is completed successfully.
Special access control by F1 button enhanced with auto
log-out within 3 mins and reset button behaviour.
Connection between P5 and Easergy Pro improved.
Communication Ethernet/IP protocol data model updated.
Modbus protocol data model updated.
IEC 60870-5-103 protocol data model updated.
Enhancements and bug fixes in IEC 61850 fPN feature.
Advanced logic engine Advanced logic can be now viewed with ISaGRAF
Workbench Demo only (without ISaGRAF Workbench
license).
Nomenclature Change for setting units from In/% to pu.
Continuous engineering Regular corrections & bug fixes package introduced.
P5/EN M/44C Hardware version A
2022-09 Firmware version V01
Release / Build 402.201
Configuration tool eSetup Easergy Pro 4.2.0 or later
CET850 V4.2.0 or later
Easergy Studio V9.4.0 or later
Order information
Protection relay
For ordering, please visit www.se.com and use PowerLogic P5 Product Selector.
Alternatively, please contact Customer Care Center stating a complete model
number (according to below table) and quantity.
PowerLogic P5
Language
Firmware
Function
Slot M
Slot D
Slot B
Slot C
Slot A
Slot N
Slot E
Slot P
Slot L
Model
Application
Feeder protection relay P5F30 - - -
Motor protection relay P5M30
Transformer differential relay P5T30
Universal protection relay P5U20
Voltage protection relay P5V20
Slot A - CT/VT
3 phase CT + 2 neutral CT (available for P5U20) B
3 phase CT + 1 neutral CSH (available for P5U20) C
4 VT (available for P5V20) D
3 phase CT + 2 neutral CT + 4 VT (available for P5F30, P5M30) G
3 phase CT + 1 neutral CSH + 4 VT (available for P5F30, P5M30) H
3 LPCT + 1 neutral CSH + 4 LPVT (available for P5F30, P5M30, P5U20) I
6 phase CT + 2 neutral CT + 1 VT (available for P5T30) * J
Model version
Version A A
Firmware version
Latest firmware version V01.500 A
Firmware version V01.402 E
Function packages
Cybersecurity Basic - firmware V01.402 A
Cyberscurity Advanced IEC 62443 4-2 Security Level 1 - firmware V01.402 B
Cybersecurity Basic & Advanced Logic Engine - firmware V01.402 C
Cybersecurity Advanced IEC 62443 4-2 Security Level 1 & Advanced Logic Engine - firmware V01.402 D
Settable cybersecurity (Basic or Advanced IEC 62443 4-2 SL1) - firmware V01.500 E
Settable cybersecurity (Basic or Advanced IEC 62443 4-2 SL1) + Advanced Logic Engine - firmware V01.500 F
Languages
English A
English - Chinese B
English - French C
English - Italian E
English - Polish F
English - Portuguese G
English - Russian H
English - Spanish I
English - Tr. Chinese L
English - English ANSI * K
* options not available with firmware version V01.303
** ATTENTION - slot occupation rules apply, not every I/O board configuration in slots C, D, E is valid. Please refer to Product Selector at www.se.com, User Guide/Ordering information or
P5x30 slot occupation rules XLS file.
NOTE: For the applicable slot occupation rules for your PowerLogic P5
protection relay ordered, refer to Slot occupation rules, page 580 to get more
details.
Accessories
Order code Description
Communication Modules
REL51038 Ethernet TP module - slot M
REL51039 Ethernet FO module - slot M
REL51042 Ethernet TP module - slot L
REL51033 Ethernet HSR/PRP FO module - slots M-N
REL51036 RS485 serial line module - slot N
VW3A8306RC RS485 line termination accessory
EMS59572 VT adapter
REL52802 Arc accessory VA1DA-20S-HF Arc sensor 20m shielded halogen free
REL52808 Arc accessory VA1EH-20S Arc sensor 20m pipe sensor shielded
Mounting accessories
Wiring accessories
Spare parts